1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 113 114 115 116 117 118 119 120 121 122 123 124 125 126 127 128 129 130 131 132 133 134 135 136 137 138 139 140 141 142 143 144 145 146 147 148 149 150 151 152 153 154 155 156 157 158 159 160 161 162 163 164 165 166 167 168 169 170 171 172 173 174 175 176 177 178 179 180 181 182 183 184 185 186 187 188 189 190 191 192 193 194 195 196 197 198 199 200 201 202 203 204 205 206 207 208 209 210 211 212 213 214 215 216 217 218 219 220 221 222 223 224 225 226 227 228 229 230 231 232 233 234 235 236 237 238 239 240 241 242 243 244 245 246 247 248 249 250 251 252 253 254 255 256 257 258 259 260 261 262 263 264 265 266 267 268 269 270 271 272 273 274 275 276 277 278 279 280 281 282 283 284 285 286 287 288 289 290 291 292 293 294 295 296 297 298 299 300 301 302 303 304 305 306 307 308 309 310 311 312 313 314 315 316 317 318 319 320 321 322 323 324 325 326 327 328 329 330 331 332 333 334 335 336 337 338 339 340 341 342 343 344 345 346 347 348 349 350 351 352 353 354 355 356 357 358 359 360 361 362 363 364 365 366 367 368 369 370 371 372 373 374 375 376 377 378 379 380 381 382 383 384 385 386 387 388 389 390 391 392 393 394 395 396 397 398 399 400 401 402 403 404 405 406 407 408 409 410 411 412 413 414 415 416 417 418 419 420 421 422 423 424 425 426 427 428 429 430 431 432 433 434 435 436 437 438 439 440 441 442 443 444 445 446 447 448 449 450 451 452 453 454 455 456 457 458 459 460 461 462 463 464 465 466 467 468 469 470 471 472 473 474 475 476 477 478 479 480 481 482 483 484 485 486 487 488 489 490 491 492 493 494 495 496 497 498 499 500 501 502 503 504 505 506 507 508 509 510 511 512 513 514 515 516 517 518 519 520 521 522 523 524 525 526 527 528 529 530 531 532 533 534 535 536 537 538 539 540 541 542 543 544 545 546 547 548 549 550 551 552 553 554 555 556 557 558 559 560 561 562 563 564 565 566 567 568 569 570 571 572 573 574 575 576 577 578 579 580 581 582 583 584 585 586 587 588 589 590 591 592 593 594 595 596 597 598 599 600 601 602 603 604 605 606 607 608 609 610 611 612 613 614 615 616 617 618 619 620 621 622 623 624 625 626 627 628 629 630 631 632 633 634 635 636 637 638 639 640 641 642 643 644 645 646 647 648 649 650 651 652 653 654 655 656 657 658 659 660 661 662 663 664 665 666 667 668 669 670 671 672 673 674 675 676 677 678 679 680 681 682 683 684 685 686 687 688 689 690 691 692 693 694 695 696 697 698 699 700 701 702 703 704 705 706 707 708 709 710 711 712 713 714 715 716 717 718 719 720 721 722 723 724 725 726 727 728 729 730 731 732 733 734 735 736 737 738 739 740 741 742 743 744 745 746 747 748 749 750 751 752 753 754 755 756 757 758 759 760 761 762 763 764 765 766 767 768 769 770 771 772 773 774 775 776 777 778 779 780 781 782 783 784 785 786 787 788 789 790 791 792 793 794 795 796 797 798 799 800 801 802 803 804 805 806 807 808 809 810 811 812 813 814 815 816 817 818 819 820 821 822 823 824 825 826 827 828 829 830 831 832 833 834 835 836 837 838 839 840 841 842 843 844 845 846 847 848 849 850 851 852 853 854 855 856 857 858 859 860 861 862 863 864 865 866 867 868 869 870 871 872 873 874 875 876 877 878 879 880 881 882 883 884 885 886 887 888 889 890 891 892 893 894 895 896 897 898 899 900 901 902 903 904 905 906 907 908 909 910 911 912 913 914 915 916 917 918 919 920 921 922 923 924 925 926 927 928 929 930 931 932 933 934 935 936 937 938 939 940 941 942 943 944 945 946 947 948 949 950 951 952 953 954 955 956 957 958 959 960 961 962 963 964 965 966 967 968 969 970 971 972 973 974 975 976 977 978 979 980 981 982 983 984 985 986 987 988 989 990 991 992 993 994 995 996 997 998 999 1000 1001 1002 1003 1004 1005 1006 1007 1008 1009 1010 1011 1012 1013 1014 1015 1016 1017 1018 1019 1020 1021 1022 1023 1024 1025 1026 1027 1028 1029 1030 1031 1032 1033 1034 1035 1036 1037 1038 1039 1040 1041 1042 1043 1044 1045 1046 1047 1048 1049 1050 1051 1052 1053 1054 1055 1056 1057 1058 1059 1060 1061 1062 1063 1064 1065 1066 1067 1068 1069 1070 1071 1072 1073 1074 1075 1076 1077 1078 1079 1080 1081 1082 1083 1084 1085 1086 1087 1088 1089 1090 1091 1092 1093 1094 1095 1096 1097 1098 1099 1100 1101 1102 1103 1104 1105 1106 1107 1108 1109 1110 1111 1112 1113 1114 1115 1116 1117 1118 1119 1120 1121 1122 1123 1124 1125 1126 1127 1128 1129 1130 1131 1132 1133 1134 1135 1136 1137 1138 1139 1140 1141 1142 1143 1144 1145 1146 1147 1148 1149 1150 1151 1152 1153 1154 1155 1156 1157 1158 1159 1160 1161 1162 1163 1164 1165 1166 1167 1168 1169 1170 1171 1172 1173 1174 1175 1176 1177 1178 1179 1180 1181 1182 1183 1184 1185 1186 1187 1188 1189 1190 1191 1192 1193 1194 1195 1196 1197 1198 1199 1200 1201 1202 1203 1204 1205 1206 1207 1208 1209 1210 1211 1212 1213 1214 1215 1216 1217 1218 1219 1220 1221 1222 1223 1224 1225 1226 1227 1228 1229 1230 1231 1232 1233 1234 1235 1236 1237 1238 1239 1240 1241 1242 1243 1244 1245 1246 1247 1248 1249 1250 1251 1252 1253 1254 1255 1256 1257 1258 1259 1260 1261 1262 1263 1264 1265 1266 1267 1268 1269 1270 1271 1272 1273 1274 1275 1276 1277 1278 1279 1280 1281 1282 1283 1284 1285 1286 1287 1288 1289 1290 1291 1292 1293 1294 1295 1296 1297 1298 1299 1300 1301 1302 1303 1304 1305 1306 1307 1308 1309 1310 1311 1312 1313 1314 1315 1316 1317 1318 1319 1320 1321 1322 1323 1324 1325 1326 1327 1328 1329 1330 1331 1332 1333 1334 1335 1336 1337 1338 1339 1340 1341 1342 1343 1344 1345 1346 1347 1348 1349 1350 1351 1352 1353 1354 1355 1356 1357 1358 1359 1360 1361 1362 1363 1364 1365 1366 1367 1368 1369 1370 1371 1372 1373 1374 1375 1376 1377 1378 1379 1380 1381 1382 1383 1384 1385 1386 1387 1388 1389 1390 1391 1392 1393 1394 1395 1396 1397 1398 1399 1400 1401 1402 1403 1404 1405 1406 1407 1408 1409 1410 1411 1412 1413 1414 1415 1416 1417 1418 1419 1420 1421 1422 1423 1424 1425 1426 1427 1428 1429 1430 1431 1432 1433 1434 1435 1436 1437 1438 1439 1440 1441 1442 1443 1444 1445 1446 1447 1448 1449 1450 1451 1452 1453 1454 1455 1456 1457 1458 1459 1460 1461 1462 1463 1464 1465 1466 1467 1468 1469 1470 1471 1472 1473 1474 1475 1476 1477 1478 1479 1480 1481 1482 1483 1484 1485 1486 1487 1488 1489 1490 1491 1492 1493 1494 1495 1496 1497 1498 1499 1500 1501 1502 1503 1504 1505 1506 1507 1508 1509 1510 1511 1512 1513 1514 1515 1516 1517 1518 1519 1520 1521 1522 1523 1524 1525 1526 1527 1528 1529 1530 1531 1532 1533 1534 1535 1536 1537 1538 1539 1540 1541 1542 1543 1544 1545 1546 1547 1548 1549 1550 1551 1552 1553 1554 1555 1556 1557 1558 1559 1560 1561 1562 1563 1564 1565 1566 1567 1568 1569 1570 1571 1572 1573 1574 1575 1576 1577 1578 1579 1580 1581 1582 1583 1584 1585 1586 1587 1588 1589 1590 1591 1592 1593 1594 1595 1596 1597 1598 1599 1600 1601 1602 1603 1604 1605 1606 1607 1608 1609 1610 1611 1612 1613 1614 1615 1616 1617 1618 1619 1620 1621 1622 1623 1624 1625 1626 1627 1628 1629 1630 1631 1632 1633 1634 1635 1636 1637 1638 1639 1640 1641 1642 1643 1644 1645 1646 1647 1648 1649 1650 1651 1652 1653 1654 1655 1656 1657 1658 1659 1660 1661 1662 1663 1664 1665 1666 1667 1668 1669 1670 1671 1672 1673 1674 1675 1676 1677 1678 1679 1680 1681 1682 1683 1684 1685 1686 1687 1688 1689 1690 1691 1692 1693 1694 1695 1696 1697 1698 1699 1700 1701 1702 1703 1704 1705 1706 1707 1708 1709 1710 1711 1712 1713 1714 1715 1716 1717 1718 1719 1720 1721 1722 1723 1724 1725 1726 1727 1728 1729 1730 1731 1732 1733 1734 1735 1736 1737 1738 1739 1740 1741 1742 1743 1744 1745 1746 1747 1748 1749 1750 1751 1752 1753 1754 1755 1756 1757 1758 1759 1760 1761 1762 1763 1764 1765 1766 1767 1768 1769 1770 1771 1772 1773 1774 1775 1776 1777 1778 1779 1780 1781 1782 1783 1784 1785 1786 1787 1788 1789 1790 1791 1792 1793 1794 1795 1796 1797 1798 1799 1800 1801 1802 1803 1804 1805 1806 1807 1808 1809 1810 1811 1812 1813 1814 1815 1816 1817 1818 1819 1820 1821 1822 1823 1824 1825 1826 1827 1828 1829 1830 1831 1832 1833 1834 1835 1836 1837 1838 1839 1840 1841 1842 1843 1844 1845 1846 1847 1848 1849 1850 1851 1852 1853 1854 1855 1856 1857 1858 1859 1860 1861 1862 1863 1864 1865 1866 1867 1868 1869 1870 1871 1872 1873 1874 1875 1876 1877 1878 1879 1880 1881 1882 1883 1884 1885 1886 1887 1888 1889 1890 1891 1892 1893 1894 1895 1896 1897 1898 1899 1900 1901 1902 1903 1904 1905 1906 1907 1908 1909 1910 1911 1912 1913 1914 1915 1916 1917 1918 1919 1920 1921 1922 1923 1924 1925 1926 1927 1928 1929 1930 1931 1932 1933 1934 1935 1936 1937 1938 1939 1940 1941 1942 1943 1944 1945 1946 1947 1948 1949 1950 1951 1952 1953 1954 1955 1956 1957 1958 1959 1960 1961 1962 1963 1964 1965 1966 1967 1968 1969 1970 1971 1972 1973 1974 1975 1976 1977 1978 1979 1980 1981 1982 1983 1984 1985 1986 1987 1988 1989 1990 1991 1992 1993 1994 1995 1996 1997 1998 1999 2000 2001 2002 2003 2004 2005 2006 2007 2008 2009 2010 2011 2012 2013 2014 2015 2016 2017 2018 2019 2020 2021 2022 2023 2024 2025 2026 2027 2028 2029 2030 2031 2032 2033 2034 2035 2036 2037 2038 2039 2040 2041 2042 2043 2044 2045 2046 2047 2048 2049 2050 2051 2052 2053 2054 2055 2056 2057 2058 2059 2060 2061 2062 2063 2064 2065 2066 2067 2068 2069 2070 2071 2072 2073 2074 2075 2076 2077 2078 2079 2080 2081 2082 2083 2084 2085 2086 2087 2088 2089 2090 2091 2092 2093 2094 2095 2096 2097 2098 2099 2100 2101 2102 2103 2104 2105 2106 2107 2108 2109 2110 2111 2112 2113 2114 2115 2116 2117 2118 2119 2120 2121 2122 2123 2124 2125 2126 2127 2128 2129 2130 2131 2132 2133 2134 2135 2136 2137 2138 2139 2140 2141 2142 2143 2144 2145 2146 2147 2148 2149 2150 2151 2152 2153 2154 2155 2156 2157 2158 2159 2160 2161 2162 2163 2164 2165 2166 2167 2168 2169 2170 2171 2172 2173 2174 2175 2176 2177 2178 2179 2180 2181 2182 2183 2184 2185 2186 2187 2188 2189 2190 2191 2192 2193 2194 2195 2196 2197 2198 2199 2200 2201 2202 2203 2204 2205 2206 2207 2208 2209 2210 2211 2212 2213 2214 2215 2216 2217 2218 2219 2220 2221 2222 2223 2224 2225 2226 2227 2228 2229 2230 2231 2232 2233 2234 2235 2236 2237 2238 2239 2240 2241 2242 2243 2244 2245 2246 2247 2248 2249 2250 2251 2252 2253 2254 2255 2256 2257 2258 2259 2260 2261 2262 2263 2264 2265 2266 2267 2268 2269 2270 2271 2272 2273 2274 2275 2276 2277 2278 2279 2280 2281 2282 2283 2284 2285 2286 2287 2288 2289 2290 2291 2292 2293 2294 2295 2296 2297 2298 2299 2300 2301 2302 2303 2304 2305 2306 2307 2308 2309 2310 2311 2312 2313 2314 2315 2316 2317 2318 2319 2320 2321 2322 2323 2324 2325 2326 2327 2328 2329 2330 2331 2332 2333 2334 2335 2336 2337 2338 2339 2340 2341 2342 2343 2344 2345 2346 2347 2348 2349 2350 2351 2352 2353 2354 2355 2356 2357 2358 2359 2360 2361 2362 2363 2364 2365 2366 2367 2368 2369 2370 2371 2372 2373 2374 2375 2376 2377 2378 2379 2380 2381 2382 2383 2384 2385 2386 2387 2388 2389 2390 2391 2392 2393 2394 2395 2396 2397 2398 2399 2400 2401 2402 2403 2404 2405 2406 2407 2408 2409 2410 2411 2412 2413 2414 2415 2416 2417 2418 2419 2420 2421 2422 2423 2424 2425 2426 2427 2428 2429 2430 2431 2432 2433 2434 2435 2436 2437 2438 2439 2440 2441 2442 2443 2444 2445 2446 2447 2448 2449 2450 2451 2452 2453 2454 2455 2456 2457 2458 2459 2460 2461 2462 2463 2464 2465 2466 2467 2468 2469 2470 2471 2472 2473 2474 2475 2476 2477 2478 2479 2480 2481 2482 2483 2484 2485 2486 2487 2488 2489 2490 2491 2492 2493 2494 2495 2496 2497 2498 2499 2500 2501 2502 2503 2504 2505 2506 2507 2508 2509 2510 2511 2512 2513 2514 2515 2516 2517 2518 2519 2520 2521 2522 2523 2524 2525 2526 2527 2528 2529 2530 2531 2532 2533 2534 2535 2536 2537 2538 2539 2540 2541 2542 2543 2544 2545 2546 2547 2548 2549 2550 2551 2552 2553 2554 2555 2556 2557 2558 2559 2560 2561 2562 2563 2564 2565 2566 2567 2568 2569 2570 2571 2572 2573 2574 2575 2576 2577 2578 2579 2580 2581 2582 2583 2584 2585 2586 2587 2588 2589 2590 2591 2592 2593 2594 2595 2596 2597 2598 2599 2600 2601 2602 2603 2604 2605 2606 2607 2608 2609 2610 2611 2612 2613 2614 2615 2616 2617 2618 2619 2620 2621 2622 2623 2624 2625 2626 2627 2628 2629 2630 2631 2632 2633 2634 2635 2636 2637 2638 2639 2640 2641 2642 2643 2644 2645 2646 2647 2648 2649 2650 2651 2652 2653 2654 2655 2656 2657 2658 2659 2660 2661 2662 2663 2664 2665 2666 2667 2668 2669 2670 2671 2672 2673 2674 2675 2676 2677 2678 2679 2680 2681 2682 2683 2684 2685 2686 2687 2688 2689 2690 2691 2692 2693 2694 2695 2696 2697 2698 2699 2700 2701 2702 2703 2704 2705 2706 2707 2708 2709 2710 2711 2712 2713 2714 2715 2716 2717 2718 2719 2720 2721 2722 2723 2724 2725 2726 2727 2728 2729 2730 2731 2732 2733 2734 2735 2736 2737 2738 2739 2740 2741 2742 2743 2744 2745 2746 2747 2748 2749 2750 2751 2752 2753 2754 2755 2756 2757 2758 2759 2760 2761 2762 2763 2764 2765 2766 2767 2768 2769 2770 2771 2772 2773 2774 2775 2776 2777 2778 2779 2780 2781 2782 2783 2784 2785 2786 2787 2788 2789 2790 2791 2792 2793 2794 2795 2796 2797 2798 2799 2800 2801 2802 2803 2804 2805 2806 2807 2808 2809 2810 2811 2812 2813 2814 2815 2816 2817 2818 2819 2820 2821 2822 2823 2824 2825 2826 2827 2828 2829 2830 2831 2832 2833 2834 2835 2836 2837 2838 2839 2840 2841 2842 2843 2844 2845 2846 2847 2848 2849 2850 2851 2852 2853 2854 2855 2856 2857 2858 2859 2860 2861 2862 2863 2864 2865 2866 2867 2868 2869 2870 2871 2872 2873 2874 2875 2876 2877 2878 2879 2880 2881 2882 2883 2884 2885 2886 2887 2888 2889 2890 2891 2892 2893 2894 2895 2896 2897 2898 2899 2900 2901 2902 2903 2904 2905 2906 2907 2908 2909 2910 2911 2912 2913 2914 2915 2916 2917 2918 2919 2920 2921 2922 2923 2924 2925 2926 2927 2928 2929 2930 2931 2932 2933 2934 2935 2936 2937 2938 2939 2940 2941 2942 2943 2944 2945 2946 2947 2948 2949 2950 2951 2952 2953 2954 2955 2956 2957 2958 2959 2960 2961 2962 2963 2964 2965 2966 2967 2968 2969 2970 2971 2972 2973 2974 2975 2976 2977 2978 2979 2980 2981 2982 2983 2984 2985 2986 2987 2988 2989 2990 2991 2992 2993 2994 2995 2996 2997 2998 2999 3000 3001 3002 3003 3004 3005 3006 3007 3008 3009 3010 3011 3012 3013 3014 3015 3016 3017 3018 3019 3020 3021 3022 3023 3024 3025 3026 3027 3028 3029 3030 3031 3032 3033 3034 3035 3036 3037 3038 3039 3040 3041 3042 3043 3044 3045 3046 3047 3048 3049 3050 3051 3052 3053 3054 3055 3056 3057 3058 3059 3060 3061 3062 3063 3064 3065 3066 3067 3068 3069 3070 3071 3072 3073 3074 3075 3076 3077 3078 3079 3080 3081 3082 3083 3084 3085 3086 3087 3088 3089 3090 3091 3092 3093 3094 3095 3096 3097 3098 3099 3100 3101 3102 3103 3104 3105 3106 3107 3108 3109 3110 3111 3112 3113 3114 3115 3116 3117 3118 3119 3120 3121 3122 3123 3124 3125 3126 3127 3128 3129 3130 3131 3132 3133 3134 3135 3136 3137 3138 3139 3140 3141 3142 3143 3144 3145 3146 3147 3148 3149 3150 3151 3152 3153 3154 3155 3156 3157 3158 3159 3160 3161 3162 3163 3164 3165 3166 3167 3168 3169 3170 3171 3172 3173 3174 3175 3176 3177 3178 3179 3180 3181 3182 3183 3184 3185 3186 3187 3188 3189 3190 3191 3192 3193 3194 3195 3196 3197 3198 3199 3200 3201 3202 3203 3204 3205 3206 3207 3208 3209 3210 3211 3212 3213 3214 3215 3216 3217 3218 3219 3220 3221 3222 3223 3224 3225 3226 3227 3228 3229 3230 3231 3232 3233 3234 3235 3236 3237 3238 3239 3240 3241 3242 3243 3244 3245 3246 3247 3248 3249 3250 3251 3252 3253 3254 3255 3256 3257 3258 3259 3260 3261 3262 3263 3264 3265 3266 3267 3268 3269 3270 3271 3272 3273 3274 3275 3276 3277 3278 3279 3280 3281 3282 3283 3284 3285 3286 3287 3288 3289 3290 3291 3292 3293 3294 3295 3296 3297 3298 3299 3300 3301 3302 3303 3304 3305 3306 3307 3308 3309 3310 3311 3312 3313 3314 3315 3316 3317 3318 3319 3320 3321 3322 3323 3324 3325 3326 3327 3328 3329 3330 3331 3332 3333 3334 3335 3336 3337 3338 3339 3340 3341 3342 3343 3344 3345 3346 3347 3348 3349 3350 3351 3352 3353 3354 3355 3356 3357 3358 3359 3360 3361 3362 3363 3364 3365 3366 3367 3368 3369 3370 3371 3372 3373 3374 3375 3376 3377 3378 3379 3380 3381 3382 3383 3384 3385 3386 3387 3388 3389 3390 3391 3392 3393 3394 3395 3396 3397 3398 3399 3400 3401 3402 3403 3404 3405 3406 3407 3408 3409 3410 3411 3412 3413 3414 3415 3416 3417 3418 3419 3420 3421 3422 3423 3424 3425 3426 3427 3428 3429 3430 3431 3432 3433 3434 3435 3436 3437 3438 3439 3440 3441 3442 3443 3444 3445 3446 3447 3448 3449 3450 3451 3452 3453 3454 3455 3456 3457 3458 3459 3460 3461 3462 3463 3464 3465 3466 3467 3468 3469 3470 3471 3472 3473 3474 3475 3476 3477 3478 3479 3480 3481 3482 3483 3484 3485 3486 3487 3488 3489 3490 3491 3492 3493 3494 3495 3496 3497 3498 3499 3500 3501 3502 3503 3504 3505 3506 3507 3508 3509 3510 3511 3512 3513 3514 3515 3516 3517 3518 3519 3520 3521 3522 3523 3524 3525 3526 3527 3528 3529 3530 3531 3532 3533 3534 3535 3536 3537 3538 3539 3540 3541 3542 3543 3544 3545 3546 3547 3548 3549 3550 3551 3552 3553 3554 3555 3556 3557 3558 3559 3560 3561 3562 3563 3564 3565 3566 3567 3568 3569 3570 3571 3572 3573 3574 3575 3576 3577 3578 3579 3580 3581 3582 3583 3584 3585 3586 3587 3588 3589 3590 3591 3592 3593 3594 3595 3596 3597 3598 3599 3600 3601 3602 3603 3604 3605 3606 3607 3608 3609 3610 3611 3612 3613 3614 3615 3616 3617 3618 3619 3620 3621 3622 3623 3624 3625 3626 3627 3628 3629 3630 3631 3632 3633 3634 3635 3636 3637 3638 3639 3640 3641 3642 3643 3644 3645 3646 3647 3648 3649 3650 3651 3652 3653 3654 3655 3656 3657 3658 3659 3660 3661 3662 3663 3664 3665 3666 3667 3668 3669 3670 3671 3672 3673 3674 3675 3676 3677 3678 3679 3680 3681 3682 3683 3684 3685 3686 3687 3688 3689 3690 3691 3692 3693 3694 3695 3696 3697 3698 3699 3700 3701 3702 3703 3704 3705 3706 3707 3708 3709 3710 3711 3712 3713 3714 3715 3716 3717 3718 3719 3720 3721 3722 3723 3724 3725 3726 3727 3728 3729 3730 3731 3732 3733 3734 3735 3736 3737 3738 3739 3740 3741 3742 3743 3744 3745 3746 3747 3748 3749 3750 3751 3752 3753 3754 3755 3756 3757 3758 3759 3760 3761 3762 3763 3764 3765 3766 3767 3768 3769 3770 3771 3772 3773 3774 3775 3776 3777 3778 3779 3780 3781 3782 3783 3784 3785 3786 3787 3788 3789 3790 3791 3792 3793 3794 3795 3796 3797 3798 3799 3800 3801 3802 3803 3804 3805 3806 3807 3808 3809 3810 3811 3812 3813 3814 3815 3816 3817 3818 3819 3820 3821 3822 3823 3824 3825 3826 3827 3828 3829 3830 3831 3832 3833 3834 3835 3836 3837 3838 3839 3840 3841 3842 3843 3844 3845 3846 3847 3848 3849 3850 3851 3852 3853 3854 3855 3856 3857 3858 3859 3860 3861 3862 3863 3864 3865 3866 3867 3868 3869 3870 3871 3872 3873 3874 3875 3876 3877 3878 3879 3880 3881 3882 3883 3884 3885 3886 3887 3888 3889 3890 3891 3892 3893 3894 3895 3896 3897 3898 3899 3900 3901 3902 3903 3904 3905 3906 3907 3908 3909 3910 3911 3912 3913 3914 3915 3916 3917 3918 3919 3920 3921 3922 3923 3924 3925 3926 3927 3928 3929 3930 3931 3932 3933 3934 3935 3936 3937 3938 3939 3940 3941 3942 3943 3944 3945 3946 3947 3948 3949 3950 3951 3952 3953 3954 3955 3956 3957 3958 3959 3960 3961 3962 3963 3964 3965 3966 3967 3968 3969 3970 3971 3972 3973 3974 3975 3976 3977 3978 3979 3980 3981 3982 3983 3984 3985 3986 3987 3988 3989 3990 3991 3992 3993 3994 3995 3996 3997 3998 3999 4000 4001 4002 4003 4004 4005 4006 4007 4008 4009 4010 4011 4012 4013 4014 4015 4016 4017 4018 4019 4020 4021 4022 4023 4024 4025 4026 4027 4028 4029 4030 4031 4032 4033 4034 4035 4036 4037 4038 4039 4040 4041 4042 4043 4044 4045 4046 4047 4048 4049 4050 4051 4052 4053 4054 4055 4056 4057 4058 4059 4060 4061 4062 4063 4064 4065 4066 4067 4068 4069 4070 4071 4072 4073 4074 4075 4076 4077 4078 4079 4080 4081 4082 4083 4084 4085 4086 4087 4088 4089 4090 4091 4092 4093 4094 4095 4096 4097 4098 4099 4100 4101 4102 4103 4104 4105 4106 4107 4108 4109 4110 4111 4112 4113 4114 4115 4116 4117 4118 4119 4120 4121 4122 4123 4124 4125 4126 4127 4128 4129 4130 4131 4132 4133 4134 4135 4136 4137 4138 4139 4140 4141 4142 4143 4144 4145 4146 4147 4148 4149 4150 4151 4152 4153 4154 4155 4156 4157 4158 4159 4160 4161 4162 4163 4164 4165 4166 4167 4168 4169 4170 4171 4172 4173 4174 4175 4176 4177 4178 4179 4180 4181 4182 4183 4184 4185 4186 4187 4188 4189 4190 4191 4192 4193 4194 4195 4196 4197 4198 4199 4200 4201 4202 4203 4204 4205 4206 4207 4208 4209 4210 4211 4212 4213 4214 4215 4216 4217 4218 4219 4220 4221 4222 4223 4224 4225 4226 4227 4228 4229 4230 4231 4232 4233 4234 4235 4236 4237 4238 4239 4240 4241 4242 4243 4244 4245 4246 4247 4248 4249 4250 4251 4252 4253 4254 4255 4256 4257 4258 4259 4260 4261 4262 4263 4264 4265 4266 4267 4268 4269 4270 4271 4272 4273 4274 4275 4276 4277 4278 4279 4280 4281 4282 4283 4284 4285 4286 4287 4288 4289 4290 4291 4292 4293 4294 4295 4296 4297 4298 4299 4300 4301 4302 4303 4304 4305 4306 4307 4308 4309 4310 4311 4312 4313 4314 4315 4316 4317 4318 4319 4320 4321 4322 4323 4324 4325 4326 4327 4328 4329 4330 4331 4332 4333 4334 4335 4336 4337 4338 4339 4340 4341 4342 4343 4344 4345 4346 4347 4348 4349 4350 4351 4352 4353 4354 4355 4356 4357 4358 4359 4360 4361 4362 4363 4364 4365 4366 4367 4368 4369 4370 4371 4372 4373 4374 4375 4376 4377 4378 4379 4380 4381 4382 4383 4384 4385 4386 4387 4388 4389 4390 4391 4392 4393 4394 4395 4396 4397 4398 4399 4400 4401 4402 4403 4404 4405 4406 4407 4408 4409 4410 4411 4412 4413 4414 4415 4416 4417 4418 4419 4420 4421 4422 4423 4424 4425 4426 4427 4428 4429 4430 4431 4432 4433 4434 4435 4436 4437 4438 4439 4440 4441 4442 4443 4444 4445 4446 4447 4448 4449 4450 4451 4452 4453 4454 4455 4456 4457 4458 4459 4460 4461 4462 4463 4464 4465 4466 4467 4468 4469 4470 4471 4472 4473 4474 4475 4476 4477 4478 4479 4480 4481 4482 4483 4484 4485 4486 4487 4488 4489 4490 4491 4492 4493 4494 4495 4496 4497 4498 4499 4500 4501 4502 4503 4504 4505 4506 4507 4508 4509 4510 4511 4512 4513 4514 4515 4516 4517 4518 4519 4520 4521 4522 4523 4524 4525 4526 4527 4528 4529 4530 4531 4532 4533 4534 4535 4536 4537 4538 4539 4540 4541 4542 4543 4544 4545 4546 4547 4548 4549 4550 4551 4552 4553 4554 4555 4556 4557 4558 4559 4560 4561 4562 4563 4564 4565 4566 4567 4568 4569 4570 4571 4572 4573 4574 4575 4576 4577 4578 4579 4580 4581 4582 4583 4584 4585 4586 4587 4588 4589 4590 4591 4592 4593 4594 4595 4596 4597 4598 4599 4600 4601 4602 4603 4604 4605 4606 4607 4608 4609 4610 4611 4612 4613 4614 4615 4616 4617 4618 4619 4620 4621 4622 4623 4624 4625 4626 4627 4628 4629 4630 4631 4632 4633 4634 4635 4636 4637 4638 4639 4640 4641 4642 4643 4644 4645 4646 4647 4648 4649 4650 4651 4652 4653 4654 4655 4656 4657 4658 4659 4660 4661 4662 4663 4664 4665 4666 4667 4668 4669 4670 4671 4672 4673 4674 4675 4676 4677 4678 4679 4680 4681 4682 4683 4684 4685 4686 4687 4688 4689 4690 4691 4692 4693 4694 4695 4696 4697 4698 4699 4700 4701 4702 4703 4704 4705 4706 4707 4708 4709 4710 4711 4712 4713 4714 4715 4716 4717 4718 4719 4720 4721 4722 4723 4724 4725 4726 4727 4728 4729 4730 4731 4732 4733 4734 4735 4736 4737 4738 4739 4740 4741 4742 4743 4744 4745 4746 4747 4748 4749 4750 4751 4752 4753 4754 4755 4756 4757 4758 4759 4760 4761 4762 4763 4764 4765 4766 4767 4768 4769 4770 4771 4772 4773 4774 4775 4776 4777 4778 4779 4780 4781 4782 4783 4784 4785 4786 4787 4788 4789 4790 4791 4792 4793 4794 4795 4796 4797 4798 4799 4800 4801 4802 4803 4804 4805 4806 4807 4808 4809 4810 4811 4812 4813 4814 4815 4816 4817 4818 4819 4820 4821 4822 4823 4824 4825 4826 4827 4828 4829 4830 4831 4832 4833 4834 4835 4836 4837 4838 4839 4840 4841 4842 4843 4844 4845 4846 4847 4848 4849 4850 4851 4852 4853 4854 4855 4856 4857 4858 4859 4860 4861 4862 4863 4864 4865 4866 4867 4868 4869 4870 4871 4872 4873 4874 4875 4876 4877 4878 4879 4880 4881 4882 4883 4884 4885 4886 4887 4888 4889 4890 4891 4892 4893 4894 4895 4896 4897 4898 4899 4900 4901 4902 4903 4904 4905 4906 4907 4908 4909 4910 4911 4912 4913 4914 4915 4916 4917 4918 4919 4920 4921 4922 4923 4924 4925 4926 4927 4928 4929 4930 4931 4932 4933 4934 4935 4936 4937 4938 4939 4940 4941 4942 4943 4944 4945 4946 4947 4948 4949 4950 4951 4952 4953 4954 4955 4956 4957 4958 4959 4960 4961 4962 4963 4964 4965 4966 4967 4968 4969 4970 4971 4972 4973 4974 4975 4976 4977 4978 4979 4980 4981 4982 4983 4984 4985 4986 4987 4988 4989 4990 4991 4992 4993 4994 4995 4996 4997 4998 4999 5000 5001 5002 5003 5004 5005 5006 5007 5008 5009 5010 5011 5012 5013 5014 5015 5016 5017 5018 5019 5020 5021 5022 5023 5024 5025 5026 5027 5028 5029 5030 5031 5032 5033 5034 5035 5036 5037 5038 5039 5040 5041 5042 5043 5044 5045 5046 5047 5048 5049 5050 5051 5052 5053 5054 5055 5056 5057 5058 5059 5060 5061 5062 5063 5064 5065 5066 5067 5068 5069 5070 5071 5072 5073 5074 5075 5076 5077 5078 5079 5080 5081 5082 5083 5084 5085 5086 5087 5088 5089 5090 5091 5092 5093 5094 5095 5096 5097 5098 5099 5100 5101 5102 5103 5104 5105 5106 5107 5108 5109 5110 5111 5112 5113 5114 5115 5116 5117 5118 5119 5120 5121 5122 5123 5124 5125 5126 5127 5128 5129 5130 5131 5132 5133 5134 5135 5136 5137 5138 5139 5140 5141 5142 5143 5144 5145 5146 5147 5148 5149 5150 5151 5152 5153 5154 5155 5156 5157 5158 5159 5160 5161 5162 5163 5164 5165 5166 5167 5168 5169 5170 5171 5172 5173 5174 5175 5176 5177 5178 5179 5180 5181 5182 5183 5184 5185 5186 5187 5188 5189 5190 5191 5192 5193 5194 5195 5196 5197 5198 5199 5200 5201 5202 5203 5204 5205 5206 5207 5208 5209 5210 5211 5212 5213 5214 5215 5216 5217 5218 5219 5220 5221 5222 5223 5224 5225 5226 5227 5228 5229 5230 5231 5232 5233 5234 5235 5236 5237 5238 5239 5240 5241 5242 5243 5244 5245 5246 5247 5248 5249 5250 5251 5252 5253 5254 5255 5256 5257 5258 5259 5260 5261 5262 5263 5264 5265 5266 5267 5268 5269 5270 5271 5272 5273 5274 5275 5276 5277 5278 5279 5280 5281 5282 5283 5284 5285 5286 5287 5288 5289 5290 5291 5292 5293 5294 5295 5296 5297 5298 5299 5300 5301 5302 5303 5304 5305 5306 5307 5308 5309 5310 5311 5312 5313 5314 5315 5316 5317 5318 5319 5320 5321 5322 5323 5324 5325 5326 5327 5328 5329 5330 5331 5332 5333 5334 5335 5336 5337 5338 5339 5340 5341 5342 5343 5344 5345 5346 5347 5348 5349 5350 5351 5352 5353 5354 5355 5356 5357 5358 5359 5360 5361 5362 5363 5364 5365 5366 5367 5368 5369 5370 5371 5372 5373 5374 5375 5376 5377 5378 5379 5380 5381 5382 5383 5384 5385 5386 5387 5388 5389 5390 5391 5392 5393 5394 5395 5396 5397 5398 5399 5400 5401 5402 5403 5404 5405 5406 5407 5408 5409 5410 5411 5412 5413 5414 5415 5416 5417 5418 5419 5420 5421 5422 5423 5424 5425 5426 5427 5428 5429 5430 5431 5432 5433 5434 5435 5436 5437 5438 5439 5440 5441 5442 5443 5444 5445 5446 5447 5448 5449 5450 5451 5452 5453 5454 5455 5456 5457 5458 5459 5460 5461 5462 5463 5464 5465 5466 5467 5468 5469 5470 5471 5472 5473 5474 5475 5476 5477 5478 5479 5480 5481 5482 5483 5484 5485 5486 5487 5488 5489 5490 5491 5492 5493 5494 5495 5496 5497 5498 5499 5500 5501 5502 5503 5504 5505 5506 5507 5508 5509 5510 5511 5512 5513 5514 5515 5516 5517 5518 5519 5520 5521 5522 5523 5524 5525 5526 5527 5528 5529 5530 5531 5532 5533 5534 5535 5536 5537 5538 5539 5540 5541 5542 5543 5544 5545 5546 5547 5548 5549 5550 5551 5552 5553 5554 5555 5556 5557 5558 5559 5560 5561 5562 5563 5564 5565 5566 5567 5568 5569 5570 5571 5572 5573 5574 5575 5576 5577 5578 5579 5580 5581 5582 5583 5584 5585 5586 5587 5588 5589 5590 5591 5592 5593 5594 5595 5596 5597 5598 5599 5600 5601 5602 5603 5604 5605 5606 5607 5608 5609 5610 5611 5612 5613 5614 5615 5616 5617 5618 5619 5620 5621 5622 5623 5624 5625 5626 5627 5628 5629 5630 5631 5632 5633 5634 5635 5636 5637 5638 5639 5640 5641 5642 5643 5644 5645 5646 5647 5648 5649 5650 5651 5652 5653 5654 5655 5656 5657 5658 5659 5660 5661 5662 5663 5664 5665 5666 5667 5668 5669 5670 5671 5672 5673 5674 5675 5676 5677 5678 5679 5680 5681 5682 5683 5684 5685 5686 5687 5688 5689 5690 5691 5692 5693 5694 5695 5696 5697 5698 5699 5700 5701 5702 5703 5704 5705 5706 5707 5708 5709 5710 5711 5712 5713 5714 5715 5716 5717 5718 5719 5720 5721 5722 5723 5724 5725 5726 5727 5728 5729 5730 5731 5732 5733 5734 5735 5736 5737 5738 5739 5740 5741 5742 5743 5744 5745 5746 5747 5748 5749 5750 5751 5752 5753 5754 5755 5756 5757 5758 5759 5760 5761 5762 5763 5764 5765 5766 5767 5768 5769 5770 5771 5772 5773 5774 5775 5776 5777 5778 5779 5780 5781 5782 5783 5784 5785 5786 5787 5788 5789 5790 5791 5792 5793 5794 5795 5796 5797 5798 5799 5800 5801 5802 5803 5804 5805 5806 5807 5808 5809 5810 5811 5812 5813 5814 5815 5816 5817 5818 5819 5820 5821 5822 5823 5824 5825 5826 5827 5828 5829 5830 5831 5832 5833 5834 5835 5836 5837 5838 5839 5840 5841 5842 5843 5844 5845 5846 5847 5848 5849 5850 5851 5852 5853 5854 5855 5856 5857 5858 5859 5860 5861 5862 5863 5864 5865 5866 5867 5868 5869 5870 5871 5872 5873 5874 5875 5876 5877 5878 5879 5880 5881 5882 5883 5884 5885 5886 5887 5888 5889 5890 5891 5892 5893 5894 5895 5896 5897 5898 5899 5900 5901 5902 5903 5904 5905 5906 5907 5908 5909 5910 5911 5912 5913 5914 5915 5916 5917 5918 5919 5920 5921 5922 5923 5924 5925 5926 5927 5928 5929 5930 5931 5932 5933 5934 5935 5936 5937 5938 5939 5940 5941 5942 5943 5944 5945 5946 5947 5948 5949 5950 5951 5952 5953 5954 5955 5956 5957 5958 5959 5960 5961 5962 5963 5964 5965 5966 5967 5968 5969 5970 5971 5972 5973 5974 5975 5976 5977 5978 5979 5980 5981 5982 5983 5984 5985 5986 5987 5988 5989 5990 5991 5992 5993 5994 5995 5996 5997 5998 5999 6000 6001 6002 6003 6004 6005 6006 6007 6008 6009 6010 6011 6012 6013 6014 6015 6016 6017 6018 6019 6020 6021 6022 6023 6024 6025 6026 6027 6028 6029 6030 6031 6032 6033 6034 6035 6036 6037 6038 6039 6040 6041 6042 6043 6044 6045 6046 6047 6048 6049 6050 6051 6052 6053 6054 6055 6056 6057 6058 6059 6060 6061 6062 6063 6064 6065 6066 6067 6068 6069 6070 6071 6072 6073 6074 6075 6076 6077 6078 6079 6080 6081 6082 6083 6084 6085 6086 6087 6088 6089 6090 6091 6092 6093 6094 6095 6096 6097 6098 6099 6100 6101 6102 6103 6104 6105 6106 6107 6108 6109 6110 6111 6112 6113 6114 6115 6116 6117 6118 6119 6120 6121 6122 6123 6124 6125 6126 6127 6128 6129 6130 6131 6132 6133 6134 6135 6136 6137 6138 6139 6140 6141 6142 6143 6144 6145 6146 6147 6148 6149 6150 6151 6152 6153 6154 6155 6156 6157 6158 6159 6160 6161 6162 6163 6164 6165 6166 6167 6168 6169 6170 6171 6172 6173 6174 6175 6176 6177 6178 6179 6180 6181 6182 6183 6184 6185 6186 6187 6188 6189 6190 6191 6192 6193 6194 6195 6196 6197 6198 6199 6200 6201 6202 6203 6204 6205 6206 6207 6208 6209 6210 6211 6212 6213 6214 6215 6216 6217 6218 6219 6220 6221 6222 6223 6224 6225 6226 6227 6228 6229 6230 6231 6232 6233 6234 6235 6236 6237 6238 6239 6240 6241 6242 6243 6244 6245 6246 6247 6248 6249 6250 6251 6252 6253 6254 6255 6256 6257 6258 6259 6260 6261 6262 6263 6264 6265 6266 6267 6268 6269 6270 6271 6272 6273 6274 6275 6276 6277 6278 6279 6280 6281 6282 6283 6284 6285 6286 6287 6288 6289 6290 6291 6292 6293 6294 6295 6296 6297 6298 6299 6300 6301 6302 6303 6304 6305 6306 6307 6308 6309 6310 6311 6312 6313 6314 6315 6316 6317 6318 6319 6320 6321 6322 6323 6324 6325 6326 6327 6328 6329 6330 6331 6332 6333 6334 6335 6336 6337 6338 6339 6340 6341 6342 6343 6344 6345 6346 6347 6348 6349 6350 6351 6352 6353 6354 6355 6356 6357 6358 6359 6360 6361 6362 6363 6364 6365 6366 6367 6368 6369 6370 6371 6372 6373 6374 6375 6376 6377 6378 6379 6380 6381 6382 6383 6384 6385 6386 6387 6388 6389 6390 6391 6392 6393 6394 6395 6396 6397 6398 6399 6400 6401 6402 6403 6404 6405 6406 6407 6408 6409 6410 6411 6412 6413 6414 6415 6416 6417 6418 6419 6420 6421 6422 6423 6424 6425 6426 6427 6428 6429 6430 6431 6432 6433 6434 6435 6436 6437 6438 6439 6440 6441 6442 6443 6444 6445 6446 6447 6448 6449 6450 6451 6452 6453 6454 6455 6456 6457 6458 6459 6460 6461 6462 6463 6464 6465 6466 6467 6468 6469 6470 6471 6472 6473 6474 6475 6476 6477 6478 6479 6480 6481 6482 6483 6484 6485 6486 6487 6488 6489 6490 6491 6492 6493 6494 6495 6496 6497 6498 6499 6500 6501 6502 6503 6504 6505 6506 6507 6508 6509 6510 6511 6512 6513 6514 6515 6516 6517 6518 6519 6520 6521 6522 6523 6524 6525 6526 6527 6528 6529 6530 6531 6532 6533 6534 6535 6536 6537 6538 6539 6540 6541 6542 6543 6544 6545 6546 6547 6548 6549 6550 6551 6552 6553 6554 6555 6556 6557 6558 6559 6560 6561 6562 6563 6564 6565 6566 6567 6568 6569 6570 6571 6572 6573 6574 6575 6576 6577 6578 6579 6580 6581 6582 6583 6584 6585 6586 6587 6588 6589 6590 6591 6592 6593 6594 6595 6596 6597 6598 6599 6600 6601 6602 6603 6604 6605 6606 6607 6608 6609 6610 6611 6612 6613 6614 6615 6616 6617 6618 6619 6620 6621 6622 6623 6624 6625 6626 6627 6628 6629 6630 6631 6632 6633 6634 6635 6636 6637 6638 6639 6640 6641 6642 6643 6644 6645 6646 6647 6648 6649 6650 6651 6652 6653 6654 6655 6656 6657 6658 6659 6660 6661 6662 6663 6664 6665 6666 6667 6668 6669 6670 6671 6672 6673 6674 6675 6676 6677 6678 6679 6680 6681 6682 6683 6684 6685 6686 6687 6688 6689 6690 6691 6692 6693 6694 6695 6696 6697 6698 6699 6700 6701 6702 6703 6704 6705 6706 6707 6708 6709 6710 6711 6712 6713 6714 6715 6716 6717 6718 6719 6720 6721 6722 6723 6724 6725 6726 6727 6728 6729 6730 6731 6732 6733 6734 6735 6736 6737 6738 6739 6740 6741 6742 6743 6744 6745 6746 6747 6748 6749 6750 6751 6752 6753 6754 6755 6756 6757 6758 6759 6760 6761 6762 6763 6764 6765 6766 6767 6768 6769 6770 6771 6772 6773 6774 6775 6776 6777 6778 6779 6780 6781 6782 6783 6784 6785 6786 6787 6788 6789 6790 6791 6792 6793 6794 6795 6796 6797 6798 6799 6800 6801 6802 6803 6804 6805 6806 6807 6808 6809 6810 6811 6812 6813 6814 6815 6816 6817 6818 6819 6820 6821 6822 6823 6824 6825 6826 6827 6828 6829 6830 6831 6832 6833 6834 6835 6836 6837 6838 6839 6840 6841 6842 6843 6844 6845 6846 6847 6848 6849 6850 6851 6852 6853 6854 6855 6856 6857 6858 6859 6860 6861 6862 6863 6864 6865 6866 6867 6868 6869 6870 6871 6872 6873 6874 6875 6876 6877 6878 6879 6880 6881 6882 6883 6884 6885 6886 6887 6888 6889 6890 6891 6892 6893 6894 6895 6896 6897 6898 6899 6900 6901 6902 6903 6904 6905 6906 6907 6908 6909 6910 6911 6912 6913 6914 6915 6916 6917 6918 6919 6920 6921 6922 6923 6924 6925 6926 6927 6928 6929 6930 6931 6932 6933 6934 6935 6936 6937 6938 6939 6940 6941 6942 6943 6944 6945 6946 6947 6948 6949 6950 6951 6952 6953 6954 6955 6956 6957 6958 6959 6960 6961 6962 6963 6964 6965 6966 6967 6968 6969 6970 6971 6972 6973 6974 6975 6976 6977 6978 6979 6980 6981 6982 6983 6984 6985 6986 6987 6988 6989 6990 6991 6992 6993 6994 6995 6996 6997 6998 6999 7000 7001 7002 7003 7004 7005 7006 7007 7008 7009 7010 7011 7012 7013 7014 7015 7016 7017 7018 7019 7020 7021 7022 7023 7024 7025 7026 7027 7028 7029 7030 7031 7032 7033 7034 7035 7036 7037 7038 7039 7040 7041 7042 7043 7044 7045 7046 7047 7048 7049 7050 7051 7052 7053 7054 7055 7056 7057 7058 7059 7060 7061 7062 7063 7064 7065 7066 7067 7068 7069 7070 7071 7072 7073 7074 7075 7076 7077 7078 7079 7080 7081 7082 7083 7084 7085 7086 7087 7088 7089 7090 7091 7092 7093 7094 7095 7096 7097 7098 7099 7100 7101 7102 7103 7104 7105 7106 7107 7108 7109 7110 7111 7112 7113 7114 7115 7116 7117 7118 7119 7120 7121 7122 7123 7124 7125 7126 7127 7128 7129 7130 7131 7132 7133 7134 7135 7136 7137 7138 7139 7140 7141 7142 7143 7144 7145 7146 7147 7148 7149 7150 7151 7152 7153 7154 7155 7156 7157 7158 7159 7160 7161 7162 7163 7164 7165 7166 7167 7168 7169 7170 7171 7172 7173 7174 7175 7176 7177 7178 7179 7180 7181 7182 7183 7184 7185 7186 7187 7188 7189 7190 7191 7192 7193 7194 7195 7196 7197 7198 7199 7200 7201 7202 7203 7204 7205 7206 7207 7208 7209 7210 7211 7212 7213 7214 7215 7216 7217 7218 7219 7220 7221 7222 7223 7224 7225 7226 7227 7228 7229 7230 7231 7232 7233 7234 7235 7236 7237 7238 7239 7240 7241 7242 7243 7244 7245 7246 7247 7248 7249 7250 7251 7252 7253 7254 7255 7256 7257 7258 7259 7260 7261 7262 7263 7264 7265 7266 7267 7268 7269 7270 7271 7272 7273 7274 7275 7276 7277 7278 7279 7280 7281 7282 7283 7284 7285 7286 7287 7288 7289 7290 7291 7292 7293 7294 7295 7296 7297 7298 7299 7300 7301 7302 7303 7304 7305 7306 7307 7308 7309 7310 7311 7312 7313 7314 7315 7316 7317 7318 7319 7320 7321 7322 7323 7324 7325 7326 7327 7328 7329 7330 7331 7332 7333 7334 7335 7336 7337 7338 7339 7340 7341 7342 7343 7344 7345 7346 7347 7348 7349 7350 7351 7352 7353 7354 7355 7356 7357 7358 7359 7360 7361 7362 7363 7364 7365 7366 7367 7368 7369 7370 7371 7372 7373 7374 7375 7376 7377 7378 7379 7380 7381 7382 7383 7384 7385 7386 7387 7388 7389 7390 7391 7392 7393 7394 7395 7396 7397 7398 7399 7400 7401 7402 7403 7404 7405 7406 7407 7408 7409 7410 7411 7412 7413 7414 7415 7416 7417 7418 7419 7420 7421 7422 7423 7424 7425 7426 7427 7428 7429 7430 7431 7432 7433 7434 7435 7436 7437 7438 7439 7440 7441 7442 7443 7444 7445 7446 7447 7448 7449 7450 7451 7452 7453 7454 7455 7456 7457 7458 7459 7460 7461 7462 7463 7464 7465 7466 7467 7468 7469 7470 7471 7472 7473 7474 7475 7476 7477 7478 7479 7480 7481 7482 7483 7484 7485 7486 7487 7488 7489 7490 7491 7492 7493 7494 7495 7496 7497 7498 7499 7500 7501 7502 7503 7504 7505 7506 7507 7508 7509 7510 7511 7512 7513 7514 7515 7516 7517 7518 7519 7520 7521 7522 7523 7524 7525 7526 7527 7528 7529 7530 7531 7532 7533 7534 7535 7536 7537 7538 7539 7540 7541 7542 7543 7544 7545 7546 7547 7548 7549 7550 7551 7552 7553 7554 7555 7556 7557 7558 7559 7560 7561 7562 7563 7564 7565 7566 7567 7568 7569 7570 7571 7572 7573 7574 7575 7576 7577 7578 7579 7580 7581 7582 7583 7584 7585 7586 7587 7588 7589 7590 7591 7592 7593 7594 7595 7596 7597 7598 7599 7600 7601 7602 7603 7604 7605 7606 7607 7608 7609 7610 7611 7612 7613 7614 7615 7616 7617 7618 7619 7620 7621 7622 7623 7624 7625 7626 7627 7628 7629 7630 7631 7632 7633 7634 7635 7636 7637 7638 7639 7640 7641 7642 7643 7644 7645 7646 7647 7648 7649 7650 7651 7652 7653 7654 7655 7656 7657 7658 7659 7660 7661 7662 7663 7664 7665 7666 7667 7668 7669 7670 7671 7672 7673 7674 7675 7676 7677 7678 7679 7680 7681 7682 7683 7684 7685 7686 7687 7688 7689 7690 7691 7692 7693 7694 7695 7696 7697 7698 7699 7700 7701 7702 7703 7704 7705 7706 7707 7708 7709 7710 7711 7712 7713 7714 7715 7716 7717 7718 7719 7720 7721 7722 7723 7724 7725 7726 7727 7728 7729 7730 7731 7732 7733 7734 7735 7736
|
// dear imgui, v1.76
// (widgets code)
/*
Index of this file:
// [SECTION] Forward Declarations
// [SECTION] Widgets: Text, etc.
// [SECTION] Widgets: Main (Button, Image, Checkbox, RadioButton, ProgressBar, Bullet, etc.)
// [SECTION] Widgets: Low-level Layout helpers (Spacing, Dummy, NewLine, Separator, etc.)
// [SECTION] Widgets: ComboBox
// [SECTION] Data Type and Data Formatting Helpers
// [SECTION] Widgets: DragScalar, DragFloat, DragInt, etc.
// [SECTION] Widgets: SliderScalar, SliderFloat, SliderInt, etc.
// [SECTION] Widgets: InputScalar, InputFloat, InputInt, etc.
// [SECTION] Widgets: InputText, InputTextMultiline
// [SECTION] Widgets: ColorEdit, ColorPicker, ColorButton, etc.
// [SECTION] Widgets: TreeNode, CollapsingHeader, etc.
// [SECTION] Widgets: Selectable
// [SECTION] Widgets: ListBox
// [SECTION] Widgets: PlotLines, PlotHistogram
// [SECTION] Widgets: Value helpers
// [SECTION] Widgets: MenuItem, BeginMenu, EndMenu, etc.
// [SECTION] Widgets: BeginTabBar, EndTabBar, etc.
// [SECTION] Widgets: BeginTabItem, EndTabItem, etc.
// [SECTION] Widgets: Columns, BeginColumns, EndColumns, etc.
*/
#if defined(_MSC_VER) && !defined(_CRT_SECURE_NO_WARNINGS)
#define _CRT_SECURE_NO_WARNINGS
#endif
#include "imgui.h"
#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE
#ifndef IMGUI_DEFINE_MATH_OPERATORS
#define IMGUI_DEFINE_MATH_OPERATORS
#endif
#include "imgui_internal.h"
#include <ctype.h> // toupper
#if defined(_MSC_VER) && _MSC_VER <= 1500 // MSVC 2008 or earlier
#include <stddef.h> // intptr_t
#else
#include <stdint.h> // intptr_t
#endif
// Visual Studio warnings
#ifdef _MSC_VER
#pragma warning (disable: 4127) // condition expression is constant
#pragma warning (disable: 4996) // 'This function or variable may be unsafe': strcpy, strdup, sprintf, vsnprintf, sscanf, fopen
#if defined(_MSC_VER) && _MSC_VER >= 1922 // MSVC 2019 16.2 or later
#pragma warning (disable: 5054) // operator '|': deprecated between enumerations of different types
#endif
#endif
// Clang/GCC warnings with -Weverything
#if defined(__clang__)
#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wold-style-cast" // warning : use of old-style cast // yes, they are more terse.
#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wfloat-equal" // warning : comparing floating point with == or != is unsafe // storing and comparing against same constants (typically 0.0f) is ok.
#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wformat-nonliteral" // warning : format string is not a string literal // passing non-literal to vsnformat(). yes, user passing incorrect format strings can crash the code.
#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wsign-conversion" // warning : implicit conversion changes signedness //
#if __has_warning("-Wzero-as-null-pointer-constant")
#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wzero-as-null-pointer-constant" // warning : zero as null pointer constant // some standard header variations use #define NULL 0
#endif
#if __has_warning("-Wdouble-promotion")
#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wdouble-promotion" // warning: implicit conversion from 'float' to 'double' when passing argument to function // using printf() is a misery with this as C++ va_arg ellipsis changes float to double.
#endif
#if __has_warning("-Wdeprecated-enum-enum-conversion")
#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wdeprecated-enum-enum-conversion" // warning: bitwise operation between different enumeration types ('XXXFlags_' and 'XXXFlagsPrivate_') is deprecated
#endif
#elif defined(__GNUC__)
#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wpragmas" // warning: unknown option after '#pragma GCC diagnostic' kind
#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wformat-nonliteral" // warning: format not a string literal, format string not checked
#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wclass-memaccess" // [__GNUC__ >= 8] warning: 'memset/memcpy' clearing/writing an object of type 'xxxx' with no trivial copy-assignment; use assignment or value-initialization instead
#endif
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// Data
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// Those MIN/MAX values are not define because we need to point to them
static const signed char IM_S8_MIN = -128;
static const signed char IM_S8_MAX = 127;
static const unsigned char IM_U8_MIN = 0;
static const unsigned char IM_U8_MAX = 0xFF;
static const signed short IM_S16_MIN = -32768;
static const signed short IM_S16_MAX = 32767;
static const unsigned short IM_U16_MIN = 0;
static const unsigned short IM_U16_MAX = 0xFFFF;
static const ImS32 IM_S32_MIN = INT_MIN; // (-2147483647 - 1), (0x80000000);
static const ImS32 IM_S32_MAX = INT_MAX; // (2147483647), (0x7FFFFFFF)
static const ImU32 IM_U32_MIN = 0;
static const ImU32 IM_U32_MAX = UINT_MAX; // (0xFFFFFFFF)
#ifdef LLONG_MIN
static const ImS64 IM_S64_MIN = LLONG_MIN; // (-9223372036854775807ll - 1ll);
static const ImS64 IM_S64_MAX = LLONG_MAX; // (9223372036854775807ll);
#else
static const ImS64 IM_S64_MIN = -9223372036854775807LL - 1;
static const ImS64 IM_S64_MAX = 9223372036854775807LL;
#endif
static const ImU64 IM_U64_MIN = 0;
#ifdef ULLONG_MAX
static const ImU64 IM_U64_MAX = ULLONG_MAX; // (0xFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFull);
#else
static const ImU64 IM_U64_MAX = (2ULL * 9223372036854775807LL + 1);
#endif
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// [SECTION] Forward Declarations
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// For InputTextEx()
static bool InputTextFilterCharacter(unsigned int* p_char, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags, ImGuiInputTextCallback callback, void* user_data);
static int InputTextCalcTextLenAndLineCount(const char* text_begin, const char** out_text_end);
static ImVec2 InputTextCalcTextSizeW(const ImWchar* text_begin, const ImWchar* text_end, const ImWchar** remaining = NULL, ImVec2* out_offset = NULL, bool stop_on_new_line = false);
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// [SECTION] Widgets: Text, etc.
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// - TextEx() [Internal]
// - TextUnformatted()
// - Text()
// - TextV()
// - TextColored()
// - TextColoredV()
// - TextDisabled()
// - TextDisabledV()
// - TextWrapped()
// - TextWrappedV()
// - LabelText()
// - LabelTextV()
// - BulletText()
// - BulletTextV()
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
void ImGui::TextEx(const char* text, const char* text_end, ImGuiTextFlags flags)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
IM_ASSERT(text != NULL);
const char* text_begin = text;
if (text_end == NULL)
text_end = text + strlen(text); // FIXME-OPT
const ImVec2 text_pos(window->DC.CursorPos.x, window->DC.CursorPos.y + window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset);
const float wrap_pos_x = window->DC.TextWrapPos;
const bool wrap_enabled = (wrap_pos_x >= 0.0f);
if (text_end - text > 2000 && !wrap_enabled)
{
// Long text!
// Perform manual coarse clipping to optimize for long multi-line text
// - From this point we will only compute the width of lines that are visible. Optimization only available when word-wrapping is disabled.
// - We also don't vertically center the text within the line full height, which is unlikely to matter because we are likely the biggest and only item on the line.
// - We use memchr(), pay attention that well optimized versions of those str/mem functions are much faster than a casually written loop.
const char* line = text;
const float line_height = GetTextLineHeight();
ImVec2 text_size(0,0);
// Lines to skip (can't skip when logging text)
ImVec2 pos = text_pos;
if (!g.LogEnabled)
{
int lines_skippable = (int)((window->ClipRect.Min.y - text_pos.y) / line_height);
if (lines_skippable > 0)
{
int lines_skipped = 0;
while (line < text_end && lines_skipped < lines_skippable)
{
const char* line_end = (const char*)memchr(line, '\n', text_end - line);
if (!line_end)
line_end = text_end;
if ((flags & ImGuiTextFlags_NoWidthForLargeClippedText) == 0)
text_size.x = ImMax(text_size.x, CalcTextSize(line, line_end).x);
line = line_end + 1;
lines_skipped++;
}
pos.y += lines_skipped * line_height;
}
}
// Lines to render
if (line < text_end)
{
ImRect line_rect(pos, pos + ImVec2(FLT_MAX, line_height));
while (line < text_end)
{
if (IsClippedEx(line_rect, 0, false))
break;
const char* line_end = (const char*)memchr(line, '\n', text_end - line);
if (!line_end)
line_end = text_end;
text_size.x = ImMax(text_size.x, CalcTextSize(line, line_end).x);
RenderText(pos, line, line_end, false);
line = line_end + 1;
line_rect.Min.y += line_height;
line_rect.Max.y += line_height;
pos.y += line_height;
}
// Count remaining lines
int lines_skipped = 0;
while (line < text_end)
{
const char* line_end = (const char*)memchr(line, '\n', text_end - line);
if (!line_end)
line_end = text_end;
if ((flags & ImGuiTextFlags_NoWidthForLargeClippedText) == 0)
text_size.x = ImMax(text_size.x, CalcTextSize(line, line_end).x);
line = line_end + 1;
lines_skipped++;
}
pos.y += lines_skipped * line_height;
}
text_size.y = (pos - text_pos).y;
ImRect bb(text_pos, text_pos + text_size);
ItemSize(text_size, 0.0f);
ItemAdd(bb, 0);
}
else
{
const float wrap_width = wrap_enabled ? CalcWrapWidthForPos(window->DC.CursorPos, wrap_pos_x) : 0.0f;
const ImVec2 text_size = CalcTextSize(text_begin, text_end, false, wrap_width);
ImRect bb(text_pos, text_pos + text_size);
ItemSize(text_size, 0.0f);
if (!ItemAdd(bb, 0))
return;
// Render (we don't hide text after ## in this end-user function)
RenderTextWrapped(bb.Min, text_begin, text_end, wrap_width);
}
}
void ImGui::TextUnformatted(const char* text, const char* text_end)
{
TextEx(text, text_end, ImGuiTextFlags_NoWidthForLargeClippedText);
}
void ImGui::Text(const char* fmt, ...)
{
va_list args;
va_start(args, fmt);
TextV(fmt, args);
va_end(args);
}
void ImGui::TextV(const char* fmt, va_list args)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
const char* text_end = g.TempBuffer + ImFormatStringV(g.TempBuffer, IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.TempBuffer), fmt, args);
TextEx(g.TempBuffer, text_end, ImGuiTextFlags_NoWidthForLargeClippedText);
}
void ImGui::TextColored(const ImVec4& col, const char* fmt, ...)
{
va_list args;
va_start(args, fmt);
TextColoredV(col, fmt, args);
va_end(args);
}
void ImGui::TextColoredV(const ImVec4& col, const char* fmt, va_list args)
{
PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, col);
TextV(fmt, args);
PopStyleColor();
}
void ImGui::TextDisabled(const char* fmt, ...)
{
va_list args;
va_start(args, fmt);
TextDisabledV(fmt, args);
va_end(args);
}
void ImGui::TextDisabledV(const char* fmt, va_list args)
{
PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, GImGui->Style.Colors[ImGuiCol_TextDisabled]);
TextV(fmt, args);
PopStyleColor();
}
void ImGui::TextWrapped(const char* fmt, ...)
{
va_list args;
va_start(args, fmt);
TextWrappedV(fmt, args);
va_end(args);
}
void ImGui::TextWrappedV(const char* fmt, va_list args)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
bool need_backup = (window->DC.TextWrapPos < 0.0f); // Keep existing wrap position if one is already set
if (need_backup)
PushTextWrapPos(0.0f);
TextV(fmt, args);
if (need_backup)
PopTextWrapPos();
}
void ImGui::LabelText(const char* label, const char* fmt, ...)
{
va_list args;
va_start(args, fmt);
LabelTextV(label, fmt, args);
va_end(args);
}
// Add a label+text combo aligned to other label+value widgets
void ImGui::LabelTextV(const char* label, const char* fmt, va_list args)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
const float w = CalcItemWidth();
const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true);
const ImRect value_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(w, label_size.y + style.FramePadding.y*2));
const ImRect total_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(w + (label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x : 0.0f), style.FramePadding.y*2) + label_size);
ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y);
if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, 0))
return;
// Render
const char* value_text_begin = &g.TempBuffer[0];
const char* value_text_end = value_text_begin + ImFormatStringV(g.TempBuffer, IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.TempBuffer), fmt, args);
RenderTextClipped(value_bb.Min, value_bb.Max, value_text_begin, value_text_end, NULL, ImVec2(0.0f,0.5f));
if (label_size.x > 0.0f)
RenderText(ImVec2(value_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, value_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), label);
}
void ImGui::BulletText(const char* fmt, ...)
{
va_list args;
va_start(args, fmt);
BulletTextV(fmt, args);
va_end(args);
}
// Text with a little bullet aligned to the typical tree node.
void ImGui::BulletTextV(const char* fmt, va_list args)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
const char* text_begin = g.TempBuffer;
const char* text_end = text_begin + ImFormatStringV(g.TempBuffer, IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.TempBuffer), fmt, args);
const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(text_begin, text_end, false);
const ImVec2 total_size = ImVec2(g.FontSize + (label_size.x > 0.0f ? (label_size.x + style.FramePadding.x * 2) : 0.0f), label_size.y); // Empty text doesn't add padding
ImVec2 pos = window->DC.CursorPos;
pos.y += window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset;
ItemSize(total_size, 0.0f);
const ImRect bb(pos, pos + total_size);
if (!ItemAdd(bb, 0))
return;
// Render
ImU32 text_col = GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text);
RenderBullet(window->DrawList, bb.Min + ImVec2(style.FramePadding.x + g.FontSize*0.5f, g.FontSize*0.5f), text_col);
RenderText(bb.Min + ImVec2(g.FontSize + style.FramePadding.x * 2, 0.0f), text_begin, text_end, false);
}
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// [SECTION] Widgets: Main
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// - ButtonBehavior() [Internal]
// - Button()
// - SmallButton()
// - InvisibleButton()
// - ArrowButton()
// - CloseButton() [Internal]
// - CollapseButton() [Internal]
// - GetWindowScrollbarID() [Internal]
// - GetWindowScrollbarRect() [Internal]
// - Scrollbar() [Internal]
// - ScrollbarEx() [Internal]
// - Image()
// - ImageButton()
// - Checkbox()
// - CheckboxFlags()
// - RadioButton()
// - ProgressBar()
// - Bullet()
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// The ButtonBehavior() function is key to many interactions and used by many/most widgets.
// Because we handle so many cases (keyboard/gamepad navigation, drag and drop) and many specific behavior (via ImGuiButtonFlags_),
// this code is a little complex.
// By far the most common path is interacting with the Mouse using the default ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease button behavior.
// See the series of events below and the corresponding state reported by dear imgui:
//------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
// with PressedOnClickRelease: return-value IsItemHovered() IsItemActive() IsItemActivated() IsItemDeactivated() IsItemClicked()
// Frame N+0 (mouse is outside bb) - - - - - -
// Frame N+1 (mouse moves inside bb) - true - - - -
// Frame N+2 (mouse button is down) - true true true - true
// Frame N+3 (mouse button is down) - true true - - -
// Frame N+4 (mouse moves outside bb) - - true - - -
// Frame N+5 (mouse moves inside bb) - true true - - -
// Frame N+6 (mouse button is released) true true - - true -
// Frame N+7 (mouse button is released) - true - - - -
// Frame N+8 (mouse moves outside bb) - - - - - -
//------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
// with PressedOnClick: return-value IsItemHovered() IsItemActive() IsItemActivated() IsItemDeactivated() IsItemClicked()
// Frame N+2 (mouse button is down) true true true true - true
// Frame N+3 (mouse button is down) - true true - - -
// Frame N+6 (mouse button is released) - true - - true -
// Frame N+7 (mouse button is released) - true - - - -
//------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
// with PressedOnRelease: return-value IsItemHovered() IsItemActive() IsItemActivated() IsItemDeactivated() IsItemClicked()
// Frame N+2 (mouse button is down) - true - - - true
// Frame N+3 (mouse button is down) - true - - - -
// Frame N+6 (mouse button is released) true true - - - -
// Frame N+7 (mouse button is released) - true - - - -
//------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
// with PressedOnDoubleClick: return-value IsItemHovered() IsItemActive() IsItemActivated() IsItemDeactivated() IsItemClicked()
// Frame N+0 (mouse button is down) - true - - - true
// Frame N+1 (mouse button is down) - true - - - -
// Frame N+2 (mouse button is released) - true - - - -
// Frame N+3 (mouse button is released) - true - - - -
// Frame N+4 (mouse button is down) true true true true - true
// Frame N+5 (mouse button is down) - true true - - -
// Frame N+6 (mouse button is released) - true - - true -
// Frame N+7 (mouse button is released) - true - - - -
//------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
// Note that some combinations are supported,
// - PressedOnDragDropHold can generally be associated with any flag.
// - PressedOnDoubleClick can be associated by PressedOnClickRelease/PressedOnRelease, in which case the second release event won't be reported.
//------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
// The behavior of the return-value changes when ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat is set:
// Repeat+ Repeat+ Repeat+ Repeat+
// PressedOnClickRelease PressedOnClick PressedOnRelease PressedOnDoubleClick
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
// Frame N+0 (mouse button is down) - true - true
// ... - - - -
// Frame N + RepeatDelay true true - true
// ... - - - -
// Frame N + RepeatDelay + RepeatRate*N true true - true
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
bool ImGui::ButtonBehavior(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, bool* out_hovered, bool* out_held, ImGuiButtonFlags flags)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_Disabled)
{
if (out_hovered) *out_hovered = false;
if (out_held) *out_held = false;
if (g.ActiveId == id) ClearActiveID();
return false;
}
// Default only reacts to left mouse button
if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonMask_) == 0)
flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonDefault_;
// Default behavior requires click + release inside bounding box
if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnMask_) == 0)
flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDefault_;
ImGuiWindow* backup_hovered_window = g.HoveredWindow;
const bool flatten_hovered_children = (flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_FlattenChildren) && g.HoveredRootWindow == window;
if (flatten_hovered_children)
g.HoveredWindow = window;
#ifdef IMGUI_ENABLE_TEST_ENGINE
if (id != 0 && window->DC.LastItemId != id)
ImGuiTestEngineHook_ItemAdd(&g, bb, id);
#endif
bool pressed = false;
bool hovered = ItemHoverable(bb, id);
// Drag source doesn't report as hovered
if (hovered && g.DragDropActive && g.DragDropPayload.SourceId == id && !(g.DragDropSourceFlags & ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceNoDisableHover))
hovered = false;
// Special mode for Drag and Drop where holding button pressed for a long time while dragging another item triggers the button
if (g.DragDropActive && (flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDragDropHold) && !(g.DragDropSourceFlags & ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceNoHoldToOpenOthers))
if (IsItemHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenBlockedByActiveItem))
{
hovered = true;
SetHoveredID(id);
if (CalcTypematicRepeatAmount(g.HoveredIdTimer + 0.0001f - g.IO.DeltaTime, g.HoveredIdTimer + 0.0001f, 0.70f, 0.00f))
{
pressed = true;
FocusWindow(window);
}
}
if (flatten_hovered_children)
g.HoveredWindow = backup_hovered_window;
// AllowOverlap mode (rarely used) requires previous frame HoveredId to be null or to match. This allows using patterns where a later submitted widget overlaps a previous one.
if (hovered && (flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_AllowItemOverlap) && (g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame != id && g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame != 0))
hovered = false;
// Mouse handling
if (hovered)
{
if (!(flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_NoKeyModifiers) || (!g.IO.KeyCtrl && !g.IO.KeyShift && !g.IO.KeyAlt))
{
// Poll buttons
int mouse_button_clicked = -1;
int mouse_button_released = -1;
if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonLeft) && g.IO.MouseClicked[0]) { mouse_button_clicked = 0; }
else if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonRight) && g.IO.MouseClicked[1]) { mouse_button_clicked = 1; }
else if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonMiddle) && g.IO.MouseClicked[2]) { mouse_button_clicked = 2; }
if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonLeft) && g.IO.MouseReleased[0]) { mouse_button_released = 0; }
else if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonRight) && g.IO.MouseReleased[1]) { mouse_button_released = 1; }
else if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonMiddle) && g.IO.MouseReleased[2]) { mouse_button_released = 2; }
if (mouse_button_clicked != -1 && g.ActiveId != id)
{
if (flags & (ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease | ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickReleaseAnywhere))
{
SetActiveID(id, window);
g.ActiveIdMouseButton = mouse_button_clicked;
if (!(flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_NoNavFocus))
SetFocusID(id, window);
FocusWindow(window);
}
if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClick) || ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDoubleClick) && g.IO.MouseDoubleClicked[mouse_button_clicked]))
{
pressed = true;
if (flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_NoHoldingActiveId)
ClearActiveID();
else
SetActiveID(id, window); // Hold on ID
g.ActiveIdMouseButton = mouse_button_clicked;
FocusWindow(window);
}
}
if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnRelease) && mouse_button_released != -1)
{
// Repeat mode trumps on release behavior
if (!((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat) && g.IO.MouseDownDurationPrev[mouse_button_released] >= g.IO.KeyRepeatDelay))
pressed = true;
ClearActiveID();
}
// 'Repeat' mode acts when held regardless of _PressedOn flags (see table above).
// Relies on repeat logic of IsMouseClicked() but we may as well do it ourselves if we end up exposing finer RepeatDelay/RepeatRate settings.
if (g.ActiveId == id && (flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat))
if (g.IO.MouseDownDuration[g.ActiveIdMouseButton] > 0.0f && IsMouseClicked(g.ActiveIdMouseButton, true))
pressed = true;
}
if (pressed)
g.NavDisableHighlight = true;
}
// Gamepad/Keyboard navigation
// We report navigated item as hovered but we don't set g.HoveredId to not interfere with mouse.
if (g.NavId == id && !g.NavDisableHighlight && g.NavDisableMouseHover && (g.ActiveId == 0 || g.ActiveId == id || g.ActiveId == window->MoveId))
if (!(flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_NoHoveredOnFocus))
hovered = true;
if (g.NavActivateDownId == id)
{
bool nav_activated_by_code = (g.NavActivateId == id);
bool nav_activated_by_inputs = IsNavInputTest(ImGuiNavInput_Activate, (flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat) ? ImGuiInputReadMode_Repeat : ImGuiInputReadMode_Pressed);
if (nav_activated_by_code || nav_activated_by_inputs)
pressed = true;
if (nav_activated_by_code || nav_activated_by_inputs || g.ActiveId == id)
{
// Set active id so it can be queried by user via IsItemActive(), equivalent of holding the mouse button.
g.NavActivateId = id; // This is so SetActiveId assign a Nav source
SetActiveID(id, window);
if ((nav_activated_by_code || nav_activated_by_inputs) && !(flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_NoNavFocus))
SetFocusID(id, window);
}
}
bool held = false;
if (g.ActiveId == id)
{
if (g.ActiveIdSource == ImGuiInputSource_Mouse)
{
if (g.ActiveIdIsJustActivated)
g.ActiveIdClickOffset = g.IO.MousePos - bb.Min;
const int mouse_button = g.ActiveIdMouseButton;
IM_ASSERT(mouse_button >= 0 && mouse_button < ImGuiMouseButton_COUNT);
if (g.IO.MouseDown[mouse_button])
{
held = true;
}
else
{
bool release_in = hovered && (flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease) != 0;
bool release_anywhere = (flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickReleaseAnywhere) != 0;
if ((release_in || release_anywhere) && !g.DragDropActive)
{
bool is_double_click_release = (flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDoubleClick) && g.IO.MouseDownWasDoubleClick[mouse_button];
bool is_repeating_already = (flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat) && g.IO.MouseDownDurationPrev[mouse_button] >= g.IO.KeyRepeatDelay; // Repeat mode trumps <on release>
if (!is_double_click_release && !is_repeating_already)
pressed = true;
}
ClearActiveID();
}
if (!(flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_NoNavFocus))
g.NavDisableHighlight = true;
}
else if (g.ActiveIdSource == ImGuiInputSource_Nav)
{
if (g.NavActivateDownId != id)
ClearActiveID();
}
if (pressed)
g.ActiveIdHasBeenPressedBefore = true;
}
if (out_hovered) *out_hovered = hovered;
if (out_held) *out_held = held;
return pressed;
}
bool ImGui::ButtonEx(const char* label, const ImVec2& size_arg, ImGuiButtonFlags flags)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label);
const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true);
ImVec2 pos = window->DC.CursorPos;
if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_AlignTextBaseLine) && style.FramePadding.y < window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset) // Try to vertically align buttons that are smaller/have no padding so that text baseline matches (bit hacky, since it shouldn't be a flag)
pos.y += window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset - style.FramePadding.y;
ImVec2 size = CalcItemSize(size_arg, label_size.x + style.FramePadding.x * 2.0f, label_size.y + style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f);
const ImRect bb(pos, pos + size);
ItemSize(size, style.FramePadding.y);
if (!ItemAdd(bb, id))
return false;
if (window->DC.ItemFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_ButtonRepeat)
flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat;
bool hovered, held;
bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held, flags);
// Render
const ImU32 col = GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_ButtonActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered : ImGuiCol_Button);
RenderNavHighlight(bb, id);
RenderFrame(bb.Min, bb.Max, col, true, style.FrameRounding);
RenderTextClipped(bb.Min + style.FramePadding, bb.Max - style.FramePadding, label, NULL, &label_size, style.ButtonTextAlign, &bb);
// Automatically close popups
//if (pressed && !(flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_DontClosePopups) && (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup))
// CloseCurrentPopup();
IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(id, label, window->DC.LastItemStatusFlags);
return pressed;
}
bool ImGui::Button(const char* label, const ImVec2& size_arg)
{
return ButtonEx(label, size_arg, 0);
}
// Small buttons fits within text without additional vertical spacing.
bool ImGui::SmallButton(const char* label)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
float backup_padding_y = g.Style.FramePadding.y;
g.Style.FramePadding.y = 0.0f;
bool pressed = ButtonEx(label, ImVec2(0, 0), ImGuiButtonFlags_AlignTextBaseLine);
g.Style.FramePadding.y = backup_padding_y;
return pressed;
}
// Tip: use ImGui::PushID()/PopID() to push indices or pointers in the ID stack.
// Then you can keep 'str_id' empty or the same for all your buttons (instead of creating a string based on a non-string id)
bool ImGui::InvisibleButton(const char* str_id, const ImVec2& size_arg)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
// Cannot use zero-size for InvisibleButton(). Unlike Button() there is not way to fallback using the label size.
IM_ASSERT(size_arg.x != 0.0f && size_arg.y != 0.0f);
const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(str_id);
ImVec2 size = CalcItemSize(size_arg, 0.0f, 0.0f);
const ImRect bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + size);
ItemSize(size);
if (!ItemAdd(bb, id))
return false;
bool hovered, held;
bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held);
return pressed;
}
bool ImGui::ArrowButtonEx(const char* str_id, ImGuiDir dir, ImVec2 size, ImGuiButtonFlags flags)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(str_id);
const ImRect bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + size);
const float default_size = GetFrameHeight();
ItemSize(size, (size.y >= default_size) ? g.Style.FramePadding.y : -1.0f);
if (!ItemAdd(bb, id))
return false;
if (window->DC.ItemFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_ButtonRepeat)
flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat;
bool hovered, held;
bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held, flags);
// Render
const ImU32 bg_col = GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_ButtonActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered : ImGuiCol_Button);
const ImU32 text_col = GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text);
RenderNavHighlight(bb, id);
RenderFrame(bb.Min, bb.Max, bg_col, true, g.Style.FrameRounding);
RenderArrow(window->DrawList, bb.Min + ImVec2(ImMax(0.0f, (size.x - g.FontSize) * 0.5f), ImMax(0.0f, (size.y - g.FontSize) * 0.5f)), text_col, dir);
return pressed;
}
bool ImGui::ArrowButton(const char* str_id, ImGuiDir dir)
{
float sz = GetFrameHeight();
return ArrowButtonEx(str_id, dir, ImVec2(sz, sz), ImGuiButtonFlags_None);
}
// Button to close a window
bool ImGui::CloseButton(ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& pos)//, float size)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
// We intentionally allow interaction when clipped so that a mechanical Alt,Right,Validate sequence close a window.
// (this isn't the regular behavior of buttons, but it doesn't affect the user much because navigation tends to keep items visible).
const ImRect bb(pos, pos + ImVec2(g.FontSize, g.FontSize) + g.Style.FramePadding * 2.0f);
bool is_clipped = !ItemAdd(bb, id);
bool hovered, held;
bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held);
if (is_clipped)
return pressed;
// Render
ImU32 col = GetColorU32(held ? ImGuiCol_ButtonActive : ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered);
ImVec2 center = bb.GetCenter();
if (hovered)
window->DrawList->AddCircleFilled(center, ImMax(2.0f, g.FontSize * 0.5f + 1.0f), col, 12);
float cross_extent = g.FontSize * 0.5f * 0.7071f - 1.0f;
ImU32 cross_col = GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text);
center -= ImVec2(0.5f, 0.5f);
window->DrawList->AddLine(center + ImVec2(+cross_extent,+cross_extent), center + ImVec2(-cross_extent,-cross_extent), cross_col, 1.0f);
window->DrawList->AddLine(center + ImVec2(+cross_extent,-cross_extent), center + ImVec2(-cross_extent,+cross_extent), cross_col, 1.0f);
return pressed;
}
bool ImGui::CollapseButton(ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& pos)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
ImRect bb(pos, pos + ImVec2(g.FontSize, g.FontSize) + g.Style.FramePadding * 2.0f);
ItemAdd(bb, id);
bool hovered, held;
bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held, ImGuiButtonFlags_None);
// Render
ImU32 bg_col = GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_ButtonActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered : ImGuiCol_Button);
ImU32 text_col = GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text);
ImVec2 center = bb.GetCenter();
if (hovered || held)
window->DrawList->AddCircleFilled(center/*+ ImVec2(0.0f, -0.5f)*/, g.FontSize * 0.5f + 1.0f, bg_col, 12);
RenderArrow(window->DrawList, bb.Min + g.Style.FramePadding, text_col, window->Collapsed ? ImGuiDir_Right : ImGuiDir_Down, 1.0f);
// Switch to moving the window after mouse is moved beyond the initial drag threshold
if (IsItemActive() && IsMouseDragging(0))
StartMouseMovingWindow(window);
return pressed;
}
ImGuiID ImGui::GetWindowScrollbarID(ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiAxis axis)
{
return window->GetIDNoKeepAlive(axis == ImGuiAxis_X ? "#SCROLLX" : "#SCROLLY");
}
// Return scrollbar rectangle, must only be called for corresponding axis if window->ScrollbarX/Y is set.
ImRect ImGui::GetWindowScrollbarRect(ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiAxis axis)
{
const ImRect outer_rect = window->Rect();
const ImRect inner_rect = window->InnerRect;
const float border_size = window->WindowBorderSize;
const float scrollbar_size = window->ScrollbarSizes[axis ^ 1]; // (ScrollbarSizes.x = width of Y scrollbar; ScrollbarSizes.y = height of X scrollbar)
IM_ASSERT(scrollbar_size > 0.0f);
if (axis == ImGuiAxis_X)
return ImRect(inner_rect.Min.x, ImMax(outer_rect.Min.y, outer_rect.Max.y - border_size - scrollbar_size), inner_rect.Max.x, outer_rect.Max.y);
else
return ImRect(ImMax(outer_rect.Min.x, outer_rect.Max.x - border_size - scrollbar_size), inner_rect.Min.y, outer_rect.Max.x, inner_rect.Max.y);
}
void ImGui::Scrollbar(ImGuiAxis axis)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
const ImGuiID id = GetWindowScrollbarID(window, axis);
KeepAliveID(id);
// Calculate scrollbar bounding box
ImRect bb = GetWindowScrollbarRect(window, axis);
ImDrawCornerFlags rounding_corners = 0;
if (axis == ImGuiAxis_X)
{
rounding_corners |= ImDrawCornerFlags_BotLeft;
if (!window->ScrollbarY)
rounding_corners |= ImDrawCornerFlags_BotRight;
}
else
{
if ((window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar) && !(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar))
rounding_corners |= ImDrawCornerFlags_TopRight;
if (!window->ScrollbarX)
rounding_corners |= ImDrawCornerFlags_BotRight;
}
float size_avail = window->InnerRect.Max[axis] - window->InnerRect.Min[axis];
float size_contents = window->ContentSize[axis] + window->WindowPadding[axis] * 2.0f;
ScrollbarEx(bb, id, axis, &window->Scroll[axis], size_avail, size_contents, rounding_corners);
}
// Vertical/Horizontal scrollbar
// The entire piece of code below is rather confusing because:
// - We handle absolute seeking (when first clicking outside the grab) and relative manipulation (afterward or when clicking inside the grab)
// - We store values as normalized ratio and in a form that allows the window content to change while we are holding on a scrollbar
// - We handle both horizontal and vertical scrollbars, which makes the terminology not ideal.
// Still, the code should probably be made simpler..
bool ImGui::ScrollbarEx(const ImRect& bb_frame, ImGuiID id, ImGuiAxis axis, float* p_scroll_v, float size_avail_v, float size_contents_v, ImDrawCornerFlags rounding_corners)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
const float bb_frame_width = bb_frame.GetWidth();
const float bb_frame_height = bb_frame.GetHeight();
if (bb_frame_width <= 0.0f || bb_frame_height <= 0.0f)
return false;
// When we are too small, start hiding and disabling the grab (this reduce visual noise on very small window and facilitate using the window resize grab)
float alpha = 1.0f;
if ((axis == ImGuiAxis_Y) && bb_frame_height < g.FontSize + g.Style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f)
alpha = ImSaturate((bb_frame_height - g.FontSize) / (g.Style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f));
if (alpha <= 0.0f)
return false;
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
const bool allow_interaction = (alpha >= 1.0f);
ImRect bb = bb_frame;
bb.Expand(ImVec2(-ImClamp(IM_FLOOR((bb_frame_width - 2.0f) * 0.5f), 0.0f, 3.0f), -ImClamp(IM_FLOOR((bb_frame_height - 2.0f) * 0.5f), 0.0f, 3.0f)));
// V denote the main, longer axis of the scrollbar (= height for a vertical scrollbar)
const float scrollbar_size_v = (axis == ImGuiAxis_X) ? bb.GetWidth() : bb.GetHeight();
// Calculate the height of our grabbable box. It generally represent the amount visible (vs the total scrollable amount)
// But we maintain a minimum size in pixel to allow for the user to still aim inside.
IM_ASSERT(ImMax(size_contents_v, size_avail_v) > 0.0f); // Adding this assert to check if the ImMax(XXX,1.0f) is still needed. PLEASE CONTACT ME if this triggers.
const float win_size_v = ImMax(ImMax(size_contents_v, size_avail_v), 1.0f);
const float grab_h_pixels = ImClamp(scrollbar_size_v * (size_avail_v / win_size_v), style.GrabMinSize, scrollbar_size_v);
const float grab_h_norm = grab_h_pixels / scrollbar_size_v;
// Handle input right away. None of the code of Begin() is relying on scrolling position before calling Scrollbar().
bool held = false;
bool hovered = false;
ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held, ImGuiButtonFlags_NoNavFocus);
float scroll_max = ImMax(1.0f, size_contents_v - size_avail_v);
float scroll_ratio = ImSaturate(*p_scroll_v / scroll_max);
float grab_v_norm = scroll_ratio * (scrollbar_size_v - grab_h_pixels) / scrollbar_size_v; // Grab position in normalized space
if (held && allow_interaction && grab_h_norm < 1.0f)
{
float scrollbar_pos_v = bb.Min[axis];
float mouse_pos_v = g.IO.MousePos[axis];
// Click position in scrollbar normalized space (0.0f->1.0f)
const float clicked_v_norm = ImSaturate((mouse_pos_v - scrollbar_pos_v) / scrollbar_size_v);
SetHoveredID(id);
bool seek_absolute = false;
if (g.ActiveIdIsJustActivated)
{
// On initial click calculate the distance between mouse and the center of the grab
seek_absolute = (clicked_v_norm < grab_v_norm || clicked_v_norm > grab_v_norm + grab_h_norm);
if (seek_absolute)
g.ScrollbarClickDeltaToGrabCenter = 0.0f;
else
g.ScrollbarClickDeltaToGrabCenter = clicked_v_norm - grab_v_norm - grab_h_norm * 0.5f;
}
// Apply scroll (p_scroll_v will generally point on one member of window->Scroll)
// It is ok to modify Scroll here because we are being called in Begin() after the calculation of ContentSize and before setting up our starting position
const float scroll_v_norm = ImSaturate((clicked_v_norm - g.ScrollbarClickDeltaToGrabCenter - grab_h_norm * 0.5f) / (1.0f - grab_h_norm));
*p_scroll_v = IM_ROUND(scroll_v_norm * scroll_max);//(win_size_contents_v - win_size_v));
// Update values for rendering
scroll_ratio = ImSaturate(*p_scroll_v / scroll_max);
grab_v_norm = scroll_ratio * (scrollbar_size_v - grab_h_pixels) / scrollbar_size_v;
// Update distance to grab now that we have seeked and saturated
if (seek_absolute)
g.ScrollbarClickDeltaToGrabCenter = clicked_v_norm - grab_v_norm - grab_h_norm * 0.5f;
}
// Render
const ImU32 bg_col = GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_ScrollbarBg);
const ImU32 grab_col = GetColorU32(held ? ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrabActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrabHovered : ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrab, alpha);
window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(bb_frame.Min, bb_frame.Max, bg_col, window->WindowRounding, rounding_corners);
ImRect grab_rect;
if (axis == ImGuiAxis_X)
grab_rect = ImRect(ImLerp(bb.Min.x, bb.Max.x, grab_v_norm), bb.Min.y, ImLerp(bb.Min.x, bb.Max.x, grab_v_norm) + grab_h_pixels, bb.Max.y);
else
grab_rect = ImRect(bb.Min.x, ImLerp(bb.Min.y, bb.Max.y, grab_v_norm), bb.Max.x, ImLerp(bb.Min.y, bb.Max.y, grab_v_norm) + grab_h_pixels);
window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(grab_rect.Min, grab_rect.Max, grab_col, style.ScrollbarRounding);
return held;
}
void ImGui::Image(ImTextureID user_texture_id, const ImVec2& size, const ImVec2& uv0, const ImVec2& uv1, const ImVec4& tint_col, const ImVec4& border_col)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return;
ImRect bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + size);
if (border_col.w > 0.0f)
bb.Max += ImVec2(2, 2);
ItemSize(bb);
if (!ItemAdd(bb, 0))
return;
if (border_col.w > 0.0f)
{
window->DrawList->AddRect(bb.Min, bb.Max, GetColorU32(border_col), 0.0f);
window->DrawList->AddImage(user_texture_id, bb.Min + ImVec2(1, 1), bb.Max - ImVec2(1, 1), uv0, uv1, GetColorU32(tint_col));
}
else
{
window->DrawList->AddImage(user_texture_id, bb.Min, bb.Max, uv0, uv1, GetColorU32(tint_col));
}
}
// frame_padding < 0: uses FramePadding from style (default)
// frame_padding = 0: no framing
// frame_padding > 0: set framing size
// The color used are the button colors.
bool ImGui::ImageButton(ImTextureID user_texture_id, const ImVec2& size, const ImVec2& uv0, const ImVec2& uv1, int frame_padding, const ImVec4& bg_col, const ImVec4& tint_col)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
// Default to using texture ID as ID. User can still push string/integer prefixes.
// We could hash the size/uv to create a unique ID but that would prevent the user from animating UV.
PushID((void*)(intptr_t)user_texture_id);
const ImGuiID id = window->GetID("#image");
PopID();
const ImVec2 padding = (frame_padding >= 0) ? ImVec2((float)frame_padding, (float)frame_padding) : style.FramePadding;
const ImRect bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + size + padding * 2);
const ImRect image_bb(window->DC.CursorPos + padding, window->DC.CursorPos + padding + size);
ItemSize(bb);
if (!ItemAdd(bb, id))
return false;
bool hovered, held;
bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held);
// Render
const ImU32 col = GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_ButtonActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered : ImGuiCol_Button);
RenderNavHighlight(bb, id);
RenderFrame(bb.Min, bb.Max, col, true, ImClamp((float)ImMin(padding.x, padding.y), 0.0f, style.FrameRounding));
if (bg_col.w > 0.0f)
window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(image_bb.Min, image_bb.Max, GetColorU32(bg_col));
window->DrawList->AddImage(user_texture_id, image_bb.Min, image_bb.Max, uv0, uv1, GetColorU32(tint_col));
return pressed;
}
bool ImGui::Checkbox(const char* label, bool* v)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label);
const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true);
const float square_sz = GetFrameHeight();
const ImVec2 pos = window->DC.CursorPos;
const ImRect total_bb(pos, pos + ImVec2(square_sz + (label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x : 0.0f), label_size.y + style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f));
ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y);
if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, id))
return false;
bool hovered, held;
bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(total_bb, id, &hovered, &held);
if (pressed)
{
*v = !(*v);
MarkItemEdited(id);
}
const ImRect check_bb(pos, pos + ImVec2(square_sz, square_sz));
RenderNavHighlight(total_bb, id);
RenderFrame(check_bb.Min, check_bb.Max, GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered : ImGuiCol_FrameBg), true, style.FrameRounding);
ImU32 check_col = GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_CheckMark);
if (window->DC.ItemFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_MixedValue)
{
// Undocumented tristate/mixed/indeterminate checkbox (#2644)
ImVec2 pad(ImMax(1.0f, IM_FLOOR(square_sz / 3.6f)), ImMax(1.0f, IM_FLOOR(square_sz / 3.6f)));
window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(check_bb.Min + pad, check_bb.Max - pad, check_col, style.FrameRounding);
}
else if (*v)
{
const float pad = ImMax(1.0f, IM_FLOOR(square_sz / 6.0f));
RenderCheckMark(window->DrawList, check_bb.Min + ImVec2(pad, pad), check_col, square_sz - pad*2.0f);
}
if (g.LogEnabled)
LogRenderedText(&total_bb.Min, *v ? "[x]" : "[ ]");
if (label_size.x > 0.0f)
RenderText(ImVec2(check_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, check_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), label);
IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(id, label, window->DC.ItemFlags | ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Checkable | (*v ? ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Checked : 0));
return pressed;
}
bool ImGui::CheckboxFlags(const char* label, unsigned int* flags, unsigned int flags_value)
{
bool v = ((*flags & flags_value) == flags_value);
bool pressed = Checkbox(label, &v);
if (pressed)
{
if (v)
*flags |= flags_value;
else
*flags &= ~flags_value;
}
return pressed;
}
bool ImGui::RadioButton(const char* label, bool active)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label);
const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true);
const float square_sz = GetFrameHeight();
const ImVec2 pos = window->DC.CursorPos;
const ImRect check_bb(pos, pos + ImVec2(square_sz, square_sz));
const ImRect total_bb(pos, pos + ImVec2(square_sz + (label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x : 0.0f), label_size.y + style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f));
ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y);
if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, id))
return false;
ImVec2 center = check_bb.GetCenter();
center.x = IM_ROUND(center.x);
center.y = IM_ROUND(center.y);
const float radius = (square_sz - 1.0f) * 0.5f;
bool hovered, held;
bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(total_bb, id, &hovered, &held);
if (pressed)
MarkItemEdited(id);
RenderNavHighlight(total_bb, id);
window->DrawList->AddCircleFilled(center, radius, GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered : ImGuiCol_FrameBg), 16);
if (active)
{
const float pad = ImMax(1.0f, IM_FLOOR(square_sz / 6.0f));
window->DrawList->AddCircleFilled(center, radius - pad, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_CheckMark), 16);
}
if (style.FrameBorderSize > 0.0f)
{
window->DrawList->AddCircle(center + ImVec2(1,1), radius, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_BorderShadow), 16, style.FrameBorderSize);
window->DrawList->AddCircle(center, radius, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Border), 16, style.FrameBorderSize);
}
if (g.LogEnabled)
LogRenderedText(&total_bb.Min, active ? "(x)" : "( )");
if (label_size.x > 0.0f)
RenderText(ImVec2(check_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, check_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), label);
return pressed;
}
// FIXME: This would work nicely if it was a public template, e.g. 'template<T> RadioButton(const char* label, T* v, T v_button)', but I'm not sure how we would expose it..
bool ImGui::RadioButton(const char* label, int* v, int v_button)
{
const bool pressed = RadioButton(label, *v == v_button);
if (pressed)
*v = v_button;
return pressed;
}
// size_arg (for each axis) < 0.0f: align to end, 0.0f: auto, > 0.0f: specified size
void ImGui::ProgressBar(float fraction, const ImVec2& size_arg, const char* overlay)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
ImVec2 pos = window->DC.CursorPos;
ImVec2 size = CalcItemSize(size_arg, CalcItemWidth(), g.FontSize + style.FramePadding.y*2.0f);
ImRect bb(pos, pos + size);
ItemSize(size, style.FramePadding.y);
if (!ItemAdd(bb, 0))
return;
// Render
fraction = ImSaturate(fraction);
RenderFrame(bb.Min, bb.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_FrameBg), true, style.FrameRounding);
bb.Expand(ImVec2(-style.FrameBorderSize, -style.FrameBorderSize));
const ImVec2 fill_br = ImVec2(ImLerp(bb.Min.x, bb.Max.x, fraction), bb.Max.y);
RenderRectFilledRangeH(window->DrawList, bb, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_PlotHistogram), 0.0f, fraction, style.FrameRounding);
// Default displaying the fraction as percentage string, but user can override it
char overlay_buf[32];
if (!overlay)
{
ImFormatString(overlay_buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(overlay_buf), "%.0f%%", fraction*100+0.01f);
overlay = overlay_buf;
}
ImVec2 overlay_size = CalcTextSize(overlay, NULL);
if (overlay_size.x > 0.0f)
RenderTextClipped(ImVec2(ImClamp(fill_br.x + style.ItemSpacing.x, bb.Min.x, bb.Max.x - overlay_size.x - style.ItemInnerSpacing.x), bb.Min.y), bb.Max, overlay, NULL, &overlay_size, ImVec2(0.0f,0.5f), &bb);
}
void ImGui::Bullet()
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
const float line_height = ImMax(ImMin(window->DC.CurrLineSize.y, g.FontSize + g.Style.FramePadding.y*2), g.FontSize);
const ImRect bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(g.FontSize, line_height));
ItemSize(bb);
if (!ItemAdd(bb, 0))
{
SameLine(0, style.FramePadding.x*2);
return;
}
// Render and stay on same line
ImU32 text_col = GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text);
RenderBullet(window->DrawList, bb.Min + ImVec2(style.FramePadding.x + g.FontSize*0.5f, line_height*0.5f), text_col);
SameLine(0, style.FramePadding.x * 2.0f);
}
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// [SECTION] Widgets: Low-level Layout helpers
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// - Spacing()
// - Dummy()
// - NewLine()
// - AlignTextToFramePadding()
// - SeparatorEx() [Internal]
// - Separator()
// - SplitterBehavior() [Internal]
// - ShrinkWidths() [Internal]
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
void ImGui::Spacing()
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return;
ItemSize(ImVec2(0,0));
}
void ImGui::Dummy(const ImVec2& size)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return;
const ImRect bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + size);
ItemSize(size);
ItemAdd(bb, 0);
}
void ImGui::NewLine()
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
const ImGuiLayoutType backup_layout_type = window->DC.LayoutType;
window->DC.LayoutType = ImGuiLayoutType_Vertical;
if (window->DC.CurrLineSize.y > 0.0f) // In the event that we are on a line with items that is smaller that FontSize high, we will preserve its height.
ItemSize(ImVec2(0,0));
else
ItemSize(ImVec2(0.0f, g.FontSize));
window->DC.LayoutType = backup_layout_type;
}
void ImGui::AlignTextToFramePadding()
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
window->DC.CurrLineSize.y = ImMax(window->DC.CurrLineSize.y, g.FontSize + g.Style.FramePadding.y * 2);
window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset = ImMax(window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset, g.Style.FramePadding.y);
}
// Horizontal/vertical separating line
void ImGui::SeparatorEx(ImGuiSeparatorFlags flags)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
IM_ASSERT(ImIsPowerOfTwo(flags & (ImGuiSeparatorFlags_Horizontal | ImGuiSeparatorFlags_Vertical))); // Check that only 1 option is selected
float thickness_draw = 1.0f;
float thickness_layout = 0.0f;
if (flags & ImGuiSeparatorFlags_Vertical)
{
// Vertical separator, for menu bars (use current line height). Not exposed because it is misleading and it doesn't have an effect on regular layout.
float y1 = window->DC.CursorPos.y;
float y2 = window->DC.CursorPos.y + window->DC.CurrLineSize.y;
const ImRect bb(ImVec2(window->DC.CursorPos.x, y1), ImVec2(window->DC.CursorPos.x + thickness_draw, y2));
ItemSize(ImVec2(thickness_layout, 0.0f));
if (!ItemAdd(bb, 0))
return;
// Draw
window->DrawList->AddLine(ImVec2(bb.Min.x, bb.Min.y), ImVec2(bb.Min.x, bb.Max.y), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Separator));
if (g.LogEnabled)
LogText(" |");
}
else if (flags & ImGuiSeparatorFlags_Horizontal)
{
// Horizontal Separator
float x1 = window->Pos.x;
float x2 = window->Pos.x + window->Size.x;
if (!window->DC.GroupStack.empty())
x1 += window->DC.Indent.x;
ImGuiColumns* columns = (flags & ImGuiSeparatorFlags_SpanAllColumns) ? window->DC.CurrentColumns : NULL;
if (columns)
PushColumnsBackground();
// We don't provide our width to the layout so that it doesn't get feed back into AutoFit
const ImRect bb(ImVec2(x1, window->DC.CursorPos.y), ImVec2(x2, window->DC.CursorPos.y + thickness_draw));
ItemSize(ImVec2(0.0f, thickness_layout));
const bool item_visible = ItemAdd(bb, 0);
if (item_visible)
{
// Draw
window->DrawList->AddLine(bb.Min, ImVec2(bb.Max.x, bb.Min.y), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Separator));
if (g.LogEnabled)
LogRenderedText(&bb.Min, "--------------------------------");
}
if (columns)
{
PopColumnsBackground();
columns->LineMinY = window->DC.CursorPos.y;
}
}
}
void ImGui::Separator()
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
if (window->SkipItems)
return;
// Those flags should eventually be overridable by the user
ImGuiSeparatorFlags flags = (window->DC.LayoutType == ImGuiLayoutType_Horizontal) ? ImGuiSeparatorFlags_Vertical : ImGuiSeparatorFlags_Horizontal;
flags |= ImGuiSeparatorFlags_SpanAllColumns;
SeparatorEx(flags);
}
// Using 'hover_visibility_delay' allows us to hide the highlight and mouse cursor for a short time, which can be convenient to reduce visual noise.
bool ImGui::SplitterBehavior(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, ImGuiAxis axis, float* size1, float* size2, float min_size1, float min_size2, float hover_extend, float hover_visibility_delay)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
const ImGuiItemFlags item_flags_backup = window->DC.ItemFlags;
window->DC.ItemFlags |= ImGuiItemFlags_NoNav | ImGuiItemFlags_NoNavDefaultFocus;
bool item_add = ItemAdd(bb, id);
window->DC.ItemFlags = item_flags_backup;
if (!item_add)
return false;
bool hovered, held;
ImRect bb_interact = bb;
bb_interact.Expand(axis == ImGuiAxis_Y ? ImVec2(0.0f, hover_extend) : ImVec2(hover_extend, 0.0f));
ButtonBehavior(bb_interact, id, &hovered, &held, ImGuiButtonFlags_FlattenChildren | ImGuiButtonFlags_AllowItemOverlap);
if (g.ActiveId != id)
SetItemAllowOverlap();
if (held || (g.HoveredId == id && g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame == id && g.HoveredIdTimer >= hover_visibility_delay))
SetMouseCursor(axis == ImGuiAxis_Y ? ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeNS : ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeEW);
ImRect bb_render = bb;
if (held)
{
ImVec2 mouse_delta_2d = g.IO.MousePos - g.ActiveIdClickOffset - bb_interact.Min;
float mouse_delta = (axis == ImGuiAxis_Y) ? mouse_delta_2d.y : mouse_delta_2d.x;
// Minimum pane size
float size_1_maximum_delta = ImMax(0.0f, *size1 - min_size1);
float size_2_maximum_delta = ImMax(0.0f, *size2 - min_size2);
if (mouse_delta < -size_1_maximum_delta)
mouse_delta = -size_1_maximum_delta;
if (mouse_delta > size_2_maximum_delta)
mouse_delta = size_2_maximum_delta;
// Apply resize
if (mouse_delta != 0.0f)
{
if (mouse_delta < 0.0f)
IM_ASSERT(*size1 + mouse_delta >= min_size1);
if (mouse_delta > 0.0f)
IM_ASSERT(*size2 - mouse_delta >= min_size2);
*size1 += mouse_delta;
*size2 -= mouse_delta;
bb_render.Translate((axis == ImGuiAxis_X) ? ImVec2(mouse_delta, 0.0f) : ImVec2(0.0f, mouse_delta));
MarkItemEdited(id);
}
}
// Render
const ImU32 col = GetColorU32(held ? ImGuiCol_SeparatorActive : (hovered && g.HoveredIdTimer >= hover_visibility_delay) ? ImGuiCol_SeparatorHovered : ImGuiCol_Separator);
window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(bb_render.Min, bb_render.Max, col, 0.0f);
return held;
}
static int IMGUI_CDECL ShrinkWidthItemComparer(const void* lhs, const void* rhs)
{
const ImGuiShrinkWidthItem* a = (const ImGuiShrinkWidthItem*)lhs;
const ImGuiShrinkWidthItem* b = (const ImGuiShrinkWidthItem*)rhs;
if (int d = (int)(b->Width - a->Width))
return d;
return (b->Index - a->Index);
}
// Shrink excess width from a set of item, by removing width from the larger items first.
void ImGui::ShrinkWidths(ImGuiShrinkWidthItem* items, int count, float width_excess)
{
if (count == 1)
{
items[0].Width = ImMax(items[0].Width - width_excess, 1.0f);
return;
}
ImQsort(items, (size_t)count, sizeof(ImGuiShrinkWidthItem), ShrinkWidthItemComparer);
int count_same_width = 1;
while (width_excess > 0.0f && count_same_width < count)
{
while (count_same_width < count && items[0].Width <= items[count_same_width].Width)
count_same_width++;
float max_width_to_remove_per_item = (count_same_width < count) ? (items[0].Width - items[count_same_width].Width) : (items[0].Width - 1.0f);
float width_to_remove_per_item = ImMin(width_excess / count_same_width, max_width_to_remove_per_item);
for (int item_n = 0; item_n < count_same_width; item_n++)
items[item_n].Width -= width_to_remove_per_item;
width_excess -= width_to_remove_per_item * count_same_width;
}
// Round width and redistribute remainder left-to-right (could make it an option of the function?)
// Ensure that e.g. the right-most tab of a shrunk tab-bar always reaches exactly at the same distance from the right-most edge of the tab bar separator.
width_excess = 0.0f;
for (int n = 0; n < count; n++)
{
float width_rounded = ImFloor(items[n].Width);
width_excess += items[n].Width - width_rounded;
items[n].Width = width_rounded;
}
if (width_excess > 0.0f)
for (int n = 0; n < count; n++)
if (items[n].Index < (int)(width_excess + 0.01f))
items[n].Width += 1.0f;
}
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// [SECTION] Widgets: ComboBox
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// - BeginCombo()
// - EndCombo()
// - Combo()
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
static float CalcMaxPopupHeightFromItemCount(int items_count)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
if (items_count <= 0)
return FLT_MAX;
return (g.FontSize + g.Style.ItemSpacing.y) * items_count - g.Style.ItemSpacing.y + (g.Style.WindowPadding.y * 2);
}
bool ImGui::BeginCombo(const char* label, const char* preview_value, ImGuiComboFlags flags)
{
// Always consume the SetNextWindowSizeConstraint() call in our early return paths
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
bool has_window_size_constraint = (g.NextWindowData.Flags & ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_HasSizeConstraint) != 0;
g.NextWindowData.Flags &= ~ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_HasSizeConstraint;
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
IM_ASSERT((flags & (ImGuiComboFlags_NoArrowButton | ImGuiComboFlags_NoPreview)) != (ImGuiComboFlags_NoArrowButton | ImGuiComboFlags_NoPreview)); // Can't use both flags together
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label);
const float arrow_size = (flags & ImGuiComboFlags_NoArrowButton) ? 0.0f : GetFrameHeight();
const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true);
const float expected_w = CalcItemWidth();
const float w = (flags & ImGuiComboFlags_NoPreview) ? arrow_size : expected_w;
const ImRect frame_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(w, label_size.y + style.FramePadding.y*2.0f));
const ImRect total_bb(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max + ImVec2(label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x : 0.0f, 0.0f));
ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y);
if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, id, &frame_bb))
return false;
bool hovered, held;
bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(frame_bb, id, &hovered, &held);
bool popup_open = IsPopupOpen(id);
const ImU32 frame_col = GetColorU32(hovered ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered : ImGuiCol_FrameBg);
const float value_x2 = ImMax(frame_bb.Min.x, frame_bb.Max.x - arrow_size);
RenderNavHighlight(frame_bb, id);
if (!(flags & ImGuiComboFlags_NoPreview))
window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(frame_bb.Min, ImVec2(value_x2, frame_bb.Max.y), frame_col, style.FrameRounding, (flags & ImGuiComboFlags_NoArrowButton) ? ImDrawCornerFlags_All : ImDrawCornerFlags_Left);
if (!(flags & ImGuiComboFlags_NoArrowButton))
{
ImU32 bg_col = GetColorU32((popup_open || hovered) ? ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered : ImGuiCol_Button);
ImU32 text_col = GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text);
window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(ImVec2(value_x2, frame_bb.Min.y), frame_bb.Max, bg_col, style.FrameRounding, (w <= arrow_size) ? ImDrawCornerFlags_All : ImDrawCornerFlags_Right);
if (value_x2 + arrow_size - style.FramePadding.x <= frame_bb.Max.x)
RenderArrow(window->DrawList, ImVec2(value_x2 + style.FramePadding.y, frame_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), text_col, ImGuiDir_Down, 1.0f);
}
RenderFrameBorder(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, style.FrameRounding);
if (preview_value != NULL && !(flags & ImGuiComboFlags_NoPreview))
RenderTextClipped(frame_bb.Min + style.FramePadding, ImVec2(value_x2, frame_bb.Max.y), preview_value, NULL, NULL, ImVec2(0.0f,0.0f));
if (label_size.x > 0)
RenderText(ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, frame_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), label);
if ((pressed || g.NavActivateId == id) && !popup_open)
{
if (window->DC.NavLayerCurrent == 0)
window->NavLastIds[0] = id;
OpenPopupEx(id);
popup_open = true;
}
if (!popup_open)
return false;
if (has_window_size_constraint)
{
g.NextWindowData.Flags |= ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_HasSizeConstraint;
g.NextWindowData.SizeConstraintRect.Min.x = ImMax(g.NextWindowData.SizeConstraintRect.Min.x, w);
}
else
{
if ((flags & ImGuiComboFlags_HeightMask_) == 0)
flags |= ImGuiComboFlags_HeightRegular;
IM_ASSERT(ImIsPowerOfTwo(flags & ImGuiComboFlags_HeightMask_)); // Only one
int popup_max_height_in_items = -1;
if (flags & ImGuiComboFlags_HeightRegular) popup_max_height_in_items = 8;
else if (flags & ImGuiComboFlags_HeightSmall) popup_max_height_in_items = 4;
else if (flags & ImGuiComboFlags_HeightLarge) popup_max_height_in_items = 20;
SetNextWindowSizeConstraints(ImVec2(w, 0.0f), ImVec2(FLT_MAX, CalcMaxPopupHeightFromItemCount(popup_max_height_in_items)));
}
char name[16];
ImFormatString(name, IM_ARRAYSIZE(name), "##Combo_%02d", g.BeginPopupStack.Size); // Recycle windows based on depth
// Peak into expected window size so we can position it
if (ImGuiWindow* popup_window = FindWindowByName(name))
if (popup_window->WasActive)
{
ImVec2 size_expected = CalcWindowExpectedSize(popup_window);
if (flags & ImGuiComboFlags_PopupAlignLeft)
popup_window->AutoPosLastDirection = ImGuiDir_Left;
ImRect r_outer = GetWindowAllowedExtentRect(popup_window);
ImVec2 pos = FindBestWindowPosForPopupEx(frame_bb.GetBL(), size_expected, &popup_window->AutoPosLastDirection, r_outer, frame_bb, ImGuiPopupPositionPolicy_ComboBox);
SetNextWindowPos(pos);
}
// We don't use BeginPopupEx() solely because we have a custom name string, which we could make an argument to BeginPopupEx()
ImGuiWindowFlags window_flags = ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize | ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove;
// Horizontally align ourselves with the framed text
PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_WindowPadding, ImVec2(style.FramePadding.x, style.WindowPadding.y));
bool ret = Begin(name, NULL, window_flags);
PopStyleVar();
if (!ret)
{
EndPopup();
IM_ASSERT(0); // This should never happen as we tested for IsPopupOpen() above
return false;
}
return true;
}
void ImGui::EndCombo()
{
EndPopup();
}
// Getter for the old Combo() API: const char*[]
static bool Items_ArrayGetter(void* data, int idx, const char** out_text)
{
const char* const* items = (const char* const*)data;
if (out_text)
*out_text = items[idx];
return true;
}
// Getter for the old Combo() API: "item1\0item2\0item3\0"
static bool Items_SingleStringGetter(void* data, int idx, const char** out_text)
{
// FIXME-OPT: we could pre-compute the indices to fasten this. But only 1 active combo means the waste is limited.
const char* items_separated_by_zeros = (const char*)data;
int items_count = 0;
const char* p = items_separated_by_zeros;
while (*p)
{
if (idx == items_count)
break;
p += strlen(p) + 1;
items_count++;
}
if (!*p)
return false;
if (out_text)
*out_text = p;
return true;
}
// Old API, prefer using BeginCombo() nowadays if you can.
bool ImGui::Combo(const char* label, int* current_item, bool (*items_getter)(void*, int, const char**), void* data, int items_count, int popup_max_height_in_items)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
// Call the getter to obtain the preview string which is a parameter to BeginCombo()
const char* preview_value = NULL;
if (*current_item >= 0 && *current_item < items_count)
items_getter(data, *current_item, &preview_value);
// The old Combo() API exposed "popup_max_height_in_items". The new more general BeginCombo() API doesn't have/need it, but we emulate it here.
if (popup_max_height_in_items != -1 && !(g.NextWindowData.Flags & ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_HasSizeConstraint))
SetNextWindowSizeConstraints(ImVec2(0,0), ImVec2(FLT_MAX, CalcMaxPopupHeightFromItemCount(popup_max_height_in_items)));
if (!BeginCombo(label, preview_value, ImGuiComboFlags_None))
return false;
// Display items
// FIXME-OPT: Use clipper (but we need to disable it on the appearing frame to make sure our call to SetItemDefaultFocus() is processed)
bool value_changed = false;
for (int i = 0; i < items_count; i++)
{
PushID((void*)(intptr_t)i);
const bool item_selected = (i == *current_item);
const char* item_text;
if (!items_getter(data, i, &item_text))
item_text = "*Unknown item*";
if (Selectable(item_text, item_selected))
{
value_changed = true;
*current_item = i;
}
if (item_selected)
SetItemDefaultFocus();
PopID();
}
EndCombo();
return value_changed;
}
// Combo box helper allowing to pass an array of strings.
bool ImGui::Combo(const char* label, int* current_item, const char* const items[], int items_count, int height_in_items)
{
const bool value_changed = Combo(label, current_item, Items_ArrayGetter, (void*)items, items_count, height_in_items);
return value_changed;
}
// Combo box helper allowing to pass all items in a single string literal holding multiple zero-terminated items "item1\0item2\0"
bool ImGui::Combo(const char* label, int* current_item, const char* items_separated_by_zeros, int height_in_items)
{
int items_count = 0;
const char* p = items_separated_by_zeros; // FIXME-OPT: Avoid computing this, or at least only when combo is open
while (*p)
{
p += strlen(p) + 1;
items_count++;
}
bool value_changed = Combo(label, current_item, Items_SingleStringGetter, (void*)items_separated_by_zeros, items_count, height_in_items);
return value_changed;
}
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// [SECTION] Data Type and Data Formatting Helpers [Internal]
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// - PatchFormatStringFloatToInt()
// - DataTypeGetInfo()
// - DataTypeFormatString()
// - DataTypeApplyOp()
// - DataTypeApplyOpFromText()
// - GetMinimumStepAtDecimalPrecision
// - RoundScalarWithFormat<>()
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
static const ImGuiDataTypeInfo GDataTypeInfo[] =
{
{ sizeof(char), "%d", "%d" }, // ImGuiDataType_S8
{ sizeof(unsigned char), "%u", "%u" },
{ sizeof(short), "%d", "%d" }, // ImGuiDataType_S16
{ sizeof(unsigned short), "%u", "%u" },
{ sizeof(int), "%d", "%d" }, // ImGuiDataType_S32
{ sizeof(unsigned int), "%u", "%u" },
#ifdef _MSC_VER
{ sizeof(ImS64), "%I64d","%I64d" }, // ImGuiDataType_S64
{ sizeof(ImU64), "%I64u","%I64u" },
#else
{ sizeof(ImS64), "%lld", "%lld" }, // ImGuiDataType_S64
{ sizeof(ImU64), "%llu", "%llu" },
#endif
{ sizeof(float), "%f", "%f" }, // ImGuiDataType_Float (float are promoted to double in va_arg)
{ sizeof(double), "%f", "%lf" }, // ImGuiDataType_Double
};
IM_STATIC_ASSERT(IM_ARRAYSIZE(GDataTypeInfo) == ImGuiDataType_COUNT);
// FIXME-LEGACY: Prior to 1.61 our DragInt() function internally used floats and because of this the compile-time default value for format was "%.0f".
// Even though we changed the compile-time default, we expect users to have carried %f around, which would break the display of DragInt() calls.
// To honor backward compatibility we are rewriting the format string, unless IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS is enabled. What could possibly go wrong?!
static const char* PatchFormatStringFloatToInt(const char* fmt)
{
if (fmt[0] == '%' && fmt[1] == '.' && fmt[2] == '0' && fmt[3] == 'f' && fmt[4] == 0) // Fast legacy path for "%.0f" which is expected to be the most common case.
return "%d";
const char* fmt_start = ImParseFormatFindStart(fmt); // Find % (if any, and ignore %%)
const char* fmt_end = ImParseFormatFindEnd(fmt_start); // Find end of format specifier, which itself is an exercise of confidence/recklessness (because snprintf is dependent on libc or user).
if (fmt_end > fmt_start && fmt_end[-1] == 'f')
{
#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS
if (fmt_start == fmt && fmt_end[0] == 0)
return "%d";
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImFormatString(g.TempBuffer, IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.TempBuffer), "%.*s%%d%s", (int)(fmt_start - fmt), fmt, fmt_end); // Honor leading and trailing decorations, but lose alignment/precision.
return g.TempBuffer;
#else
IM_ASSERT(0 && "DragInt(): Invalid format string!"); // Old versions used a default parameter of "%.0f", please replace with e.g. "%d"
#endif
}
return fmt;
}
const ImGuiDataTypeInfo* ImGui::DataTypeGetInfo(ImGuiDataType data_type)
{
IM_ASSERT(data_type >= 0 && data_type < ImGuiDataType_COUNT);
return &GDataTypeInfo[data_type];
}
int ImGui::DataTypeFormatString(char* buf, int buf_size, ImGuiDataType data_type, const void* p_data, const char* format)
{
// Signedness doesn't matter when pushing integer arguments
if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_S32 || data_type == ImGuiDataType_U32)
return ImFormatString(buf, buf_size, format, *(const ImU32*)p_data);
if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_S64 || data_type == ImGuiDataType_U64)
return ImFormatString(buf, buf_size, format, *(const ImU64*)p_data);
if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Float)
return ImFormatString(buf, buf_size, format, *(const float*)p_data);
if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Double)
return ImFormatString(buf, buf_size, format, *(const double*)p_data);
if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_S8)
return ImFormatString(buf, buf_size, format, *(const ImS8*)p_data);
if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_U8)
return ImFormatString(buf, buf_size, format, *(const ImU8*)p_data);
if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_S16)
return ImFormatString(buf, buf_size, format, *(const ImS16*)p_data);
if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_U16)
return ImFormatString(buf, buf_size, format, *(const ImU16*)p_data);
IM_ASSERT(0);
return 0;
}
void ImGui::DataTypeApplyOp(ImGuiDataType data_type, int op, void* output, void* arg1, const void* arg2)
{
IM_ASSERT(op == '+' || op == '-');
switch (data_type)
{
case ImGuiDataType_S8:
if (op == '+') { *(ImS8*)output = ImAddClampOverflow(*(const ImS8*)arg1, *(const ImS8*)arg2, IM_S8_MIN, IM_S8_MAX); }
if (op == '-') { *(ImS8*)output = ImSubClampOverflow(*(const ImS8*)arg1, *(const ImS8*)arg2, IM_S8_MIN, IM_S8_MAX); }
return;
case ImGuiDataType_U8:
if (op == '+') { *(ImU8*)output = ImAddClampOverflow(*(const ImU8*)arg1, *(const ImU8*)arg2, IM_U8_MIN, IM_U8_MAX); }
if (op == '-') { *(ImU8*)output = ImSubClampOverflow(*(const ImU8*)arg1, *(const ImU8*)arg2, IM_U8_MIN, IM_U8_MAX); }
return;
case ImGuiDataType_S16:
if (op == '+') { *(ImS16*)output = ImAddClampOverflow(*(const ImS16*)arg1, *(const ImS16*)arg2, IM_S16_MIN, IM_S16_MAX); }
if (op == '-') { *(ImS16*)output = ImSubClampOverflow(*(const ImS16*)arg1, *(const ImS16*)arg2, IM_S16_MIN, IM_S16_MAX); }
return;
case ImGuiDataType_U16:
if (op == '+') { *(ImU16*)output = ImAddClampOverflow(*(const ImU16*)arg1, *(const ImU16*)arg2, IM_U16_MIN, IM_U16_MAX); }
if (op == '-') { *(ImU16*)output = ImSubClampOverflow(*(const ImU16*)arg1, *(const ImU16*)arg2, IM_U16_MIN, IM_U16_MAX); }
return;
case ImGuiDataType_S32:
if (op == '+') { *(ImS32*)output = ImAddClampOverflow(*(const ImS32*)arg1, *(const ImS32*)arg2, IM_S32_MIN, IM_S32_MAX); }
if (op == '-') { *(ImS32*)output = ImSubClampOverflow(*(const ImS32*)arg1, *(const ImS32*)arg2, IM_S32_MIN, IM_S32_MAX); }
return;
case ImGuiDataType_U32:
if (op == '+') { *(ImU32*)output = ImAddClampOverflow(*(const ImU32*)arg1, *(const ImU32*)arg2, IM_U32_MIN, IM_U32_MAX); }
if (op == '-') { *(ImU32*)output = ImSubClampOverflow(*(const ImU32*)arg1, *(const ImU32*)arg2, IM_U32_MIN, IM_U32_MAX); }
return;
case ImGuiDataType_S64:
if (op == '+') { *(ImS64*)output = ImAddClampOverflow(*(const ImS64*)arg1, *(const ImS64*)arg2, IM_S64_MIN, IM_S64_MAX); }
if (op == '-') { *(ImS64*)output = ImSubClampOverflow(*(const ImS64*)arg1, *(const ImS64*)arg2, IM_S64_MIN, IM_S64_MAX); }
return;
case ImGuiDataType_U64:
if (op == '+') { *(ImU64*)output = ImAddClampOverflow(*(const ImU64*)arg1, *(const ImU64*)arg2, IM_U64_MIN, IM_U64_MAX); }
if (op == '-') { *(ImU64*)output = ImSubClampOverflow(*(const ImU64*)arg1, *(const ImU64*)arg2, IM_U64_MIN, IM_U64_MAX); }
return;
case ImGuiDataType_Float:
if (op == '+') { *(float*)output = *(const float*)arg1 + *(const float*)arg2; }
if (op == '-') { *(float*)output = *(const float*)arg1 - *(const float*)arg2; }
return;
case ImGuiDataType_Double:
if (op == '+') { *(double*)output = *(const double*)arg1 + *(const double*)arg2; }
if (op == '-') { *(double*)output = *(const double*)arg1 - *(const double*)arg2; }
return;
case ImGuiDataType_COUNT: break;
}
IM_ASSERT(0);
}
// User can input math operators (e.g. +100) to edit a numerical values.
// NB: This is _not_ a full expression evaluator. We should probably add one and replace this dumb mess..
bool ImGui::DataTypeApplyOpFromText(const char* buf, const char* initial_value_buf, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, const char* format)
{
while (ImCharIsBlankA(*buf))
buf++;
// We don't support '-' op because it would conflict with inputing negative value.
// Instead you can use +-100 to subtract from an existing value
char op = buf[0];
if (op == '+' || op == '*' || op == '/')
{
buf++;
while (ImCharIsBlankA(*buf))
buf++;
}
else
{
op = 0;
}
if (!buf[0])
return false;
// Copy the value in an opaque buffer so we can compare at the end of the function if it changed at all.
IM_ASSERT(data_type < ImGuiDataType_COUNT);
int data_backup[2];
const ImGuiDataTypeInfo* type_info = ImGui::DataTypeGetInfo(data_type);
IM_ASSERT(type_info->Size <= sizeof(data_backup));
memcpy(data_backup, p_data, type_info->Size);
if (format == NULL)
format = type_info->ScanFmt;
// FIXME-LEGACY: The aim is to remove those operators and write a proper expression evaluator at some point..
int arg1i = 0;
if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_S32)
{
int* v = (int*)p_data;
int arg0i = *v;
float arg1f = 0.0f;
if (op && sscanf(initial_value_buf, format, &arg0i) < 1)
return false;
// Store operand in a float so we can use fractional value for multipliers (*1.1), but constant always parsed as integer so we can fit big integers (e.g. 2000000003) past float precision
if (op == '+') { if (sscanf(buf, "%d", &arg1i)) *v = (int)(arg0i + arg1i); } // Add (use "+-" to subtract)
else if (op == '*') { if (sscanf(buf, "%f", &arg1f)) *v = (int)(arg0i * arg1f); } // Multiply
else if (op == '/') { if (sscanf(buf, "%f", &arg1f) && arg1f != 0.0f) *v = (int)(arg0i / arg1f); } // Divide
else { if (sscanf(buf, format, &arg1i) == 1) *v = arg1i; } // Assign constant
}
else if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Float)
{
// For floats we have to ignore format with precision (e.g. "%.2f") because sscanf doesn't take them in
format = "%f";
float* v = (float*)p_data;
float arg0f = *v, arg1f = 0.0f;
if (op && sscanf(initial_value_buf, format, &arg0f) < 1)
return false;
if (sscanf(buf, format, &arg1f) < 1)
return false;
if (op == '+') { *v = arg0f + arg1f; } // Add (use "+-" to subtract)
else if (op == '*') { *v = arg0f * arg1f; } // Multiply
else if (op == '/') { if (arg1f != 0.0f) *v = arg0f / arg1f; } // Divide
else { *v = arg1f; } // Assign constant
}
else if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Double)
{
format = "%lf"; // scanf differentiate float/double unlike printf which forces everything to double because of ellipsis
double* v = (double*)p_data;
double arg0f = *v, arg1f = 0.0;
if (op && sscanf(initial_value_buf, format, &arg0f) < 1)
return false;
if (sscanf(buf, format, &arg1f) < 1)
return false;
if (op == '+') { *v = arg0f + arg1f; } // Add (use "+-" to subtract)
else if (op == '*') { *v = arg0f * arg1f; } // Multiply
else if (op == '/') { if (arg1f != 0.0f) *v = arg0f / arg1f; } // Divide
else { *v = arg1f; } // Assign constant
}
else if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_U32 || data_type == ImGuiDataType_S64 || data_type == ImGuiDataType_U64)
{
// All other types assign constant
// We don't bother handling support for legacy operators since they are a little too crappy. Instead we will later implement a proper expression evaluator in the future.
sscanf(buf, format, p_data);
}
else
{
// Small types need a 32-bit buffer to receive the result from scanf()
int v32;
sscanf(buf, format, &v32);
if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_S8)
*(ImS8*)p_data = (ImS8)ImClamp(v32, (int)IM_S8_MIN, (int)IM_S8_MAX);
else if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_U8)
*(ImU8*)p_data = (ImU8)ImClamp(v32, (int)IM_U8_MIN, (int)IM_U8_MAX);
else if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_S16)
*(ImS16*)p_data = (ImS16)ImClamp(v32, (int)IM_S16_MIN, (int)IM_S16_MAX);
else if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_U16)
*(ImU16*)p_data = (ImU16)ImClamp(v32, (int)IM_U16_MIN, (int)IM_U16_MAX);
else
IM_ASSERT(0);
}
return memcmp(data_backup, p_data, type_info->Size) != 0;
}
static float GetMinimumStepAtDecimalPrecision(int decimal_precision)
{
static const float min_steps[10] = { 1.0f, 0.1f, 0.01f, 0.001f, 0.0001f, 0.00001f, 0.000001f, 0.0000001f, 0.00000001f, 0.000000001f };
if (decimal_precision < 0)
return FLT_MIN;
return (decimal_precision < IM_ARRAYSIZE(min_steps)) ? min_steps[decimal_precision] : ImPow(10.0f, (float)-decimal_precision);
}
template<typename TYPE>
static const char* ImAtoi(const char* src, TYPE* output)
{
int negative = 0;
if (*src == '-') { negative = 1; src++; }
if (*src == '+') { src++; }
TYPE v = 0;
while (*src >= '0' && *src <= '9')
v = (v * 10) + (*src++ - '0');
*output = negative ? -v : v;
return src;
}
template<typename TYPE, typename SIGNEDTYPE>
TYPE ImGui::RoundScalarWithFormatT(const char* format, ImGuiDataType data_type, TYPE v)
{
const char* fmt_start = ImParseFormatFindStart(format);
if (fmt_start[0] != '%' || fmt_start[1] == '%') // Don't apply if the value is not visible in the format string
return v;
char v_str[64];
ImFormatString(v_str, IM_ARRAYSIZE(v_str), fmt_start, v);
const char* p = v_str;
while (*p == ' ')
p++;
if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Float || data_type == ImGuiDataType_Double)
v = (TYPE)ImAtof(p);
else
ImAtoi(p, (SIGNEDTYPE*)&v);
return v;
}
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// [SECTION] Widgets: DragScalar, DragFloat, DragInt, etc.
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// - DragBehaviorT<>() [Internal]
// - DragBehavior() [Internal]
// - DragScalar()
// - DragScalarN()
// - DragFloat()
// - DragFloat2()
// - DragFloat3()
// - DragFloat4()
// - DragFloatRange2()
// - DragInt()
// - DragInt2()
// - DragInt3()
// - DragInt4()
// - DragIntRange2()
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// This is called by DragBehavior() when the widget is active (held by mouse or being manipulated with Nav controls)
template<typename TYPE, typename SIGNEDTYPE, typename FLOATTYPE>
bool ImGui::DragBehaviorT(ImGuiDataType data_type, TYPE* v, float v_speed, const TYPE v_min, const TYPE v_max, const char* format, float power, ImGuiDragFlags flags)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
const ImGuiAxis axis = (flags & ImGuiDragFlags_Vertical) ? ImGuiAxis_Y : ImGuiAxis_X;
const bool is_decimal = (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Float) || (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Double);
const bool is_clamped = (v_min < v_max);
const bool is_power = (power != 1.0f && is_decimal && is_clamped && (v_max - v_min < FLT_MAX));
const bool is_locked = (v_min > v_max);
if (is_locked)
return false;
// Default tweak speed
if (v_speed == 0.0f && is_clamped && (v_max - v_min < FLT_MAX))
v_speed = (float)((v_max - v_min) * g.DragSpeedDefaultRatio);
// Inputs accumulates into g.DragCurrentAccum, which is flushed into the current value as soon as it makes a difference with our precision settings
float adjust_delta = 0.0f;
if (g.ActiveIdSource == ImGuiInputSource_Mouse && IsMousePosValid() && g.IO.MouseDragMaxDistanceSqr[0] > 1.0f*1.0f)
{
adjust_delta = g.IO.MouseDelta[axis];
if (g.IO.KeyAlt)
adjust_delta *= 1.0f / 100.0f;
if (g.IO.KeyShift)
adjust_delta *= 10.0f;
}
else if (g.ActiveIdSource == ImGuiInputSource_Nav)
{
int decimal_precision = is_decimal ? ImParseFormatPrecision(format, 3) : 0;
adjust_delta = GetNavInputAmount2d(ImGuiNavDirSourceFlags_Keyboard | ImGuiNavDirSourceFlags_PadDPad, ImGuiInputReadMode_RepeatFast, 1.0f / 10.0f, 10.0f)[axis];
v_speed = ImMax(v_speed, GetMinimumStepAtDecimalPrecision(decimal_precision));
}
adjust_delta *= v_speed;
// For vertical drag we currently assume that Up=higher value (like we do with vertical sliders). This may become a parameter.
if (axis == ImGuiAxis_Y)
adjust_delta = -adjust_delta;
// Clear current value on activation
// Avoid altering values and clamping when we are _already_ past the limits and heading in the same direction, so e.g. if range is 0..255, current value is 300 and we are pushing to the right side, keep the 300.
bool is_just_activated = g.ActiveIdIsJustActivated;
bool is_already_past_limits_and_pushing_outward = is_clamped && ((*v >= v_max && adjust_delta > 0.0f) || (*v <= v_min && adjust_delta < 0.0f));
bool is_drag_direction_change_with_power = is_power && ((adjust_delta < 0 && g.DragCurrentAccum > 0) || (adjust_delta > 0 && g.DragCurrentAccum < 0));
if (is_just_activated || is_already_past_limits_and_pushing_outward || is_drag_direction_change_with_power)
{
g.DragCurrentAccum = 0.0f;
g.DragCurrentAccumDirty = false;
}
else if (adjust_delta != 0.0f)
{
g.DragCurrentAccum += adjust_delta;
g.DragCurrentAccumDirty = true;
}
if (!g.DragCurrentAccumDirty)
return false;
TYPE v_cur = *v;
FLOATTYPE v_old_ref_for_accum_remainder = (FLOATTYPE)0.0f;
if (is_power)
{
// Offset + round to user desired precision, with a curve on the v_min..v_max range to get more precision on one side of the range
FLOATTYPE v_old_norm_curved = ImPow((FLOATTYPE)(v_cur - v_min) / (FLOATTYPE)(v_max - v_min), (FLOATTYPE)1.0f / power);
FLOATTYPE v_new_norm_curved = v_old_norm_curved + (g.DragCurrentAccum / (v_max - v_min));
v_cur = v_min + (SIGNEDTYPE)ImPow(ImSaturate((float)v_new_norm_curved), power) * (v_max - v_min);
v_old_ref_for_accum_remainder = v_old_norm_curved;
}
else
{
v_cur += (SIGNEDTYPE)g.DragCurrentAccum;
}
// Round to user desired precision based on format string
v_cur = RoundScalarWithFormatT<TYPE, SIGNEDTYPE>(format, data_type, v_cur);
// Preserve remainder after rounding has been applied. This also allow slow tweaking of values.
g.DragCurrentAccumDirty = false;
if (is_power)
{
FLOATTYPE v_cur_norm_curved = ImPow((FLOATTYPE)(v_cur - v_min) / (FLOATTYPE)(v_max - v_min), (FLOATTYPE)1.0f / power);
g.DragCurrentAccum -= (float)(v_cur_norm_curved - v_old_ref_for_accum_remainder);
}
else
{
g.DragCurrentAccum -= (float)((SIGNEDTYPE)v_cur - (SIGNEDTYPE)*v);
}
// Lose zero sign for float/double
if (v_cur == (TYPE)-0)
v_cur = (TYPE)0;
// Clamp values (+ handle overflow/wrap-around for integer types)
if (*v != v_cur && is_clamped)
{
if (v_cur < v_min || (v_cur > *v && adjust_delta < 0.0f && !is_decimal))
v_cur = v_min;
if (v_cur > v_max || (v_cur < *v && adjust_delta > 0.0f && !is_decimal))
v_cur = v_max;
}
// Apply result
if (*v == v_cur)
return false;
*v = v_cur;
return true;
}
bool ImGui::DragBehavior(ImGuiID id, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_v, float v_speed, const void* p_min, const void* p_max, const char* format, float power, ImGuiDragFlags flags)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
if (g.ActiveId == id)
{
if (g.ActiveIdSource == ImGuiInputSource_Mouse && !g.IO.MouseDown[0])
ClearActiveID();
else if (g.ActiveIdSource == ImGuiInputSource_Nav && g.NavActivatePressedId == id && !g.ActiveIdIsJustActivated)
ClearActiveID();
}
if (g.ActiveId != id)
return false;
switch (data_type)
{
case ImGuiDataType_S8: { ImS32 v32 = (ImS32)*(ImS8*)p_v; bool r = DragBehaviorT<ImS32, ImS32, float>(ImGuiDataType_S32, &v32, v_speed, p_min ? *(const ImS8*) p_min : IM_S8_MIN, p_max ? *(const ImS8*)p_max : IM_S8_MAX, format, power, flags); if (r) *(ImS8*)p_v = (ImS8)v32; return r; }
case ImGuiDataType_U8: { ImU32 v32 = (ImU32)*(ImU8*)p_v; bool r = DragBehaviorT<ImU32, ImS32, float>(ImGuiDataType_U32, &v32, v_speed, p_min ? *(const ImU8*) p_min : IM_U8_MIN, p_max ? *(const ImU8*)p_max : IM_U8_MAX, format, power, flags); if (r) *(ImU8*)p_v = (ImU8)v32; return r; }
case ImGuiDataType_S16: { ImS32 v32 = (ImS32)*(ImS16*)p_v; bool r = DragBehaviorT<ImS32, ImS32, float>(ImGuiDataType_S32, &v32, v_speed, p_min ? *(const ImS16*)p_min : IM_S16_MIN, p_max ? *(const ImS16*)p_max : IM_S16_MAX, format, power, flags); if (r) *(ImS16*)p_v = (ImS16)v32; return r; }
case ImGuiDataType_U16: { ImU32 v32 = (ImU32)*(ImU16*)p_v; bool r = DragBehaviorT<ImU32, ImS32, float>(ImGuiDataType_U32, &v32, v_speed, p_min ? *(const ImU16*)p_min : IM_U16_MIN, p_max ? *(const ImU16*)p_max : IM_U16_MAX, format, power, flags); if (r) *(ImU16*)p_v = (ImU16)v32; return r; }
case ImGuiDataType_S32: return DragBehaviorT<ImS32, ImS32, float >(data_type, (ImS32*)p_v, v_speed, p_min ? *(const ImS32* )p_min : IM_S32_MIN, p_max ? *(const ImS32* )p_max : IM_S32_MAX, format, power, flags);
case ImGuiDataType_U32: return DragBehaviorT<ImU32, ImS32, float >(data_type, (ImU32*)p_v, v_speed, p_min ? *(const ImU32* )p_min : IM_U32_MIN, p_max ? *(const ImU32* )p_max : IM_U32_MAX, format, power, flags);
case ImGuiDataType_S64: return DragBehaviorT<ImS64, ImS64, double>(data_type, (ImS64*)p_v, v_speed, p_min ? *(const ImS64* )p_min : IM_S64_MIN, p_max ? *(const ImS64* )p_max : IM_S64_MAX, format, power, flags);
case ImGuiDataType_U64: return DragBehaviorT<ImU64, ImS64, double>(data_type, (ImU64*)p_v, v_speed, p_min ? *(const ImU64* )p_min : IM_U64_MIN, p_max ? *(const ImU64* )p_max : IM_U64_MAX, format, power, flags);
case ImGuiDataType_Float: return DragBehaviorT<float, float, float >(data_type, (float*)p_v, v_speed, p_min ? *(const float* )p_min : -FLT_MAX, p_max ? *(const float* )p_max : FLT_MAX, format, power, flags);
case ImGuiDataType_Double: return DragBehaviorT<double,double,double>(data_type, (double*)p_v, v_speed, p_min ? *(const double*)p_min : -DBL_MAX, p_max ? *(const double*)p_max : DBL_MAX, format, power, flags);
case ImGuiDataType_COUNT: break;
}
IM_ASSERT(0);
return false;
}
// Note: p_data, p_min and p_max are _pointers_ to a memory address holding the data. For a Drag widget, p_min and p_max are optional.
// Read code of e.g. SliderFloat(), SliderInt() etc. or examples in 'Demo->Widgets->Data Types' to understand how to use this function directly.
bool ImGui::DragScalar(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, float v_speed, const void* p_min, const void* p_max, const char* format, float power)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
if (power != 1.0f)
IM_ASSERT(p_min != NULL && p_max != NULL); // When using a power curve the drag needs to have known bounds
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label);
const float w = CalcItemWidth();
const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true);
const ImRect frame_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(w, label_size.y + style.FramePadding.y*2.0f));
const ImRect total_bb(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max + ImVec2(label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x : 0.0f, 0.0f));
ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y);
if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, id, &frame_bb))
return false;
// Default format string when passing NULL
if (format == NULL)
format = DataTypeGetInfo(data_type)->PrintFmt;
else if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_S32 && strcmp(format, "%d") != 0) // (FIXME-LEGACY: Patch old "%.0f" format string to use "%d", read function more details.)
format = PatchFormatStringFloatToInt(format);
// Tabbing or CTRL-clicking on Drag turns it into an input box
const bool hovered = ItemHoverable(frame_bb, id);
bool temp_input_is_active = TempInputIsActive(id);
bool temp_input_start = false;
if (!temp_input_is_active)
{
const bool focus_requested = FocusableItemRegister(window, id);
const bool clicked = (hovered && g.IO.MouseClicked[0]);
const bool double_clicked = (hovered && g.IO.MouseDoubleClicked[0]);
if (focus_requested || clicked || double_clicked || g.NavActivateId == id || g.NavInputId == id)
{
SetActiveID(id, window);
SetFocusID(id, window);
FocusWindow(window);
g.ActiveIdUsingNavDirMask = (1 << ImGuiDir_Left) | (1 << ImGuiDir_Right);
if (focus_requested || (clicked && g.IO.KeyCtrl) || double_clicked || g.NavInputId == id)
{
temp_input_start = true;
FocusableItemUnregister(window);
}
}
}
if (temp_input_is_active || temp_input_start)
return TempInputScalar(frame_bb, id, label, data_type, p_data, format);
// Draw frame
const ImU32 frame_col = GetColorU32(g.ActiveId == id ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgActive : g.HoveredId == id ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered : ImGuiCol_FrameBg);
RenderNavHighlight(frame_bb, id);
RenderFrame(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, frame_col, true, style.FrameRounding);
// Drag behavior
const bool value_changed = DragBehavior(id, data_type, p_data, v_speed, p_min, p_max, format, power, ImGuiDragFlags_None);
if (value_changed)
MarkItemEdited(id);
// Display value using user-provided display format so user can add prefix/suffix/decorations to the value.
char value_buf[64];
const char* value_buf_end = value_buf + DataTypeFormatString(value_buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(value_buf), data_type, p_data, format);
RenderTextClipped(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, value_buf, value_buf_end, NULL, ImVec2(0.5f, 0.5f));
if (label_size.x > 0.0f)
RenderText(ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, frame_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), label);
IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(id, label, window->DC.ItemFlags);
return value_changed;
}
bool ImGui::DragScalarN(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, int components, float v_speed, const void* p_min, const void* p_max, const char* format, float power)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
bool value_changed = false;
BeginGroup();
PushID(label);
PushMultiItemsWidths(components, CalcItemWidth());
size_t type_size = GDataTypeInfo[data_type].Size;
for (int i = 0; i < components; i++)
{
PushID(i);
if (i > 0)
SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
value_changed |= DragScalar("", data_type, p_data, v_speed, p_min, p_max, format, power);
PopID();
PopItemWidth();
p_data = (void*)((char*)p_data + type_size);
}
PopID();
const char* label_end = FindRenderedTextEnd(label);
if (label != label_end)
{
SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
TextEx(label, label_end);
}
EndGroup();
return value_changed;
}
bool ImGui::DragFloat(const char* label, float* v, float v_speed, float v_min, float v_max, const char* format, float power)
{
return DragScalar(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, v_speed, &v_min, &v_max, format, power);
}
bool ImGui::DragFloat2(const char* label, float v[2], float v_speed, float v_min, float v_max, const char* format, float power)
{
return DragScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, 2, v_speed, &v_min, &v_max, format, power);
}
bool ImGui::DragFloat3(const char* label, float v[3], float v_speed, float v_min, float v_max, const char* format, float power)
{
return DragScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, 3, v_speed, &v_min, &v_max, format, power);
}
bool ImGui::DragFloat4(const char* label, float v[4], float v_speed, float v_min, float v_max, const char* format, float power)
{
return DragScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, 4, v_speed, &v_min, &v_max, format, power);
}
bool ImGui::DragFloatRange2(const char* label, float* v_current_min, float* v_current_max, float v_speed, float v_min, float v_max, const char* format, const char* format_max, float power)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
PushID(label);
BeginGroup();
PushMultiItemsWidths(2, CalcItemWidth());
bool value_changed = DragFloat("##min", v_current_min, v_speed, (v_min >= v_max) ? -FLT_MAX : v_min, (v_min >= v_max) ? *v_current_max : ImMin(v_max, *v_current_max), format, power);
PopItemWidth();
SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
value_changed |= DragFloat("##max", v_current_max, v_speed, (v_min >= v_max) ? *v_current_min : ImMax(v_min, *v_current_min), (v_min >= v_max) ? FLT_MAX : v_max, format_max ? format_max : format, power);
PopItemWidth();
SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
TextEx(label, FindRenderedTextEnd(label));
EndGroup();
PopID();
return value_changed;
}
// NB: v_speed is float to allow adjusting the drag speed with more precision
bool ImGui::DragInt(const char* label, int* v, float v_speed, int v_min, int v_max, const char* format)
{
return DragScalar(label, ImGuiDataType_S32, v, v_speed, &v_min, &v_max, format);
}
bool ImGui::DragInt2(const char* label, int v[2], float v_speed, int v_min, int v_max, const char* format)
{
return DragScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_S32, v, 2, v_speed, &v_min, &v_max, format);
}
bool ImGui::DragInt3(const char* label, int v[3], float v_speed, int v_min, int v_max, const char* format)
{
return DragScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_S32, v, 3, v_speed, &v_min, &v_max, format);
}
bool ImGui::DragInt4(const char* label, int v[4], float v_speed, int v_min, int v_max, const char* format)
{
return DragScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_S32, v, 4, v_speed, &v_min, &v_max, format);
}
bool ImGui::DragIntRange2(const char* label, int* v_current_min, int* v_current_max, float v_speed, int v_min, int v_max, const char* format, const char* format_max)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
PushID(label);
BeginGroup();
PushMultiItemsWidths(2, CalcItemWidth());
bool value_changed = DragInt("##min", v_current_min, v_speed, (v_min >= v_max) ? INT_MIN : v_min, (v_min >= v_max) ? *v_current_max : ImMin(v_max, *v_current_max), format);
PopItemWidth();
SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
value_changed |= DragInt("##max", v_current_max, v_speed, (v_min >= v_max) ? *v_current_min : ImMax(v_min, *v_current_min), (v_min >= v_max) ? INT_MAX : v_max, format_max ? format_max : format);
PopItemWidth();
SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
TextEx(label, FindRenderedTextEnd(label));
EndGroup();
PopID();
return value_changed;
}
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// [SECTION] Widgets: SliderScalar, SliderFloat, SliderInt, etc.
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// - SliderBehaviorT<>() [Internal]
// - SliderBehavior() [Internal]
// - SliderScalar()
// - SliderScalarN()
// - SliderFloat()
// - SliderFloat2()
// - SliderFloat3()
// - SliderFloat4()
// - SliderAngle()
// - SliderInt()
// - SliderInt2()
// - SliderInt3()
// - SliderInt4()
// - VSliderScalar()
// - VSliderFloat()
// - VSliderInt()
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
template<typename TYPE, typename FLOATTYPE>
float ImGui::SliderCalcRatioFromValueT(ImGuiDataType data_type, TYPE v, TYPE v_min, TYPE v_max, float power, float linear_zero_pos)
{
if (v_min == v_max)
return 0.0f;
const bool is_power = (power != 1.0f) && (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Float || data_type == ImGuiDataType_Double);
const TYPE v_clamped = (v_min < v_max) ? ImClamp(v, v_min, v_max) : ImClamp(v, v_max, v_min);
if (is_power)
{
if (v_clamped < 0.0f)
{
const float f = 1.0f - (float)((v_clamped - v_min) / (ImMin((TYPE)0, v_max) - v_min));
return (1.0f - ImPow(f, 1.0f/power)) * linear_zero_pos;
}
else
{
const float f = (float)((v_clamped - ImMax((TYPE)0, v_min)) / (v_max - ImMax((TYPE)0, v_min)));
return linear_zero_pos + ImPow(f, 1.0f/power) * (1.0f - linear_zero_pos);
}
}
// Linear slider
return (float)((FLOATTYPE)(v_clamped - v_min) / (FLOATTYPE)(v_max - v_min));
}
// FIXME: Move some of the code into SliderBehavior(). Current responsability is larger than what the equivalent DragBehaviorT<> does, we also do some rendering, etc.
template<typename TYPE, typename SIGNEDTYPE, typename FLOATTYPE>
bool ImGui::SliderBehaviorT(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, ImGuiDataType data_type, TYPE* v, const TYPE v_min, const TYPE v_max, const char* format, float power, ImGuiSliderFlags flags, ImRect* out_grab_bb)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
const ImGuiAxis axis = (flags & ImGuiSliderFlags_Vertical) ? ImGuiAxis_Y : ImGuiAxis_X;
const bool is_decimal = (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Float) || (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Double);
const bool is_power = (power != 1.0f) && is_decimal;
const float grab_padding = 2.0f;
const float slider_sz = (bb.Max[axis] - bb.Min[axis]) - grab_padding * 2.0f;
float grab_sz = style.GrabMinSize;
SIGNEDTYPE v_range = (v_min < v_max ? v_max - v_min : v_min - v_max);
if (!is_decimal && v_range >= 0) // v_range < 0 may happen on integer overflows
grab_sz = ImMax((float)(slider_sz / (v_range + 1)), style.GrabMinSize); // For integer sliders: if possible have the grab size represent 1 unit
grab_sz = ImMin(grab_sz, slider_sz);
const float slider_usable_sz = slider_sz - grab_sz;
const float slider_usable_pos_min = bb.Min[axis] + grab_padding + grab_sz * 0.5f;
const float slider_usable_pos_max = bb.Max[axis] - grab_padding - grab_sz * 0.5f;
// For power curve sliders that cross over sign boundary we want the curve to be symmetric around 0.0f
float linear_zero_pos; // 0.0->1.0f
if (is_power && v_min * v_max < 0.0f)
{
// Different sign
const FLOATTYPE linear_dist_min_to_0 = ImPow(v_min >= 0 ? (FLOATTYPE)v_min : -(FLOATTYPE)v_min, (FLOATTYPE)1.0f / power);
const FLOATTYPE linear_dist_max_to_0 = ImPow(v_max >= 0 ? (FLOATTYPE)v_max : -(FLOATTYPE)v_max, (FLOATTYPE)1.0f / power);
linear_zero_pos = (float)(linear_dist_min_to_0 / (linear_dist_min_to_0 + linear_dist_max_to_0));
}
else
{
// Same sign
linear_zero_pos = v_min < 0.0f ? 1.0f : 0.0f;
}
// Process interacting with the slider
bool value_changed = false;
if (g.ActiveId == id)
{
bool set_new_value = false;
float clicked_t = 0.0f;
if (g.ActiveIdSource == ImGuiInputSource_Mouse)
{
if (!g.IO.MouseDown[0])
{
ClearActiveID();
}
else
{
const float mouse_abs_pos = g.IO.MousePos[axis];
clicked_t = (slider_usable_sz > 0.0f) ? ImClamp((mouse_abs_pos - slider_usable_pos_min) / slider_usable_sz, 0.0f, 1.0f) : 0.0f;
if (axis == ImGuiAxis_Y)
clicked_t = 1.0f - clicked_t;
set_new_value = true;
}
}
else if (g.ActiveIdSource == ImGuiInputSource_Nav)
{
const ImVec2 delta2 = GetNavInputAmount2d(ImGuiNavDirSourceFlags_Keyboard | ImGuiNavDirSourceFlags_PadDPad, ImGuiInputReadMode_RepeatFast, 0.0f, 0.0f);
float delta = (axis == ImGuiAxis_X) ? delta2.x : -delta2.y;
if (g.NavActivatePressedId == id && !g.ActiveIdIsJustActivated)
{
ClearActiveID();
}
else if (delta != 0.0f)
{
clicked_t = SliderCalcRatioFromValueT<TYPE,FLOATTYPE>(data_type, *v, v_min, v_max, power, linear_zero_pos);
const int decimal_precision = is_decimal ? ImParseFormatPrecision(format, 3) : 0;
if ((decimal_precision > 0) || is_power)
{
delta /= 100.0f; // Gamepad/keyboard tweak speeds in % of slider bounds
if (IsNavInputDown(ImGuiNavInput_TweakSlow))
delta /= 10.0f;
}
else
{
if ((v_range >= -100.0f && v_range <= 100.0f) || IsNavInputDown(ImGuiNavInput_TweakSlow))
delta = ((delta < 0.0f) ? -1.0f : +1.0f) / (float)v_range; // Gamepad/keyboard tweak speeds in integer steps
else
delta /= 100.0f;
}
if (IsNavInputDown(ImGuiNavInput_TweakFast))
delta *= 10.0f;
set_new_value = true;
if ((clicked_t >= 1.0f && delta > 0.0f) || (clicked_t <= 0.0f && delta < 0.0f)) // This is to avoid applying the saturation when already past the limits
set_new_value = false;
else
clicked_t = ImSaturate(clicked_t + delta);
}
}
if (set_new_value)
{
TYPE v_new;
if (is_power)
{
// Account for power curve scale on both sides of the zero
if (clicked_t < linear_zero_pos)
{
// Negative: rescale to the negative range before powering
float a = 1.0f - (clicked_t / linear_zero_pos);
a = ImPow(a, power);
v_new = ImLerp(ImMin(v_max, (TYPE)0), v_min, a);
}
else
{
// Positive: rescale to the positive range before powering
float a;
if (ImFabs(linear_zero_pos - 1.0f) > 1.e-6f)
a = (clicked_t - linear_zero_pos) / (1.0f - linear_zero_pos);
else
a = clicked_t;
a = ImPow(a, power);
v_new = ImLerp(ImMax(v_min, (TYPE)0), v_max, a);
}
}
else
{
// Linear slider
if (is_decimal)
{
v_new = ImLerp(v_min, v_max, clicked_t);
}
else
{
// For integer values we want the clicking position to match the grab box so we round above
// This code is carefully tuned to work with large values (e.g. high ranges of U64) while preserving this property..
FLOATTYPE v_new_off_f = (v_max - v_min) * clicked_t;
TYPE v_new_off_floor = (TYPE)(v_new_off_f);
TYPE v_new_off_round = (TYPE)(v_new_off_f + (FLOATTYPE)0.5);
if (v_new_off_floor < v_new_off_round)
v_new = v_min + v_new_off_round;
else
v_new = v_min + v_new_off_floor;
}
}
// Round to user desired precision based on format string
v_new = RoundScalarWithFormatT<TYPE,SIGNEDTYPE>(format, data_type, v_new);
// Apply result
if (*v != v_new)
{
*v = v_new;
value_changed = true;
}
}
}
if (slider_sz < 1.0f)
{
*out_grab_bb = ImRect(bb.Min, bb.Min);
}
else
{
// Output grab position so it can be displayed by the caller
float grab_t = SliderCalcRatioFromValueT<TYPE, FLOATTYPE>(data_type, *v, v_min, v_max, power, linear_zero_pos);
if (axis == ImGuiAxis_Y)
grab_t = 1.0f - grab_t;
const float grab_pos = ImLerp(slider_usable_pos_min, slider_usable_pos_max, grab_t);
if (axis == ImGuiAxis_X)
*out_grab_bb = ImRect(grab_pos - grab_sz * 0.5f, bb.Min.y + grab_padding, grab_pos + grab_sz * 0.5f, bb.Max.y - grab_padding);
else
*out_grab_bb = ImRect(bb.Min.x + grab_padding, grab_pos - grab_sz * 0.5f, bb.Max.x - grab_padding, grab_pos + grab_sz * 0.5f);
}
return value_changed;
}
// For 32-bit and larger types, slider bounds are limited to half the natural type range.
// So e.g. an integer Slider between INT_MAX-10 and INT_MAX will fail, but an integer Slider between INT_MAX/2-10 and INT_MAX/2 will be ok.
// It would be possible to lift that limitation with some work but it doesn't seem to be worth it for sliders.
bool ImGui::SliderBehavior(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_v, const void* p_min, const void* p_max, const char* format, float power, ImGuiSliderFlags flags, ImRect* out_grab_bb)
{
switch (data_type)
{
case ImGuiDataType_S8: { ImS32 v32 = (ImS32)*(ImS8*)p_v; bool r = SliderBehaviorT<ImS32, ImS32, float>(bb, id, ImGuiDataType_S32, &v32, *(const ImS8*)p_min, *(const ImS8*)p_max, format, power, flags, out_grab_bb); if (r) *(ImS8*)p_v = (ImS8)v32; return r; }
case ImGuiDataType_U8: { ImU32 v32 = (ImU32)*(ImU8*)p_v; bool r = SliderBehaviorT<ImU32, ImS32, float>(bb, id, ImGuiDataType_U32, &v32, *(const ImU8*)p_min, *(const ImU8*)p_max, format, power, flags, out_grab_bb); if (r) *(ImU8*)p_v = (ImU8)v32; return r; }
case ImGuiDataType_S16: { ImS32 v32 = (ImS32)*(ImS16*)p_v; bool r = SliderBehaviorT<ImS32, ImS32, float>(bb, id, ImGuiDataType_S32, &v32, *(const ImS16*)p_min, *(const ImS16*)p_max, format, power, flags, out_grab_bb); if (r) *(ImS16*)p_v = (ImS16)v32; return r; }
case ImGuiDataType_U16: { ImU32 v32 = (ImU32)*(ImU16*)p_v; bool r = SliderBehaviorT<ImU32, ImS32, float>(bb, id, ImGuiDataType_U32, &v32, *(const ImU16*)p_min, *(const ImU16*)p_max, format, power, flags, out_grab_bb); if (r) *(ImU16*)p_v = (ImU16)v32; return r; }
case ImGuiDataType_S32:
IM_ASSERT(*(const ImS32*)p_min >= IM_S32_MIN/2 && *(const ImS32*)p_max <= IM_S32_MAX/2);
return SliderBehaviorT<ImS32, ImS32, float >(bb, id, data_type, (ImS32*)p_v, *(const ImS32*)p_min, *(const ImS32*)p_max, format, power, flags, out_grab_bb);
case ImGuiDataType_U32:
IM_ASSERT(*(const ImU32*)p_max <= IM_U32_MAX/2);
return SliderBehaviorT<ImU32, ImS32, float >(bb, id, data_type, (ImU32*)p_v, *(const ImU32*)p_min, *(const ImU32*)p_max, format, power, flags, out_grab_bb);
case ImGuiDataType_S64:
IM_ASSERT(*(const ImS64*)p_min >= IM_S64_MIN/2 && *(const ImS64*)p_max <= IM_S64_MAX/2);
return SliderBehaviorT<ImS64, ImS64, double>(bb, id, data_type, (ImS64*)p_v, *(const ImS64*)p_min, *(const ImS64*)p_max, format, power, flags, out_grab_bb);
case ImGuiDataType_U64:
IM_ASSERT(*(const ImU64*)p_max <= IM_U64_MAX/2);
return SliderBehaviorT<ImU64, ImS64, double>(bb, id, data_type, (ImU64*)p_v, *(const ImU64*)p_min, *(const ImU64*)p_max, format, power, flags, out_grab_bb);
case ImGuiDataType_Float:
IM_ASSERT(*(const float*)p_min >= -FLT_MAX/2.0f && *(const float*)p_max <= FLT_MAX/2.0f);
return SliderBehaviorT<float, float, float >(bb, id, data_type, (float*)p_v, *(const float*)p_min, *(const float*)p_max, format, power, flags, out_grab_bb);
case ImGuiDataType_Double:
IM_ASSERT(*(const double*)p_min >= -DBL_MAX/2.0f && *(const double*)p_max <= DBL_MAX/2.0f);
return SliderBehaviorT<double,double,double>(bb, id, data_type, (double*)p_v, *(const double*)p_min, *(const double*)p_max, format, power, flags, out_grab_bb);
case ImGuiDataType_COUNT: break;
}
IM_ASSERT(0);
return false;
}
// Note: p_data, p_min and p_max are _pointers_ to a memory address holding the data. For a slider, they are all required.
// Read code of e.g. SliderFloat(), SliderInt() etc. or examples in 'Demo->Widgets->Data Types' to understand how to use this function directly.
bool ImGui::SliderScalar(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, const void* p_min, const void* p_max, const char* format, float power)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label);
const float w = CalcItemWidth();
const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true);
const ImRect frame_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(w, label_size.y + style.FramePadding.y*2.0f));
const ImRect total_bb(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max + ImVec2(label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x : 0.0f, 0.0f));
ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y);
if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, id, &frame_bb))
return false;
// Default format string when passing NULL
if (format == NULL)
format = DataTypeGetInfo(data_type)->PrintFmt;
else if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_S32 && strcmp(format, "%d") != 0) // (FIXME-LEGACY: Patch old "%.0f" format string to use "%d", read function more details.)
format = PatchFormatStringFloatToInt(format);
// Tabbing or CTRL-clicking on Slider turns it into an input box
const bool hovered = ItemHoverable(frame_bb, id);
bool temp_input_is_active = TempInputIsActive(id);
bool temp_input_start = false;
if (!temp_input_is_active)
{
const bool focus_requested = FocusableItemRegister(window, id);
const bool clicked = (hovered && g.IO.MouseClicked[0]);
if (focus_requested || clicked || g.NavActivateId == id || g.NavInputId == id)
{
SetActiveID(id, window);
SetFocusID(id, window);
FocusWindow(window);
g.ActiveIdUsingNavDirMask |= (1 << ImGuiDir_Left) | (1 << ImGuiDir_Right);
if (focus_requested || (clicked && g.IO.KeyCtrl) || g.NavInputId == id)
{
temp_input_start = true;
FocusableItemUnregister(window);
}
}
}
if (temp_input_is_active || temp_input_start)
return TempInputScalar(frame_bb, id, label, data_type, p_data, format);
// Draw frame
const ImU32 frame_col = GetColorU32(g.ActiveId == id ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgActive : g.HoveredId == id ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered : ImGuiCol_FrameBg);
RenderNavHighlight(frame_bb, id);
RenderFrame(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, frame_col, true, g.Style.FrameRounding);
// Slider behavior
ImRect grab_bb;
const bool value_changed = SliderBehavior(frame_bb, id, data_type, p_data, p_min, p_max, format, power, ImGuiSliderFlags_None, &grab_bb);
if (value_changed)
MarkItemEdited(id);
// Render grab
if (grab_bb.Max.x > grab_bb.Min.x)
window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(grab_bb.Min, grab_bb.Max, GetColorU32(g.ActiveId == id ? ImGuiCol_SliderGrabActive : ImGuiCol_SliderGrab), style.GrabRounding);
// Display value using user-provided display format so user can add prefix/suffix/decorations to the value.
char value_buf[64];
const char* value_buf_end = value_buf + DataTypeFormatString(value_buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(value_buf), data_type, p_data, format);
RenderTextClipped(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, value_buf, value_buf_end, NULL, ImVec2(0.5f,0.5f));
if (label_size.x > 0.0f)
RenderText(ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, frame_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), label);
IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(id, label, window->DC.ItemFlags);
return value_changed;
}
// Add multiple sliders on 1 line for compact edition of multiple components
bool ImGui::SliderScalarN(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* v, int components, const void* v_min, const void* v_max, const char* format, float power)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
bool value_changed = false;
BeginGroup();
PushID(label);
PushMultiItemsWidths(components, CalcItemWidth());
size_t type_size = GDataTypeInfo[data_type].Size;
for (int i = 0; i < components; i++)
{
PushID(i);
if (i > 0)
SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
value_changed |= SliderScalar("", data_type, v, v_min, v_max, format, power);
PopID();
PopItemWidth();
v = (void*)((char*)v + type_size);
}
PopID();
const char* label_end = FindRenderedTextEnd(label);
if (label != label_end)
{
SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
TextEx(label, label_end);
}
EndGroup();
return value_changed;
}
bool ImGui::SliderFloat(const char* label, float* v, float v_min, float v_max, const char* format, float power)
{
return SliderScalar(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, &v_min, &v_max, format, power);
}
bool ImGui::SliderFloat2(const char* label, float v[2], float v_min, float v_max, const char* format, float power)
{
return SliderScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, 2, &v_min, &v_max, format, power);
}
bool ImGui::SliderFloat3(const char* label, float v[3], float v_min, float v_max, const char* format, float power)
{
return SliderScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, 3, &v_min, &v_max, format, power);
}
bool ImGui::SliderFloat4(const char* label, float v[4], float v_min, float v_max, const char* format, float power)
{
return SliderScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, 4, &v_min, &v_max, format, power);
}
bool ImGui::SliderAngle(const char* label, float* v_rad, float v_degrees_min, float v_degrees_max, const char* format)
{
if (format == NULL)
format = "%.0f deg";
float v_deg = (*v_rad) * 360.0f / (2*IM_PI);
bool value_changed = SliderFloat(label, &v_deg, v_degrees_min, v_degrees_max, format, 1.0f);
*v_rad = v_deg * (2*IM_PI) / 360.0f;
return value_changed;
}
bool ImGui::SliderInt(const char* label, int* v, int v_min, int v_max, const char* format)
{
return SliderScalar(label, ImGuiDataType_S32, v, &v_min, &v_max, format);
}
bool ImGui::SliderInt2(const char* label, int v[2], int v_min, int v_max, const char* format)
{
return SliderScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_S32, v, 2, &v_min, &v_max, format);
}
bool ImGui::SliderInt3(const char* label, int v[3], int v_min, int v_max, const char* format)
{
return SliderScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_S32, v, 3, &v_min, &v_max, format);
}
bool ImGui::SliderInt4(const char* label, int v[4], int v_min, int v_max, const char* format)
{
return SliderScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_S32, v, 4, &v_min, &v_max, format);
}
bool ImGui::VSliderScalar(const char* label, const ImVec2& size, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, const void* p_min, const void* p_max, const char* format, float power)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label);
const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true);
const ImRect frame_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + size);
const ImRect bb(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max + ImVec2(label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x : 0.0f, 0.0f));
ItemSize(bb, style.FramePadding.y);
if (!ItemAdd(frame_bb, id))
return false;
// Default format string when passing NULL
if (format == NULL)
format = DataTypeGetInfo(data_type)->PrintFmt;
else if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_S32 && strcmp(format, "%d") != 0) // (FIXME-LEGACY: Patch old "%.0f" format string to use "%d", read function more details.)
format = PatchFormatStringFloatToInt(format);
const bool hovered = ItemHoverable(frame_bb, id);
if ((hovered && g.IO.MouseClicked[0]) || g.NavActivateId == id || g.NavInputId == id)
{
SetActiveID(id, window);
SetFocusID(id, window);
FocusWindow(window);
g.ActiveIdUsingNavDirMask |= (1 << ImGuiDir_Up) | (1 << ImGuiDir_Down);
}
// Draw frame
const ImU32 frame_col = GetColorU32(g.ActiveId == id ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgActive : g.HoveredId == id ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered : ImGuiCol_FrameBg);
RenderNavHighlight(frame_bb, id);
RenderFrame(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, frame_col, true, g.Style.FrameRounding);
// Slider behavior
ImRect grab_bb;
const bool value_changed = SliderBehavior(frame_bb, id, data_type, p_data, p_min, p_max, format, power, ImGuiSliderFlags_Vertical, &grab_bb);
if (value_changed)
MarkItemEdited(id);
// Render grab
if (grab_bb.Max.y > grab_bb.Min.y)
window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(grab_bb.Min, grab_bb.Max, GetColorU32(g.ActiveId == id ? ImGuiCol_SliderGrabActive : ImGuiCol_SliderGrab), style.GrabRounding);
// Display value using user-provided display format so user can add prefix/suffix/decorations to the value.
// For the vertical slider we allow centered text to overlap the frame padding
char value_buf[64];
const char* value_buf_end = value_buf + DataTypeFormatString(value_buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(value_buf), data_type, p_data, format);
RenderTextClipped(ImVec2(frame_bb.Min.x, frame_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), frame_bb.Max, value_buf, value_buf_end, NULL, ImVec2(0.5f,0.0f));
if (label_size.x > 0.0f)
RenderText(ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, frame_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), label);
return value_changed;
}
bool ImGui::VSliderFloat(const char* label, const ImVec2& size, float* v, float v_min, float v_max, const char* format, float power)
{
return VSliderScalar(label, size, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, &v_min, &v_max, format, power);
}
bool ImGui::VSliderInt(const char* label, const ImVec2& size, int* v, int v_min, int v_max, const char* format)
{
return VSliderScalar(label, size, ImGuiDataType_S32, v, &v_min, &v_max, format);
}
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// [SECTION] Widgets: InputScalar, InputFloat, InputInt, etc.
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// - ImParseFormatFindStart() [Internal]
// - ImParseFormatFindEnd() [Internal]
// - ImParseFormatTrimDecorations() [Internal]
// - ImParseFormatPrecision() [Internal]
// - TempInputTextScalar() [Internal]
// - InputScalar()
// - InputScalarN()
// - InputFloat()
// - InputFloat2()
// - InputFloat3()
// - InputFloat4()
// - InputInt()
// - InputInt2()
// - InputInt3()
// - InputInt4()
// - InputDouble()
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// We don't use strchr() because our strings are usually very short and often start with '%'
const char* ImParseFormatFindStart(const char* fmt)
{
while (char c = fmt[0])
{
if (c == '%' && fmt[1] != '%')
return fmt;
else if (c == '%')
fmt++;
fmt++;
}
return fmt;
}
const char* ImParseFormatFindEnd(const char* fmt)
{
// Printf/scanf types modifiers: I/L/h/j/l/t/w/z. Other uppercase letters qualify as types aka end of the format.
if (fmt[0] != '%')
return fmt;
const unsigned int ignored_uppercase_mask = (1 << ('I'-'A')) | (1 << ('L'-'A'));
const unsigned int ignored_lowercase_mask = (1 << ('h'-'a')) | (1 << ('j'-'a')) | (1 << ('l'-'a')) | (1 << ('t'-'a')) | (1 << ('w'-'a')) | (1 << ('z'-'a'));
for (char c; (c = *fmt) != 0; fmt++)
{
if (c >= 'A' && c <= 'Z' && ((1 << (c - 'A')) & ignored_uppercase_mask) == 0)
return fmt + 1;
if (c >= 'a' && c <= 'z' && ((1 << (c - 'a')) & ignored_lowercase_mask) == 0)
return fmt + 1;
}
return fmt;
}
// Extract the format out of a format string with leading or trailing decorations
// fmt = "blah blah" -> return fmt
// fmt = "%.3f" -> return fmt
// fmt = "hello %.3f" -> return fmt + 6
// fmt = "%.3f hello" -> return buf written with "%.3f"
const char* ImParseFormatTrimDecorations(const char* fmt, char* buf, size_t buf_size)
{
const char* fmt_start = ImParseFormatFindStart(fmt);
if (fmt_start[0] != '%')
return fmt;
const char* fmt_end = ImParseFormatFindEnd(fmt_start);
if (fmt_end[0] == 0) // If we only have leading decoration, we don't need to copy the data.
return fmt_start;
ImStrncpy(buf, fmt_start, ImMin((size_t)(fmt_end - fmt_start) + 1, buf_size));
return buf;
}
// Parse display precision back from the display format string
// FIXME: This is still used by some navigation code path to infer a minimum tweak step, but we should aim to rework widgets so it isn't needed.
int ImParseFormatPrecision(const char* fmt, int default_precision)
{
fmt = ImParseFormatFindStart(fmt);
if (fmt[0] != '%')
return default_precision;
fmt++;
while (*fmt >= '0' && *fmt <= '9')
fmt++;
int precision = INT_MAX;
if (*fmt == '.')
{
fmt = ImAtoi<int>(fmt + 1, &precision);
if (precision < 0 || precision > 99)
precision = default_precision;
}
if (*fmt == 'e' || *fmt == 'E') // Maximum precision with scientific notation
precision = -1;
if ((*fmt == 'g' || *fmt == 'G') && precision == INT_MAX)
precision = -1;
return (precision == INT_MAX) ? default_precision : precision;
}
// Create text input in place of another active widget (e.g. used when doing a CTRL+Click on drag/slider widgets)
// FIXME: Facilitate using this in variety of other situations.
bool ImGui::TempInputText(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, const char* label, char* buf, int buf_size, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags)
{
// On the first frame, g.TempInputTextId == 0, then on subsequent frames it becomes == id.
// We clear ActiveID on the first frame to allow the InputText() taking it back.
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
const bool init = (g.TempInputId != id);
if (init)
ClearActiveID();
g.CurrentWindow->DC.CursorPos = bb.Min;
bool value_changed = InputTextEx(label, NULL, buf, buf_size, bb.GetSize(), flags);
if (init)
{
// First frame we started displaying the InputText widget, we expect it to take the active id.
IM_ASSERT(g.ActiveId == id);
g.TempInputId = g.ActiveId;
}
return value_changed;
}
bool ImGui::TempInputScalar(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, const char* format)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
char fmt_buf[32];
char data_buf[32];
format = ImParseFormatTrimDecorations(format, fmt_buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(fmt_buf));
DataTypeFormatString(data_buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(data_buf), data_type, p_data, format);
ImStrTrimBlanks(data_buf);
ImGuiInputTextFlags flags = ImGuiInputTextFlags_AutoSelectAll | ImGuiInputTextFlags_NoMarkEdited;
flags |= ((data_type == ImGuiDataType_Float || data_type == ImGuiDataType_Double) ? ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsScientific : ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsDecimal);
bool value_changed = TempInputText(bb, id, label, data_buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(data_buf), flags);
if (value_changed)
{
value_changed = DataTypeApplyOpFromText(data_buf, g.InputTextState.InitialTextA.Data, data_type, p_data, NULL);
if (value_changed)
MarkItemEdited(id);
}
return value_changed;
}
// Note: p_data, p_step, p_step_fast are _pointers_ to a memory address holding the data. For an Input widget, p_step and p_step_fast are optional.
// Read code of e.g. InputFloat(), InputInt() etc. or examples in 'Demo->Widgets->Data Types' to understand how to use this function directly.
bool ImGui::InputScalar(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, const void* p_step, const void* p_step_fast, const char* format, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
if (format == NULL)
format = DataTypeGetInfo(data_type)->PrintFmt;
char buf[64];
DataTypeFormatString(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), data_type, p_data, format);
bool value_changed = false;
if ((flags & (ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsHexadecimal | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsScientific)) == 0)
flags |= ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsDecimal;
flags |= ImGuiInputTextFlags_AutoSelectAll;
flags |= ImGuiInputTextFlags_NoMarkEdited; // We call MarkItemEdited() ourselve by comparing the actual data rather than the string.
if (p_step != NULL)
{
const float button_size = GetFrameHeight();
BeginGroup(); // The only purpose of the group here is to allow the caller to query item data e.g. IsItemActive()
PushID(label);
SetNextItemWidth(ImMax(1.0f, CalcItemWidth() - (button_size + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x) * 2));
if (InputText("", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), flags)) // PushId(label) + "" gives us the expected ID from outside point of view
value_changed = DataTypeApplyOpFromText(buf, g.InputTextState.InitialTextA.Data, data_type, p_data, format);
// Step buttons
const ImVec2 backup_frame_padding = style.FramePadding;
style.FramePadding.x = style.FramePadding.y;
ImGuiButtonFlags button_flags = ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat | ImGuiButtonFlags_DontClosePopups;
if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_ReadOnly)
button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_Disabled;
SameLine(0, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
if (ButtonEx("-", ImVec2(button_size, button_size), button_flags))
{
DataTypeApplyOp(data_type, '-', p_data, p_data, g.IO.KeyCtrl && p_step_fast ? p_step_fast : p_step);
value_changed = true;
}
SameLine(0, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
if (ButtonEx("+", ImVec2(button_size, button_size), button_flags))
{
DataTypeApplyOp(data_type, '+', p_data, p_data, g.IO.KeyCtrl && p_step_fast ? p_step_fast : p_step);
value_changed = true;
}
const char* label_end = FindRenderedTextEnd(label);
if (label != label_end)
{
SameLine(0, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
TextEx(label, label_end);
}
style.FramePadding = backup_frame_padding;
PopID();
EndGroup();
}
else
{
if (InputText(label, buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), flags))
value_changed = DataTypeApplyOpFromText(buf, g.InputTextState.InitialTextA.Data, data_type, p_data, format);
}
if (value_changed)
MarkItemEdited(window->DC.LastItemId);
return value_changed;
}
bool ImGui::InputScalarN(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, int components, const void* p_step, const void* p_step_fast, const char* format, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
bool value_changed = false;
BeginGroup();
PushID(label);
PushMultiItemsWidths(components, CalcItemWidth());
size_t type_size = GDataTypeInfo[data_type].Size;
for (int i = 0; i < components; i++)
{
PushID(i);
if (i > 0)
SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
value_changed |= InputScalar("", data_type, p_data, p_step, p_step_fast, format, flags);
PopID();
PopItemWidth();
p_data = (void*)((char*)p_data + type_size);
}
PopID();
const char* label_end = FindRenderedTextEnd(label);
if (label != label_end)
{
SameLine(0.0f, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
TextEx(label, label_end);
}
EndGroup();
return value_changed;
}
bool ImGui::InputFloat(const char* label, float* v, float step, float step_fast, const char* format, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags)
{
flags |= ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsScientific;
return InputScalar(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, (void*)v, (void*)(step>0.0f ? &step : NULL), (void*)(step_fast>0.0f ? &step_fast : NULL), format, flags);
}
bool ImGui::InputFloat2(const char* label, float v[2], const char* format, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags)
{
return InputScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, 2, NULL, NULL, format, flags);
}
bool ImGui::InputFloat3(const char* label, float v[3], const char* format, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags)
{
return InputScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, 3, NULL, NULL, format, flags);
}
bool ImGui::InputFloat4(const char* label, float v[4], const char* format, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags)
{
return InputScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, 4, NULL, NULL, format, flags);
}
// Prefer using "const char* format" directly, which is more flexible and consistent with other API.
#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS
bool ImGui::InputFloat(const char* label, float* v, float step, float step_fast, int decimal_precision, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags)
{
char format[16] = "%f";
if (decimal_precision >= 0)
ImFormatString(format, IM_ARRAYSIZE(format), "%%.%df", decimal_precision);
return InputFloat(label, v, step, step_fast, format, flags);
}
bool ImGui::InputFloat2(const char* label, float v[2], int decimal_precision, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags)
{
char format[16] = "%f";
if (decimal_precision >= 0)
ImFormatString(format, IM_ARRAYSIZE(format), "%%.%df", decimal_precision);
return InputScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, 2, NULL, NULL, format, flags);
}
bool ImGui::InputFloat3(const char* label, float v[3], int decimal_precision, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags)
{
char format[16] = "%f";
if (decimal_precision >= 0)
ImFormatString(format, IM_ARRAYSIZE(format), "%%.%df", decimal_precision);
return InputScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, 3, NULL, NULL, format, flags);
}
bool ImGui::InputFloat4(const char* label, float v[4], int decimal_precision, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags)
{
char format[16] = "%f";
if (decimal_precision >= 0)
ImFormatString(format, IM_ARRAYSIZE(format), "%%.%df", decimal_precision);
return InputScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, 4, NULL, NULL, format, flags);
}
#endif // IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS
bool ImGui::InputInt(const char* label, int* v, int step, int step_fast, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags)
{
// Hexadecimal input provided as a convenience but the flag name is awkward. Typically you'd use InputText() to parse your own data, if you want to handle prefixes.
const char* format = (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsHexadecimal) ? "%08X" : "%d";
return InputScalar(label, ImGuiDataType_S32, (void*)v, (void*)(step>0 ? &step : NULL), (void*)(step_fast>0 ? &step_fast : NULL), format, flags);
}
bool ImGui::InputInt2(const char* label, int v[2], ImGuiInputTextFlags flags)
{
return InputScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_S32, v, 2, NULL, NULL, "%d", flags);
}
bool ImGui::InputInt3(const char* label, int v[3], ImGuiInputTextFlags flags)
{
return InputScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_S32, v, 3, NULL, NULL, "%d", flags);
}
bool ImGui::InputInt4(const char* label, int v[4], ImGuiInputTextFlags flags)
{
return InputScalarN(label, ImGuiDataType_S32, v, 4, NULL, NULL, "%d", flags);
}
bool ImGui::InputDouble(const char* label, double* v, double step, double step_fast, const char* format, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags)
{
flags |= ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsScientific;
return InputScalar(label, ImGuiDataType_Double, (void*)v, (void*)(step>0.0 ? &step : NULL), (void*)(step_fast>0.0 ? &step_fast : NULL), format, flags);
}
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// [SECTION] Widgets: InputText, InputTextMultiline, InputTextWithHint
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// - InputText()
// - InputTextWithHint()
// - InputTextMultiline()
// - InputTextEx() [Internal]
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
bool ImGui::InputText(const char* label, char* buf, size_t buf_size, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags, ImGuiInputTextCallback callback, void* user_data)
{
IM_ASSERT(!(flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_Multiline)); // call InputTextMultiline()
return InputTextEx(label, NULL, buf, (int)buf_size, ImVec2(0,0), flags, callback, user_data);
}
bool ImGui::InputTextMultiline(const char* label, char* buf, size_t buf_size, const ImVec2& size, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags, ImGuiInputTextCallback callback, void* user_data)
{
return InputTextEx(label, NULL, buf, (int)buf_size, size, flags | ImGuiInputTextFlags_Multiline, callback, user_data);
}
bool ImGui::InputTextWithHint(const char* label, const char* hint, char* buf, size_t buf_size, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags, ImGuiInputTextCallback callback, void* user_data)
{
IM_ASSERT(!(flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_Multiline)); // call InputTextMultiline()
return InputTextEx(label, hint, buf, (int)buf_size, ImVec2(0, 0), flags, callback, user_data);
}
static int InputTextCalcTextLenAndLineCount(const char* text_begin, const char** out_text_end)
{
int line_count = 0;
const char* s = text_begin;
while (char c = *s++) // We are only matching for \n so we can ignore UTF-8 decoding
if (c == '\n')
line_count++;
s--;
if (s[0] != '\n' && s[0] != '\r')
line_count++;
*out_text_end = s;
return line_count;
}
static ImVec2 InputTextCalcTextSizeW(const ImWchar* text_begin, const ImWchar* text_end, const ImWchar** remaining, ImVec2* out_offset, bool stop_on_new_line)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImFont* font = g.Font;
const float line_height = g.FontSize;
const float scale = line_height / font->FontSize;
ImVec2 text_size = ImVec2(0,0);
float line_width = 0.0f;
const ImWchar* s = text_begin;
while (s < text_end)
{
unsigned int c = (unsigned int)(*s++);
if (c == '\n')
{
text_size.x = ImMax(text_size.x, line_width);
text_size.y += line_height;
line_width = 0.0f;
if (stop_on_new_line)
break;
continue;
}
if (c == '\r')
continue;
const float char_width = font->GetCharAdvance((ImWchar)c) * scale;
line_width += char_width;
}
if (text_size.x < line_width)
text_size.x = line_width;
if (out_offset)
*out_offset = ImVec2(line_width, text_size.y + line_height); // offset allow for the possibility of sitting after a trailing \n
if (line_width > 0 || text_size.y == 0.0f) // whereas size.y will ignore the trailing \n
text_size.y += line_height;
if (remaining)
*remaining = s;
return text_size;
}
// Wrapper for stb_textedit.h to edit text (our wrapper is for: statically sized buffer, single-line, wchar characters. InputText converts between UTF-8 and wchar)
namespace ImStb
{
static int STB_TEXTEDIT_STRINGLEN(const STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj) { return obj->CurLenW; }
static ImWchar STB_TEXTEDIT_GETCHAR(const STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj, int idx) { return obj->TextW[idx]; }
static float STB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj, int line_start_idx, int char_idx) { ImWchar c = obj->TextW[line_start_idx + char_idx]; if (c == '\n') return STB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH_NEWLINE; ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; return g.Font->GetCharAdvance(c) * (g.FontSize / g.Font->FontSize); }
static int STB_TEXTEDIT_KEYTOTEXT(int key) { return key >= 0x200000 ? 0 : key; }
static ImWchar STB_TEXTEDIT_NEWLINE = '\n';
static void STB_TEXTEDIT_LAYOUTROW(StbTexteditRow* r, STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj, int line_start_idx)
{
const ImWchar* text = obj->TextW.Data;
const ImWchar* text_remaining = NULL;
const ImVec2 size = InputTextCalcTextSizeW(text + line_start_idx, text + obj->CurLenW, &text_remaining, NULL, true);
r->x0 = 0.0f;
r->x1 = size.x;
r->baseline_y_delta = size.y;
r->ymin = 0.0f;
r->ymax = size.y;
r->num_chars = (int)(text_remaining - (text + line_start_idx));
}
static bool is_separator(unsigned int c) { return ImCharIsBlankW(c) || c==',' || c==';' || c=='(' || c==')' || c=='{' || c=='}' || c=='[' || c==']' || c=='|'; }
static int is_word_boundary_from_right(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj, int idx) { return idx > 0 ? (is_separator( obj->TextW[idx-1] ) && !is_separator( obj->TextW[idx] ) ) : 1; }
static int STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDLEFT_IMPL(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj, int idx) { idx--; while (idx >= 0 && !is_word_boundary_from_right(obj, idx)) idx--; return idx < 0 ? 0 : idx; }
#ifdef __APPLE__ // FIXME: Move setting to IO structure
static int is_word_boundary_from_left(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj, int idx) { return idx > 0 ? (!is_separator( obj->TextW[idx-1] ) && is_separator( obj->TextW[idx] ) ) : 1; }
static int STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDRIGHT_IMPL(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj, int idx) { idx++; int len = obj->CurLenW; while (idx < len && !is_word_boundary_from_left(obj, idx)) idx++; return idx > len ? len : idx; }
#else
static int STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDRIGHT_IMPL(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj, int idx) { idx++; int len = obj->CurLenW; while (idx < len && !is_word_boundary_from_right(obj, idx)) idx++; return idx > len ? len : idx; }
#endif
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDLEFT STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDLEFT_IMPL // They need to be #define for stb_textedit.h
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDRIGHT STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDRIGHT_IMPL
static void STB_TEXTEDIT_DELETECHARS(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj, int pos, int n)
{
ImWchar* dst = obj->TextW.Data + pos;
// We maintain our buffer length in both UTF-8 and wchar formats
obj->CurLenA -= ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromStr(dst, dst + n);
obj->CurLenW -= n;
// Offset remaining text (FIXME-OPT: Use memmove)
const ImWchar* src = obj->TextW.Data + pos + n;
while (ImWchar c = *src++)
*dst++ = c;
*dst = '\0';
}
static bool STB_TEXTEDIT_INSERTCHARS(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj, int pos, const ImWchar* new_text, int new_text_len)
{
const bool is_resizable = (obj->UserFlags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackResize) != 0;
const int text_len = obj->CurLenW;
IM_ASSERT(pos <= text_len);
const int new_text_len_utf8 = ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromStr(new_text, new_text + new_text_len);
if (!is_resizable && (new_text_len_utf8 + obj->CurLenA + 1 > obj->BufCapacityA))
return false;
// Grow internal buffer if needed
if (new_text_len + text_len + 1 > obj->TextW.Size)
{
if (!is_resizable)
return false;
IM_ASSERT(text_len < obj->TextW.Size);
obj->TextW.resize(text_len + ImClamp(new_text_len * 4, 32, ImMax(256, new_text_len)) + 1);
}
ImWchar* text = obj->TextW.Data;
if (pos != text_len)
memmove(text + pos + new_text_len, text + pos, (size_t)(text_len - pos) * sizeof(ImWchar));
memcpy(text + pos, new_text, (size_t)new_text_len * sizeof(ImWchar));
obj->CurLenW += new_text_len;
obj->CurLenA += new_text_len_utf8;
obj->TextW[obj->CurLenW] = '\0';
return true;
}
// We don't use an enum so we can build even with conflicting symbols (if another user of stb_textedit.h leak their STB_TEXTEDIT_K_* symbols)
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LEFT 0x200000 // keyboard input to move cursor left
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_RIGHT 0x200001 // keyboard input to move cursor right
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_UP 0x200002 // keyboard input to move cursor up
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_DOWN 0x200003 // keyboard input to move cursor down
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINESTART 0x200004 // keyboard input to move cursor to start of line
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINEEND 0x200005 // keyboard input to move cursor to end of line
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTSTART 0x200006 // keyboard input to move cursor to start of text
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTEND 0x200007 // keyboard input to move cursor to end of text
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_DELETE 0x200008 // keyboard input to delete selection or character under cursor
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_BACKSPACE 0x200009 // keyboard input to delete selection or character left of cursor
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_UNDO 0x20000A // keyboard input to perform undo
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_REDO 0x20000B // keyboard input to perform redo
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDLEFT 0x20000C // keyboard input to move cursor left one word
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDRIGHT 0x20000D // keyboard input to move cursor right one word
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT 0x400000
#define STB_TEXTEDIT_IMPLEMENTATION
#include "imstb_textedit.h"
// stb_textedit internally allows for a single undo record to do addition and deletion, but somehow, calling
// the stb_textedit_paste() function creates two separate records, so we perform it manually. (FIXME: Report to nothings/stb?)
static void stb_textedit_replace(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* str, STB_TexteditState* state, const STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE* text, int text_len)
{
stb_text_makeundo_replace(str, state, 0, str->CurLenW, text_len);
ImStb::STB_TEXTEDIT_DELETECHARS(str, 0, str->CurLenW);
if (text_len <= 0)
return;
if (ImStb::STB_TEXTEDIT_INSERTCHARS(str, 0, text, text_len))
{
state->cursor = text_len;
state->has_preferred_x = 0;
return;
}
IM_ASSERT(0); // Failed to insert character, normally shouldn't happen because of how we currently use stb_textedit_replace()
}
} // namespace ImStb
void ImGuiInputTextState::OnKeyPressed(int key)
{
stb_textedit_key(this, &Stb, key);
CursorFollow = true;
CursorAnimReset();
}
ImGuiInputTextCallbackData::ImGuiInputTextCallbackData()
{
memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this));
}
// Public API to manipulate UTF-8 text
// We expose UTF-8 to the user (unlike the STB_TEXTEDIT_* functions which are manipulating wchar)
// FIXME: The existence of this rarely exercised code path is a bit of a nuisance.
void ImGuiInputTextCallbackData::DeleteChars(int pos, int bytes_count)
{
IM_ASSERT(pos + bytes_count <= BufTextLen);
char* dst = Buf + pos;
const char* src = Buf + pos + bytes_count;
while (char c = *src++)
*dst++ = c;
*dst = '\0';
if (CursorPos + bytes_count >= pos)
CursorPos -= bytes_count;
else if (CursorPos >= pos)
CursorPos = pos;
SelectionStart = SelectionEnd = CursorPos;
BufDirty = true;
BufTextLen -= bytes_count;
}
void ImGuiInputTextCallbackData::InsertChars(int pos, const char* new_text, const char* new_text_end)
{
const bool is_resizable = (Flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackResize) != 0;
const int new_text_len = new_text_end ? (int)(new_text_end - new_text) : (int)strlen(new_text);
if (new_text_len + BufTextLen >= BufSize)
{
if (!is_resizable)
return;
// Contrary to STB_TEXTEDIT_INSERTCHARS() this is working in the UTF8 buffer, hence the midly similar code (until we remove the U16 buffer alltogether!)
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiInputTextState* edit_state = &g.InputTextState;
IM_ASSERT(edit_state->ID != 0 && g.ActiveId == edit_state->ID);
IM_ASSERT(Buf == edit_state->TextA.Data);
int new_buf_size = BufTextLen + ImClamp(new_text_len * 4, 32, ImMax(256, new_text_len)) + 1;
edit_state->TextA.reserve(new_buf_size + 1);
Buf = edit_state->TextA.Data;
BufSize = edit_state->BufCapacityA = new_buf_size;
}
if (BufTextLen != pos)
memmove(Buf + pos + new_text_len, Buf + pos, (size_t)(BufTextLen - pos));
memcpy(Buf + pos, new_text, (size_t)new_text_len * sizeof(char));
Buf[BufTextLen + new_text_len] = '\0';
if (CursorPos >= pos)
CursorPos += new_text_len;
SelectionStart = SelectionEnd = CursorPos;
BufDirty = true;
BufTextLen += new_text_len;
}
// Return false to discard a character.
static bool InputTextFilterCharacter(unsigned int* p_char, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags, ImGuiInputTextCallback callback, void* user_data)
{
unsigned int c = *p_char;
// Filter non-printable (NB: isprint is unreliable! see #2467)
if (c < 0x20)
{
bool pass = false;
pass |= (c == '\n' && (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_Multiline));
pass |= (c == '\t' && (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_AllowTabInput));
if (!pass)
return false;
}
// We ignore Ascii representation of delete (emitted from Backspace on OSX, see #2578, #2817)
if (c == 127)
return false;
// Filter private Unicode range. GLFW on OSX seems to send private characters for special keys like arrow keys (FIXME)
if (c >= 0xE000 && c <= 0xF8FF)
return false;
// Filter Unicode ranges we are not handling in this build.
if (c > IM_UNICODE_CODEPOINT_MAX)
return false;
// Generic named filters
if (flags & (ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsDecimal | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsHexadecimal | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsUppercase | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsNoBlank | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsScientific))
{
if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsDecimal)
if (!(c >= '0' && c <= '9') && (c != '.') && (c != '-') && (c != '+') && (c != '*') && (c != '/'))
return false;
if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsScientific)
if (!(c >= '0' && c <= '9') && (c != '.') && (c != '-') && (c != '+') && (c != '*') && (c != '/') && (c != 'e') && (c != 'E'))
return false;
if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsHexadecimal)
if (!(c >= '0' && c <= '9') && !(c >= 'a' && c <= 'f') && !(c >= 'A' && c <= 'F'))
return false;
if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsUppercase)
if (c >= 'a' && c <= 'z')
*p_char = (c += (unsigned int)('A'-'a'));
if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsNoBlank)
if (ImCharIsBlankW(c))
return false;
}
// Custom callback filter
if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCharFilter)
{
ImGuiInputTextCallbackData callback_data;
memset(&callback_data, 0, sizeof(ImGuiInputTextCallbackData));
callback_data.EventFlag = ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCharFilter;
callback_data.EventChar = (ImWchar)c;
callback_data.Flags = flags;
callback_data.UserData = user_data;
if (callback(&callback_data) != 0)
return false;
*p_char = callback_data.EventChar;
if (!callback_data.EventChar)
return false;
}
return true;
}
// Edit a string of text
// - buf_size account for the zero-terminator, so a buf_size of 6 can hold "Hello" but not "Hello!".
// This is so we can easily call InputText() on static arrays using ARRAYSIZE() and to match
// Note that in std::string world, capacity() would omit 1 byte used by the zero-terminator.
// - When active, hold on a privately held copy of the text (and apply back to 'buf'). So changing 'buf' while the InputText is active has no effect.
// - If you want to use ImGui::InputText() with std::string, see misc/cpp/imgui_stdlib.h
// (FIXME: Rather confusing and messy function, among the worse part of our codebase, expecting to rewrite a V2 at some point.. Partly because we are
// doing UTF8 > U16 > UTF8 conversions on the go to easily interface with stb_textedit. Ideally should stay in UTF-8 all the time. See https://github.com/nothings/stb/issues/188)
bool ImGui::InputTextEx(const char* label, const char* hint, char* buf, int buf_size, const ImVec2& size_arg, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags, ImGuiInputTextCallback callback, void* callback_user_data)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
IM_ASSERT(!((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory) && (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_Multiline))); // Can't use both together (they both use up/down keys)
IM_ASSERT(!((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCompletion) && (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_AllowTabInput))); // Can't use both together (they both use tab key)
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiIO& io = g.IO;
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
const bool RENDER_SELECTION_WHEN_INACTIVE = false;
const bool is_multiline = (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_Multiline) != 0;
const bool is_readonly = (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_ReadOnly) != 0;
const bool is_password = (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_Password) != 0;
const bool is_undoable = (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_NoUndoRedo) == 0;
const bool is_resizable = (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackResize) != 0;
if (is_resizable)
IM_ASSERT(callback != NULL); // Must provide a callback if you set the ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackResize flag!
if (is_multiline) // Open group before calling GetID() because groups tracks id created within their scope,
BeginGroup();
const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label);
const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true);
const ImVec2 frame_size = CalcItemSize(size_arg, CalcItemWidth(), (is_multiline ? g.FontSize * 8.0f : label_size.y) + style.FramePadding.y*2.0f); // Arbitrary default of 8 lines high for multi-line
const ImVec2 total_size = ImVec2(frame_size.x + (label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x : 0.0f), frame_size.y);
const ImRect frame_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + frame_size);
const ImRect total_bb(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Min + total_size);
ImGuiWindow* draw_window = window;
ImVec2 inner_size = frame_size;
if (is_multiline)
{
if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, id, &frame_bb))
{
ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y);
EndGroup();
return false;
}
// We reproduce the contents of BeginChildFrame() in order to provide 'label' so our window internal data are easier to read/debug.
PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_ChildBg, style.Colors[ImGuiCol_FrameBg]);
PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ChildRounding, style.FrameRounding);
PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ChildBorderSize, style.FrameBorderSize);
PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_WindowPadding, style.FramePadding);
bool child_visible = BeginChildEx(label, id, frame_bb.GetSize(), true, ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove | ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysUseWindowPadding);
PopStyleVar(3);
PopStyleColor();
if (!child_visible)
{
EndChild();
EndGroup();
return false;
}
draw_window = g.CurrentWindow; // Child window
draw_window->DC.NavLayerActiveMaskNext |= draw_window->DC.NavLayerCurrentMask; // This is to ensure that EndChild() will display a navigation highlight so we can "enter" into it.
inner_size.x -= draw_window->ScrollbarSizes.x;
}
else
{
ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y);
if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, id, &frame_bb))
return false;
}
const bool hovered = ItemHoverable(frame_bb, id);
if (hovered)
g.MouseCursor = ImGuiMouseCursor_TextInput;
// We are only allowed to access the state if we are already the active widget.
ImGuiInputTextState* state = GetInputTextState(id);
const bool focus_requested = FocusableItemRegister(window, id);
const bool focus_requested_by_code = focus_requested && (g.FocusRequestCurrWindow == window && g.FocusRequestCurrCounterRegular == window->DC.FocusCounterRegular);
const bool focus_requested_by_tab = focus_requested && !focus_requested_by_code;
const bool user_clicked = hovered && io.MouseClicked[0];
const bool user_nav_input_start = (g.ActiveId != id) && ((g.NavInputId == id) || (g.NavActivateId == id && g.NavInputSource == ImGuiInputSource_NavKeyboard));
const bool user_scroll_finish = is_multiline && state != NULL && g.ActiveId == 0 && g.ActiveIdPreviousFrame == GetWindowScrollbarID(draw_window, ImGuiAxis_Y);
const bool user_scroll_active = is_multiline && state != NULL && g.ActiveId == GetWindowScrollbarID(draw_window, ImGuiAxis_Y);
bool clear_active_id = false;
bool select_all = (g.ActiveId != id) && ((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_AutoSelectAll) != 0 || user_nav_input_start) && (!is_multiline);
const bool init_make_active = (focus_requested || user_clicked || user_scroll_finish || user_nav_input_start);
const bool init_state = (init_make_active || user_scroll_active);
if (init_state && g.ActiveId != id)
{
// Access state even if we don't own it yet.
state = &g.InputTextState;
state->CursorAnimReset();
// Take a copy of the initial buffer value (both in original UTF-8 format and converted to wchar)
// From the moment we focused we are ignoring the content of 'buf' (unless we are in read-only mode)
const int buf_len = (int)strlen(buf);
state->InitialTextA.resize(buf_len + 1); // UTF-8. we use +1 to make sure that .Data is always pointing to at least an empty string.
memcpy(state->InitialTextA.Data, buf, buf_len + 1);
// Start edition
const char* buf_end = NULL;
state->TextW.resize(buf_size + 1); // wchar count <= UTF-8 count. we use +1 to make sure that .Data is always pointing to at least an empty string.
state->TextA.resize(0);
state->TextAIsValid = false; // TextA is not valid yet (we will display buf until then)
state->CurLenW = ImTextStrFromUtf8(state->TextW.Data, buf_size, buf, NULL, &buf_end);
state->CurLenA = (int)(buf_end - buf); // We can't get the result from ImStrncpy() above because it is not UTF-8 aware. Here we'll cut off malformed UTF-8.
// Preserve cursor position and undo/redo stack if we come back to same widget
// FIXME: For non-readonly widgets we might be able to require that TextAIsValid && TextA == buf ? (untested) and discard undo stack if user buffer has changed.
const bool recycle_state = (state->ID == id);
if (recycle_state)
{
// Recycle existing cursor/selection/undo stack but clamp position
// Note a single mouse click will override the cursor/position immediately by calling stb_textedit_click handler.
state->CursorClamp();
}
else
{
state->ID = id;
state->ScrollX = 0.0f;
stb_textedit_initialize_state(&state->Stb, !is_multiline);
if (!is_multiline && focus_requested_by_code)
select_all = true;
}
if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_AlwaysInsertMode)
state->Stb.insert_mode = 1;
if (!is_multiline && (focus_requested_by_tab || (user_clicked && io.KeyCtrl)))
select_all = true;
}
if (g.ActiveId != id && init_make_active)
{
IM_ASSERT(state && state->ID == id);
SetActiveID(id, window);
SetFocusID(id, window);
FocusWindow(window);
// Declare our inputs
IM_ASSERT(ImGuiNavInput_COUNT < 32);
g.ActiveIdUsingNavDirMask |= (1 << ImGuiDir_Left) | (1 << ImGuiDir_Right);
if (is_multiline || (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory))
g.ActiveIdUsingNavDirMask |= (1 << ImGuiDir_Up) | (1 << ImGuiDir_Down);
g.ActiveIdUsingNavInputMask |= (1 << ImGuiNavInput_Cancel);
g.ActiveIdUsingKeyInputMask |= ((ImU64)1 << ImGuiKey_Home) | ((ImU64)1 << ImGuiKey_End);
if (is_multiline)
g.ActiveIdUsingKeyInputMask |= ((ImU64)1 << ImGuiKey_PageUp) | ((ImU64)1 << ImGuiKey_PageDown); // FIXME-NAV: Page up/down actually not supported yet by widget, but claim them ahead.
if (flags & (ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCompletion | ImGuiInputTextFlags_AllowTabInput)) // Disable keyboard tabbing out as we will use the \t character.
g.ActiveIdUsingKeyInputMask |= ((ImU64)1 << ImGuiKey_Tab);
}
// We have an edge case if ActiveId was set through another widget (e.g. widget being swapped), clear id immediately (don't wait until the end of the function)
if (g.ActiveId == id && state == NULL)
ClearActiveID();
// Release focus when we click outside
if (g.ActiveId == id && io.MouseClicked[0] && !init_state && !init_make_active) //-V560
clear_active_id = true;
// Lock the decision of whether we are going to take the path displaying the cursor or selection
const bool render_cursor = (g.ActiveId == id) || (state && user_scroll_active);
bool render_selection = state && state->HasSelection() && (RENDER_SELECTION_WHEN_INACTIVE || render_cursor);
bool value_changed = false;
bool enter_pressed = false;
// When read-only we always use the live data passed to the function
// FIXME-OPT: Because our selection/cursor code currently needs the wide text we need to convert it when active, which is not ideal :(
if (is_readonly && state != NULL && (render_cursor || render_selection))
{
const char* buf_end = NULL;
state->TextW.resize(buf_size + 1);
state->CurLenW = ImTextStrFromUtf8(state->TextW.Data, state->TextW.Size, buf, NULL, &buf_end);
state->CurLenA = (int)(buf_end - buf);
state->CursorClamp();
render_selection &= state->HasSelection();
}
// Select the buffer to render.
const bool buf_display_from_state = (render_cursor || render_selection || g.ActiveId == id) && !is_readonly && state && state->TextAIsValid;
const bool is_displaying_hint = (hint != NULL && (buf_display_from_state ? state->TextA.Data : buf)[0] == 0);
// Password pushes a temporary font with only a fallback glyph
if (is_password && !is_displaying_hint)
{
const ImFontGlyph* glyph = g.Font->FindGlyph('*');
ImFont* password_font = &g.InputTextPasswordFont;
password_font->FontSize = g.Font->FontSize;
password_font->Scale = g.Font->Scale;
password_font->DisplayOffset = g.Font->DisplayOffset;
password_font->Ascent = g.Font->Ascent;
password_font->Descent = g.Font->Descent;
password_font->ContainerAtlas = g.Font->ContainerAtlas;
password_font->FallbackGlyph = glyph;
password_font->FallbackAdvanceX = glyph->AdvanceX;
IM_ASSERT(password_font->Glyphs.empty() && password_font->IndexAdvanceX.empty() && password_font->IndexLookup.empty());
PushFont(password_font);
}
// Process mouse inputs and character inputs
int backup_current_text_length = 0;
if (g.ActiveId == id)
{
IM_ASSERT(state != NULL);
backup_current_text_length = state->CurLenA;
state->BufCapacityA = buf_size;
state->UserFlags = flags;
state->UserCallback = callback;
state->UserCallbackData = callback_user_data;
// Although we are active we don't prevent mouse from hovering other elements unless we are interacting right now with the widget.
// Down the line we should have a cleaner library-wide concept of Selected vs Active.
g.ActiveIdAllowOverlap = !io.MouseDown[0];
g.WantTextInputNextFrame = 1;
// Edit in progress
const float mouse_x = (io.MousePos.x - frame_bb.Min.x - style.FramePadding.x) + state->ScrollX;
const float mouse_y = (is_multiline ? (io.MousePos.y - draw_window->DC.CursorPos.y - style.FramePadding.y) : (g.FontSize*0.5f));
const bool is_osx = io.ConfigMacOSXBehaviors;
if (select_all || (hovered && !is_osx && io.MouseDoubleClicked[0]))
{
state->SelectAll();
state->SelectedAllMouseLock = true;
}
else if (hovered && is_osx && io.MouseDoubleClicked[0])
{
// Double-click select a word only, OS X style (by simulating keystrokes)
state->OnKeyPressed(STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDLEFT);
state->OnKeyPressed(STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDRIGHT | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT);
}
else if (io.MouseClicked[0] && !state->SelectedAllMouseLock)
{
if (hovered)
{
stb_textedit_click(state, &state->Stb, mouse_x, mouse_y);
state->CursorAnimReset();
}
}
else if (io.MouseDown[0] && !state->SelectedAllMouseLock && (io.MouseDelta.x != 0.0f || io.MouseDelta.y != 0.0f))
{
stb_textedit_drag(state, &state->Stb, mouse_x, mouse_y);
state->CursorAnimReset();
state->CursorFollow = true;
}
if (state->SelectedAllMouseLock && !io.MouseDown[0])
state->SelectedAllMouseLock = false;
// It is ill-defined whether the back-end needs to send a \t character when pressing the TAB keys.
// Win32 and GLFW naturally do it but not SDL.
const bool ignore_char_inputs = (io.KeyCtrl && !io.KeyAlt) || (is_osx && io.KeySuper);
if ((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_AllowTabInput) && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Tab) && !ignore_char_inputs && !io.KeyShift && !is_readonly)
if (!io.InputQueueCharacters.contains('\t'))
{
unsigned int c = '\t'; // Insert TAB
if (InputTextFilterCharacter(&c, flags, callback, callback_user_data))
state->OnKeyPressed((int)c);
}
// Process regular text input (before we check for Return because using some IME will effectively send a Return?)
// We ignore CTRL inputs, but need to allow ALT+CTRL as some keyboards (e.g. German) use AltGR (which _is_ Alt+Ctrl) to input certain characters.
if (io.InputQueueCharacters.Size > 0)
{
if (!ignore_char_inputs && !is_readonly && !user_nav_input_start)
for (int n = 0; n < io.InputQueueCharacters.Size; n++)
{
// Insert character if they pass filtering
unsigned int c = (unsigned int)io.InputQueueCharacters[n];
if (c == '\t' && io.KeyShift)
continue;
if (InputTextFilterCharacter(&c, flags, callback, callback_user_data))
state->OnKeyPressed((int)c);
}
// Consume characters
io.InputQueueCharacters.resize(0);
}
}
// Process other shortcuts/key-presses
bool cancel_edit = false;
if (g.ActiveId == id && !g.ActiveIdIsJustActivated && !clear_active_id)
{
IM_ASSERT(state != NULL);
IM_ASSERT(io.KeyMods == GetMergedKeyModFlags() && "Mismatching io.KeyCtrl/io.KeyShift/io.KeyAlt/io.KeySuper vs io.KeyMods"); // We rarely do this check, but if anything let's do it here.
const int k_mask = (io.KeyShift ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT : 0);
const bool is_osx = io.ConfigMacOSXBehaviors;
const bool is_osx_shift_shortcut = is_osx && (io.KeyMods == (ImGuiKeyModFlags_Super | ImGuiKeyModFlags_Shift));
const bool is_wordmove_key_down = is_osx ? io.KeyAlt : io.KeyCtrl; // OS X style: Text editing cursor movement using Alt instead of Ctrl
const bool is_startend_key_down = is_osx && io.KeySuper && !io.KeyCtrl && !io.KeyAlt; // OS X style: Line/Text Start and End using Cmd+Arrows instead of Home/End
const bool is_ctrl_key_only = (io.KeyMods == ImGuiKeyModFlags_Ctrl);
const bool is_shift_key_only = (io.KeyMods == ImGuiKeyModFlags_Shift);
const bool is_shortcut_key = g.IO.ConfigMacOSXBehaviors ? (io.KeyMods == ImGuiKeyModFlags_Super) : (io.KeyMods == ImGuiKeyModFlags_Ctrl);
const bool is_cut = ((is_shortcut_key && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_X)) || (is_shift_key_only && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Delete))) && !is_readonly && !is_password && (!is_multiline || state->HasSelection());
const bool is_copy = ((is_shortcut_key && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_C)) || (is_ctrl_key_only && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Insert))) && !is_password && (!is_multiline || state->HasSelection());
const bool is_paste = ((is_shortcut_key && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_V)) || (is_shift_key_only && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Insert))) && !is_readonly;
const bool is_undo = ((is_shortcut_key && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Z)) && !is_readonly && is_undoable);
const bool is_redo = ((is_shortcut_key && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Y)) || (is_osx_shift_shortcut && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Z))) && !is_readonly && is_undoable;
if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_LeftArrow)) { state->OnKeyPressed((is_startend_key_down ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINESTART : is_wordmove_key_down ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDLEFT : STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LEFT) | k_mask); }
else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_RightArrow)) { state->OnKeyPressed((is_startend_key_down ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINEEND : is_wordmove_key_down ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDRIGHT : STB_TEXTEDIT_K_RIGHT) | k_mask); }
else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_UpArrow) && is_multiline) { if (io.KeyCtrl) SetScrollY(draw_window, ImMax(draw_window->Scroll.y - g.FontSize, 0.0f)); else state->OnKeyPressed((is_startend_key_down ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTSTART : STB_TEXTEDIT_K_UP) | k_mask); }
else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_DownArrow) && is_multiline) { if (io.KeyCtrl) SetScrollY(draw_window, ImMin(draw_window->Scroll.y + g.FontSize, GetScrollMaxY())); else state->OnKeyPressed((is_startend_key_down ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTEND : STB_TEXTEDIT_K_DOWN) | k_mask); }
else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Home)) { state->OnKeyPressed(io.KeyCtrl ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTSTART | k_mask : STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINESTART | k_mask); }
else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_End)) { state->OnKeyPressed(io.KeyCtrl ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTEND | k_mask : STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINEEND | k_mask); }
else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Delete) && !is_readonly) { state->OnKeyPressed(STB_TEXTEDIT_K_DELETE | k_mask); }
else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Backspace) && !is_readonly)
{
if (!state->HasSelection())
{
if (is_wordmove_key_down)
state->OnKeyPressed(STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDLEFT|STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT);
else if (is_osx && io.KeySuper && !io.KeyAlt && !io.KeyCtrl)
state->OnKeyPressed(STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINESTART|STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT);
}
state->OnKeyPressed(STB_TEXTEDIT_K_BACKSPACE | k_mask);
}
else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Enter) || IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_KeyPadEnter))
{
bool ctrl_enter_for_new_line = (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CtrlEnterForNewLine) != 0;
if (!is_multiline || (ctrl_enter_for_new_line && !io.KeyCtrl) || (!ctrl_enter_for_new_line && io.KeyCtrl))
{
enter_pressed = clear_active_id = true;
}
else if (!is_readonly)
{
unsigned int c = '\n'; // Insert new line
if (InputTextFilterCharacter(&c, flags, callback, callback_user_data))
state->OnKeyPressed((int)c);
}
}
else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Escape))
{
clear_active_id = cancel_edit = true;
}
else if (is_undo || is_redo)
{
state->OnKeyPressed(is_undo ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_UNDO : STB_TEXTEDIT_K_REDO);
state->ClearSelection();
}
else if (is_shortcut_key && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_A))
{
state->SelectAll();
state->CursorFollow = true;
}
else if (is_cut || is_copy)
{
// Cut, Copy
if (io.SetClipboardTextFn)
{
const int ib = state->HasSelection() ? ImMin(state->Stb.select_start, state->Stb.select_end) : 0;
const int ie = state->HasSelection() ? ImMax(state->Stb.select_start, state->Stb.select_end) : state->CurLenW;
const int clipboard_data_len = ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromStr(state->TextW.Data + ib, state->TextW.Data + ie) + 1;
char* clipboard_data = (char*)IM_ALLOC(clipboard_data_len * sizeof(char));
ImTextStrToUtf8(clipboard_data, clipboard_data_len, state->TextW.Data + ib, state->TextW.Data + ie);
SetClipboardText(clipboard_data);
MemFree(clipboard_data);
}
if (is_cut)
{
if (!state->HasSelection())
state->SelectAll();
state->CursorFollow = true;
stb_textedit_cut(state, &state->Stb);
}
}
else if (is_paste)
{
if (const char* clipboard = GetClipboardText())
{
// Filter pasted buffer
const int clipboard_len = (int)strlen(clipboard);
ImWchar* clipboard_filtered = (ImWchar*)IM_ALLOC((clipboard_len+1) * sizeof(ImWchar));
int clipboard_filtered_len = 0;
for (const char* s = clipboard; *s; )
{
unsigned int c;
s += ImTextCharFromUtf8(&c, s, NULL);
if (c == 0)
break;
if (!InputTextFilterCharacter(&c, flags, callback, callback_user_data))
continue;
clipboard_filtered[clipboard_filtered_len++] = (ImWchar)c;
}
clipboard_filtered[clipboard_filtered_len] = 0;
if (clipboard_filtered_len > 0) // If everything was filtered, ignore the pasting operation
{
stb_textedit_paste(state, &state->Stb, clipboard_filtered, clipboard_filtered_len);
state->CursorFollow = true;
}
MemFree(clipboard_filtered);
}
}
// Update render selection flag after events have been handled, so selection highlight can be displayed during the same frame.
render_selection |= state->HasSelection() && (RENDER_SELECTION_WHEN_INACTIVE || render_cursor);
}
// Process callbacks and apply result back to user's buffer.
if (g.ActiveId == id)
{
IM_ASSERT(state != NULL);
const char* apply_new_text = NULL;
int apply_new_text_length = 0;
if (cancel_edit)
{
// Restore initial value. Only return true if restoring to the initial value changes the current buffer contents.
if (!is_readonly && strcmp(buf, state->InitialTextA.Data) != 0)
{
// Push records into the undo stack so we can CTRL+Z the revert operation itself
apply_new_text = state->InitialTextA.Data;
apply_new_text_length = state->InitialTextA.Size - 1;
ImVector<ImWchar> w_text;
if (apply_new_text_length > 0)
{
w_text.resize(ImTextCountCharsFromUtf8(apply_new_text, apply_new_text + apply_new_text_length) + 1);
ImTextStrFromUtf8(w_text.Data, w_text.Size, apply_new_text, apply_new_text + apply_new_text_length);
}
stb_textedit_replace(state, &state->Stb, w_text.Data, (apply_new_text_length > 0) ? (w_text.Size - 1) : 0);
}
}
// When using 'ImGuiInputTextFlags_EnterReturnsTrue' as a special case we reapply the live buffer back to the input buffer before clearing ActiveId, even though strictly speaking it wasn't modified on this frame.
// If we didn't do that, code like InputInt() with ImGuiInputTextFlags_EnterReturnsTrue would fail.
// This also allows the user to use InputText() with ImGuiInputTextFlags_EnterReturnsTrue without maintaining any user-side storage (please note that if you use this property along ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackResize you can end up with your temporary string object unnecessarily allocating once a frame, either store your string data, either if you don't then don't use ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackResize).
bool apply_edit_back_to_user_buffer = !cancel_edit || (enter_pressed && (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_EnterReturnsTrue) != 0);
if (apply_edit_back_to_user_buffer)
{
// Apply new value immediately - copy modified buffer back
// Note that as soon as the input box is active, the in-widget value gets priority over any underlying modification of the input buffer
// FIXME: We actually always render 'buf' when calling DrawList->AddText, making the comment above incorrect.
// FIXME-OPT: CPU waste to do this every time the widget is active, should mark dirty state from the stb_textedit callbacks.
if (!is_readonly)
{
state->TextAIsValid = true;
state->TextA.resize(state->TextW.Size * 4 + 1);
ImTextStrToUtf8(state->TextA.Data, state->TextA.Size, state->TextW.Data, NULL);
}
// User callback
if ((flags & (ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCompletion | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackAlways)) != 0)
{
IM_ASSERT(callback != NULL);
// The reason we specify the usage semantic (Completion/History) is that Completion needs to disable keyboard TABBING at the moment.
ImGuiInputTextFlags event_flag = 0;
ImGuiKey event_key = ImGuiKey_COUNT;
if ((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCompletion) != 0 && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Tab))
{
event_flag = ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCompletion;
event_key = ImGuiKey_Tab;
}
else if ((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory) != 0 && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_UpArrow))
{
event_flag = ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory;
event_key = ImGuiKey_UpArrow;
}
else if ((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory) != 0 && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_DownArrow))
{
event_flag = ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory;
event_key = ImGuiKey_DownArrow;
}
else if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackAlways)
event_flag = ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackAlways;
if (event_flag)
{
ImGuiInputTextCallbackData callback_data;
memset(&callback_data, 0, sizeof(ImGuiInputTextCallbackData));
callback_data.EventFlag = event_flag;
callback_data.Flags = flags;
callback_data.UserData = callback_user_data;
callback_data.EventKey = event_key;
callback_data.Buf = state->TextA.Data;
callback_data.BufTextLen = state->CurLenA;
callback_data.BufSize = state->BufCapacityA;
callback_data.BufDirty = false;
// We have to convert from wchar-positions to UTF-8-positions, which can be pretty slow (an incentive to ditch the ImWchar buffer, see https://github.com/nothings/stb/issues/188)
ImWchar* text = state->TextW.Data;
const int utf8_cursor_pos = callback_data.CursorPos = ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromStr(text, text + state->Stb.cursor);
const int utf8_selection_start = callback_data.SelectionStart = ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromStr(text, text + state->Stb.select_start);
const int utf8_selection_end = callback_data.SelectionEnd = ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromStr(text, text + state->Stb.select_end);
// Call user code
callback(&callback_data);
// Read back what user may have modified
IM_ASSERT(callback_data.Buf == state->TextA.Data); // Invalid to modify those fields
IM_ASSERT(callback_data.BufSize == state->BufCapacityA);
IM_ASSERT(callback_data.Flags == flags);
if (callback_data.CursorPos != utf8_cursor_pos) { state->Stb.cursor = ImTextCountCharsFromUtf8(callback_data.Buf, callback_data.Buf + callback_data.CursorPos); state->CursorFollow = true; }
if (callback_data.SelectionStart != utf8_selection_start) { state->Stb.select_start = ImTextCountCharsFromUtf8(callback_data.Buf, callback_data.Buf + callback_data.SelectionStart); }
if (callback_data.SelectionEnd != utf8_selection_end) { state->Stb.select_end = ImTextCountCharsFromUtf8(callback_data.Buf, callback_data.Buf + callback_data.SelectionEnd); }
if (callback_data.BufDirty)
{
IM_ASSERT(callback_data.BufTextLen == (int)strlen(callback_data.Buf)); // You need to maintain BufTextLen if you change the text!
if (callback_data.BufTextLen > backup_current_text_length && is_resizable)
state->TextW.resize(state->TextW.Size + (callback_data.BufTextLen - backup_current_text_length));
state->CurLenW = ImTextStrFromUtf8(state->TextW.Data, state->TextW.Size, callback_data.Buf, NULL);
state->CurLenA = callback_data.BufTextLen; // Assume correct length and valid UTF-8 from user, saves us an extra strlen()
state->CursorAnimReset();
}
}
}
// Will copy result string if modified
if (!is_readonly && strcmp(state->TextA.Data, buf) != 0)
{
apply_new_text = state->TextA.Data;
apply_new_text_length = state->CurLenA;
}
}
// Copy result to user buffer
if (apply_new_text)
{
// We cannot test for 'backup_current_text_length != apply_new_text_length' here because we have no guarantee that the size
// of our owned buffer matches the size of the string object held by the user, and by design we allow InputText() to be used
// without any storage on user's side.
IM_ASSERT(apply_new_text_length >= 0);
if (is_resizable)
{
ImGuiInputTextCallbackData callback_data;
callback_data.EventFlag = ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackResize;
callback_data.Flags = flags;
callback_data.Buf = buf;
callback_data.BufTextLen = apply_new_text_length;
callback_data.BufSize = ImMax(buf_size, apply_new_text_length + 1);
callback_data.UserData = callback_user_data;
callback(&callback_data);
buf = callback_data.Buf;
buf_size = callback_data.BufSize;
apply_new_text_length = ImMin(callback_data.BufTextLen, buf_size - 1);
IM_ASSERT(apply_new_text_length <= buf_size);
}
//IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG("InputText(\"%s\"): apply_new_text length %d\n", label, apply_new_text_length);
// If the underlying buffer resize was denied or not carried to the next frame, apply_new_text_length+1 may be >= buf_size.
ImStrncpy(buf, apply_new_text, ImMin(apply_new_text_length + 1, buf_size));
value_changed = true;
}
// Clear temporary user storage
state->UserFlags = 0;
state->UserCallback = NULL;
state->UserCallbackData = NULL;
}
// Release active ID at the end of the function (so e.g. pressing Return still does a final application of the value)
if (clear_active_id && g.ActiveId == id)
ClearActiveID();
// Render frame
if (!is_multiline)
{
RenderNavHighlight(frame_bb, id);
RenderFrame(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_FrameBg), true, style.FrameRounding);
}
const ImVec4 clip_rect(frame_bb.Min.x, frame_bb.Min.y, frame_bb.Min.x + inner_size.x, frame_bb.Min.y + inner_size.y); // Not using frame_bb.Max because we have adjusted size
ImVec2 draw_pos = is_multiline ? draw_window->DC.CursorPos : frame_bb.Min + style.FramePadding;
ImVec2 text_size(0.0f, 0.0f);
// Set upper limit of single-line InputTextEx() at 2 million characters strings. The current pathological worst case is a long line
// without any carriage return, which would makes ImFont::RenderText() reserve too many vertices and probably crash. Avoid it altogether.
// Note that we only use this limit on single-line InputText(), so a pathologically large line on a InputTextMultiline() would still crash.
const int buf_display_max_length = 2 * 1024 * 1024;
const char* buf_display = buf_display_from_state ? state->TextA.Data : buf; //-V595
const char* buf_display_end = NULL; // We have specialized paths below for setting the length
if (is_displaying_hint)
{
buf_display = hint;
buf_display_end = hint + strlen(hint);
}
// Render text. We currently only render selection when the widget is active or while scrolling.
// FIXME: We could remove the '&& render_cursor' to keep rendering selection when inactive.
if (render_cursor || render_selection)
{
IM_ASSERT(state != NULL);
if (!is_displaying_hint)
buf_display_end = buf_display + state->CurLenA;
// Render text (with cursor and selection)
// This is going to be messy. We need to:
// - Display the text (this alone can be more easily clipped)
// - Handle scrolling, highlight selection, display cursor (those all requires some form of 1d->2d cursor position calculation)
// - Measure text height (for scrollbar)
// We are attempting to do most of that in **one main pass** to minimize the computation cost (non-negligible for large amount of text) + 2nd pass for selection rendering (we could merge them by an extra refactoring effort)
// FIXME: This should occur on buf_display but we'd need to maintain cursor/select_start/select_end for UTF-8.
const ImWchar* text_begin = state->TextW.Data;
ImVec2 cursor_offset, select_start_offset;
{
// Find lines numbers straddling 'cursor' (slot 0) and 'select_start' (slot 1) positions.
const ImWchar* searches_input_ptr[2] = { NULL, NULL };
int searches_result_line_no[2] = { -1000, -1000 };
int searches_remaining = 0;
if (render_cursor)
{
searches_input_ptr[0] = text_begin + state->Stb.cursor;
searches_result_line_no[0] = -1;
searches_remaining++;
}
if (render_selection)
{
searches_input_ptr[1] = text_begin + ImMin(state->Stb.select_start, state->Stb.select_end);
searches_result_line_no[1] = -1;
searches_remaining++;
}
// Iterate all lines to find our line numbers
// In multi-line mode, we never exit the loop until all lines are counted, so add one extra to the searches_remaining counter.
searches_remaining += is_multiline ? 1 : 0;
int line_count = 0;
//for (const ImWchar* s = text_begin; (s = (const ImWchar*)wcschr((const wchar_t*)s, (wchar_t)'\n')) != NULL; s++) // FIXME-OPT: Could use this when wchar_t are 16-bit
for (const ImWchar* s = text_begin; *s != 0; s++)
if (*s == '\n')
{
line_count++;
if (searches_result_line_no[0] == -1 && s >= searches_input_ptr[0]) { searches_result_line_no[0] = line_count; if (--searches_remaining <= 0) break; }
if (searches_result_line_no[1] == -1 && s >= searches_input_ptr[1]) { searches_result_line_no[1] = line_count; if (--searches_remaining <= 0) break; }
}
line_count++;
if (searches_result_line_no[0] == -1)
searches_result_line_no[0] = line_count;
if (searches_result_line_no[1] == -1)
searches_result_line_no[1] = line_count;
// Calculate 2d position by finding the beginning of the line and measuring distance
cursor_offset.x = InputTextCalcTextSizeW(ImStrbolW(searches_input_ptr[0], text_begin), searches_input_ptr[0]).x;
cursor_offset.y = searches_result_line_no[0] * g.FontSize;
if (searches_result_line_no[1] >= 0)
{
select_start_offset.x = InputTextCalcTextSizeW(ImStrbolW(searches_input_ptr[1], text_begin), searches_input_ptr[1]).x;
select_start_offset.y = searches_result_line_no[1] * g.FontSize;
}
// Store text height (note that we haven't calculated text width at all, see GitHub issues #383, #1224)
if (is_multiline)
text_size = ImVec2(inner_size.x, line_count * g.FontSize);
}
// Scroll
if (render_cursor && state->CursorFollow)
{
// Horizontal scroll in chunks of quarter width
if (!(flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_NoHorizontalScroll))
{
const float scroll_increment_x = inner_size.x * 0.25f;
if (cursor_offset.x < state->ScrollX)
state->ScrollX = IM_FLOOR(ImMax(0.0f, cursor_offset.x - scroll_increment_x));
else if (cursor_offset.x - inner_size.x >= state->ScrollX)
state->ScrollX = IM_FLOOR(cursor_offset.x - inner_size.x + scroll_increment_x);
}
else
{
state->ScrollX = 0.0f;
}
// Vertical scroll
if (is_multiline)
{
float scroll_y = draw_window->Scroll.y;
if (cursor_offset.y - g.FontSize < scroll_y)
scroll_y = ImMax(0.0f, cursor_offset.y - g.FontSize);
else if (cursor_offset.y - inner_size.y >= scroll_y)
scroll_y = cursor_offset.y - inner_size.y;
draw_pos.y += (draw_window->Scroll.y - scroll_y); // Manipulate cursor pos immediately avoid a frame of lag
draw_window->Scroll.y = scroll_y;
}
state->CursorFollow = false;
}
// Draw selection
const ImVec2 draw_scroll = ImVec2(state->ScrollX, 0.0f);
if (render_selection)
{
const ImWchar* text_selected_begin = text_begin + ImMin(state->Stb.select_start, state->Stb.select_end);
const ImWchar* text_selected_end = text_begin + ImMax(state->Stb.select_start, state->Stb.select_end);
ImU32 bg_color = GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_TextSelectedBg, render_cursor ? 1.0f : 0.6f); // FIXME: current code flow mandate that render_cursor is always true here, we are leaving the transparent one for tests.
float bg_offy_up = is_multiline ? 0.0f : -1.0f; // FIXME: those offsets should be part of the style? they don't play so well with multi-line selection.
float bg_offy_dn = is_multiline ? 0.0f : 2.0f;
ImVec2 rect_pos = draw_pos + select_start_offset - draw_scroll;
for (const ImWchar* p = text_selected_begin; p < text_selected_end; )
{
if (rect_pos.y > clip_rect.w + g.FontSize)
break;
if (rect_pos.y < clip_rect.y)
{
//p = (const ImWchar*)wmemchr((const wchar_t*)p, '\n', text_selected_end - p); // FIXME-OPT: Could use this when wchar_t are 16-bit
//p = p ? p + 1 : text_selected_end;
while (p < text_selected_end)
if (*p++ == '\n')
break;
}
else
{
ImVec2 rect_size = InputTextCalcTextSizeW(p, text_selected_end, &p, NULL, true);
if (rect_size.x <= 0.0f) rect_size.x = IM_FLOOR(g.Font->GetCharAdvance((ImWchar)' ') * 0.50f); // So we can see selected empty lines
ImRect rect(rect_pos + ImVec2(0.0f, bg_offy_up - g.FontSize), rect_pos +ImVec2(rect_size.x, bg_offy_dn));
rect.ClipWith(clip_rect);
if (rect.Overlaps(clip_rect))
draw_window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(rect.Min, rect.Max, bg_color);
}
rect_pos.x = draw_pos.x - draw_scroll.x;
rect_pos.y += g.FontSize;
}
}
// We test for 'buf_display_max_length' as a way to avoid some pathological cases (e.g. single-line 1 MB string) which would make ImDrawList crash.
if (is_multiline || (buf_display_end - buf_display) < buf_display_max_length)
{
ImU32 col = GetColorU32(is_displaying_hint ? ImGuiCol_TextDisabled : ImGuiCol_Text);
draw_window->DrawList->AddText(g.Font, g.FontSize, draw_pos - draw_scroll, col, buf_display, buf_display_end, 0.0f, is_multiline ? NULL : &clip_rect);
}
// Draw blinking cursor
if (render_cursor)
{
state->CursorAnim += io.DeltaTime;
bool cursor_is_visible = (!g.IO.ConfigInputTextCursorBlink) || (state->CursorAnim <= 0.0f) || ImFmod(state->CursorAnim, 1.20f) <= 0.80f;
ImVec2 cursor_screen_pos = draw_pos + cursor_offset - draw_scroll;
ImRect cursor_screen_rect(cursor_screen_pos.x, cursor_screen_pos.y - g.FontSize + 0.5f, cursor_screen_pos.x + 1.0f, cursor_screen_pos.y - 1.5f);
if (cursor_is_visible && cursor_screen_rect.Overlaps(clip_rect))
draw_window->DrawList->AddLine(cursor_screen_rect.Min, cursor_screen_rect.GetBL(), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text));
// Notify OS of text input position for advanced IME (-1 x offset so that Windows IME can cover our cursor. Bit of an extra nicety.)
if (!is_readonly)
g.PlatformImePos = ImVec2(cursor_screen_pos.x - 1.0f, cursor_screen_pos.y - g.FontSize);
}
}
else
{
// Render text only (no selection, no cursor)
if (is_multiline)
text_size = ImVec2(inner_size.x, InputTextCalcTextLenAndLineCount(buf_display, &buf_display_end) * g.FontSize); // We don't need width
else if (!is_displaying_hint && g.ActiveId == id)
buf_display_end = buf_display + state->CurLenA;
else if (!is_displaying_hint)
buf_display_end = buf_display + strlen(buf_display);
if (is_multiline || (buf_display_end - buf_display) < buf_display_max_length)
{
ImU32 col = GetColorU32(is_displaying_hint ? ImGuiCol_TextDisabled : ImGuiCol_Text);
draw_window->DrawList->AddText(g.Font, g.FontSize, draw_pos, col, buf_display, buf_display_end, 0.0f, is_multiline ? NULL : &clip_rect);
}
}
if (is_multiline)
{
Dummy(text_size + ImVec2(0.0f, g.FontSize)); // Always add room to scroll an extra line
EndChild();
EndGroup();
}
if (is_password && !is_displaying_hint)
PopFont();
// Log as text
if (g.LogEnabled && !(is_password && !is_displaying_hint))
LogRenderedText(&draw_pos, buf_display, buf_display_end);
if (label_size.x > 0)
RenderText(ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, frame_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), label);
if (value_changed && !(flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_NoMarkEdited))
MarkItemEdited(id);
IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(id, label, window->DC.ItemFlags);
if ((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_EnterReturnsTrue) != 0)
return enter_pressed;
else
return value_changed;
}
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// [SECTION] Widgets: ColorEdit, ColorPicker, ColorButton, etc.
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// - ColorEdit3()
// - ColorEdit4()
// - ColorPicker3()
// - RenderColorRectWithAlphaCheckerboard() [Internal]
// - ColorPicker4()
// - ColorButton()
// - SetColorEditOptions()
// - ColorTooltip() [Internal]
// - ColorEditOptionsPopup() [Internal]
// - ColorPickerOptionsPopup() [Internal]
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
bool ImGui::ColorEdit3(const char* label, float col[3], ImGuiColorEditFlags flags)
{
return ColorEdit4(label, col, flags | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha);
}
// Edit colors components (each component in 0.0f..1.0f range).
// See enum ImGuiColorEditFlags_ for available options. e.g. Only access 3 floats if ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha flag is set.
// With typical options: Left-click on colored square to open color picker. Right-click to open option menu. CTRL-Click over input fields to edit them and TAB to go to next item.
bool ImGui::ColorEdit4(const char* label, float col[4], ImGuiColorEditFlags flags)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
const float square_sz = GetFrameHeight();
const float w_full = CalcItemWidth();
const float w_button = (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSmallPreview) ? 0.0f : (square_sz + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
const float w_inputs = w_full - w_button;
const char* label_display_end = FindRenderedTextEnd(label);
g.NextItemData.ClearFlags();
BeginGroup();
PushID(label);
// If we're not showing any slider there's no point in doing any HSV conversions
const ImGuiColorEditFlags flags_untouched = flags;
if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoInputs)
flags = (flags & (~ImGuiColorEditFlags__DisplayMask)) | ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayRGB | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions;
// Context menu: display and modify options (before defaults are applied)
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions))
ColorEditOptionsPopup(col, flags);
// Read stored options
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__DisplayMask))
flags |= (g.ColorEditOptions & ImGuiColorEditFlags__DisplayMask);
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__DataTypeMask))
flags |= (g.ColorEditOptions & ImGuiColorEditFlags__DataTypeMask);
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__PickerMask))
flags |= (g.ColorEditOptions & ImGuiColorEditFlags__PickerMask);
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputMask))
flags |= (g.ColorEditOptions & ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputMask);
flags |= (g.ColorEditOptions & ~(ImGuiColorEditFlags__DisplayMask | ImGuiColorEditFlags__DataTypeMask | ImGuiColorEditFlags__PickerMask | ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputMask));
IM_ASSERT(ImIsPowerOfTwo(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__DisplayMask)); // Check that only 1 is selected
IM_ASSERT(ImIsPowerOfTwo(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputMask)); // Check that only 1 is selected
const bool alpha = (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha) == 0;
const bool hdr = (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_HDR) != 0;
const int components = alpha ? 4 : 3;
// Convert to the formats we need
float f[4] = { col[0], col[1], col[2], alpha ? col[3] : 1.0f };
if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputHSV) && (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayRGB))
ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(f[0], f[1], f[2], f[0], f[1], f[2]);
else if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputRGB) && (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHSV))
{
// Hue is lost when converting from greyscale rgb (saturation=0). Restore it.
ColorConvertRGBtoHSV(f[0], f[1], f[2], f[0], f[1], f[2]);
if (memcmp(g.ColorEditLastColor, col, sizeof(float) * 3) == 0)
{
if (f[1] == 0)
f[0] = g.ColorEditLastHue;
if (f[2] == 0)
f[1] = g.ColorEditLastSat;
}
}
int i[4] = { IM_F32_TO_INT8_UNBOUND(f[0]), IM_F32_TO_INT8_UNBOUND(f[1]), IM_F32_TO_INT8_UNBOUND(f[2]), IM_F32_TO_INT8_UNBOUND(f[3]) };
bool value_changed = false;
bool value_changed_as_float = false;
const ImVec2 pos = window->DC.CursorPos;
const float inputs_offset_x = (style.ColorButtonPosition == ImGuiDir_Left) ? w_button : 0.0f;
window->DC.CursorPos.x = pos.x + inputs_offset_x;
if ((flags & (ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayRGB | ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHSV)) != 0 && (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoInputs) == 0)
{
// RGB/HSV 0..255 Sliders
const float w_item_one = ImMax(1.0f, IM_FLOOR((w_inputs - (style.ItemInnerSpacing.x) * (components-1)) / (float)components));
const float w_item_last = ImMax(1.0f, IM_FLOOR(w_inputs - (w_item_one + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x) * (components-1)));
const bool hide_prefix = (w_item_one <= CalcTextSize((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_Float) ? "M:0.000" : "M:000").x);
static const char* ids[4] = { "##X", "##Y", "##Z", "##W" };
static const char* fmt_table_int[3][4] =
{
{ "%3d", "%3d", "%3d", "%3d" }, // Short display
{ "R:%3d", "G:%3d", "B:%3d", "A:%3d" }, // Long display for RGBA
{ "H:%3d", "S:%3d", "V:%3d", "A:%3d" } // Long display for HSVA
};
static const char* fmt_table_float[3][4] =
{
{ "%0.3f", "%0.3f", "%0.3f", "%0.3f" }, // Short display
{ "R:%0.3f", "G:%0.3f", "B:%0.3f", "A:%0.3f" }, // Long display for RGBA
{ "H:%0.3f", "S:%0.3f", "V:%0.3f", "A:%0.3f" } // Long display for HSVA
};
const int fmt_idx = hide_prefix ? 0 : (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHSV) ? 2 : 1;
for (int n = 0; n < components; n++)
{
if (n > 0)
SameLine(0, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
SetNextItemWidth((n + 1 < components) ? w_item_one : w_item_last);
// FIXME: When ImGuiColorEditFlags_HDR flag is passed HS values snap in weird ways when SV values go below 0.
if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_Float)
{
value_changed |= DragFloat(ids[n], &f[n], 1.0f/255.0f, 0.0f, hdr ? 0.0f : 1.0f, fmt_table_float[fmt_idx][n]);
value_changed_as_float |= value_changed;
}
else
{
value_changed |= DragInt(ids[n], &i[n], 1.0f, 0, hdr ? 0 : 255, fmt_table_int[fmt_idx][n]);
}
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions))
OpenPopupOnItemClick("context");
}
}
else if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHex) != 0 && (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoInputs) == 0)
{
// RGB Hexadecimal Input
char buf[64];
if (alpha)
ImFormatString(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), "#%02X%02X%02X%02X", ImClamp(i[0],0,255), ImClamp(i[1],0,255), ImClamp(i[2],0,255), ImClamp(i[3],0,255));
else
ImFormatString(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), "#%02X%02X%02X", ImClamp(i[0],0,255), ImClamp(i[1],0,255), ImClamp(i[2],0,255));
SetNextItemWidth(w_inputs);
if (InputText("##Text", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsHexadecimal | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsUppercase))
{
value_changed = true;
char* p = buf;
while (*p == '#' || ImCharIsBlankA(*p))
p++;
i[0] = i[1] = i[2] = i[3] = 0;
if (alpha)
sscanf(p, "%02X%02X%02X%02X", (unsigned int*)&i[0], (unsigned int*)&i[1], (unsigned int*)&i[2], (unsigned int*)&i[3]); // Treat at unsigned (%X is unsigned)
else
sscanf(p, "%02X%02X%02X", (unsigned int*)&i[0], (unsigned int*)&i[1], (unsigned int*)&i[2]);
}
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions))
OpenPopupOnItemClick("context");
}
ImGuiWindow* picker_active_window = NULL;
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSmallPreview))
{
const float button_offset_x = ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoInputs) || (style.ColorButtonPosition == ImGuiDir_Left)) ? 0.0f : w_inputs + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x;
window->DC.CursorPos = ImVec2(pos.x + button_offset_x, pos.y);
const ImVec4 col_v4(col[0], col[1], col[2], alpha ? col[3] : 1.0f);
if (ColorButton("##ColorButton", col_v4, flags))
{
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoPicker))
{
// Store current color and open a picker
g.ColorPickerRef = col_v4;
OpenPopup("picker");
SetNextWindowPos(window->DC.LastItemRect.GetBL() + ImVec2(-1,style.ItemSpacing.y));
}
}
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions))
OpenPopupOnItemClick("context");
if (BeginPopup("picker"))
{
picker_active_window = g.CurrentWindow;
if (label != label_display_end)
{
TextEx(label, label_display_end);
Spacing();
}
ImGuiColorEditFlags picker_flags_to_forward = ImGuiColorEditFlags__DataTypeMask | ImGuiColorEditFlags__PickerMask | ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputMask | ImGuiColorEditFlags_HDR | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaBar;
ImGuiColorEditFlags picker_flags = (flags_untouched & picker_flags_to_forward) | ImGuiColorEditFlags__DisplayMask | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoLabel | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreviewHalf;
SetNextItemWidth(square_sz * 12.0f); // Use 256 + bar sizes?
value_changed |= ColorPicker4("##picker", col, picker_flags, &g.ColorPickerRef.x);
EndPopup();
}
}
if (label != label_display_end && !(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoLabel))
{
const float text_offset_x = (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoInputs) ? w_button : w_full + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x;
window->DC.CursorPos = ImVec2(pos.x + text_offset_x, pos.y + style.FramePadding.y);
TextEx(label, label_display_end);
}
// Convert back
if (value_changed && picker_active_window == NULL)
{
if (!value_changed_as_float)
for (int n = 0; n < 4; n++)
f[n] = i[n] / 255.0f;
if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHSV) && (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputRGB))
{
g.ColorEditLastHue = f[0];
g.ColorEditLastSat = f[1];
ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(f[0], f[1], f[2], f[0], f[1], f[2]);
memcpy(g.ColorEditLastColor, f, sizeof(float) * 3);
}
if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayRGB) && (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputHSV))
ColorConvertRGBtoHSV(f[0], f[1], f[2], f[0], f[1], f[2]);
col[0] = f[0];
col[1] = f[1];
col[2] = f[2];
if (alpha)
col[3] = f[3];
}
PopID();
EndGroup();
// Drag and Drop Target
// NB: The flag test is merely an optional micro-optimization, BeginDragDropTarget() does the same test.
if ((window->DC.LastItemStatusFlags & ImGuiItemStatusFlags_HoveredRect) && !(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoDragDrop) && BeginDragDropTarget())
{
bool accepted_drag_drop = false;
if (const ImGuiPayload* payload = AcceptDragDropPayload(IMGUI_PAYLOAD_TYPE_COLOR_3F))
{
memcpy((float*)col, payload->Data, sizeof(float) * 3); // Preserve alpha if any //-V512
value_changed = accepted_drag_drop = true;
}
if (const ImGuiPayload* payload = AcceptDragDropPayload(IMGUI_PAYLOAD_TYPE_COLOR_4F))
{
memcpy((float*)col, payload->Data, sizeof(float) * components);
value_changed = accepted_drag_drop = true;
}
// Drag-drop payloads are always RGB
if (accepted_drag_drop && (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputHSV))
ColorConvertRGBtoHSV(col[0], col[1], col[2], col[0], col[1], col[2]);
EndDragDropTarget();
}
// When picker is being actively used, use its active id so IsItemActive() will function on ColorEdit4().
if (picker_active_window && g.ActiveId != 0 && g.ActiveIdWindow == picker_active_window)
window->DC.LastItemId = g.ActiveId;
if (value_changed)
MarkItemEdited(window->DC.LastItemId);
return value_changed;
}
bool ImGui::ColorPicker3(const char* label, float col[3], ImGuiColorEditFlags flags)
{
float col4[4] = { col[0], col[1], col[2], 1.0f };
if (!ColorPicker4(label, col4, flags | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha))
return false;
col[0] = col4[0]; col[1] = col4[1]; col[2] = col4[2];
return true;
}
// Helper for ColorPicker4()
static void RenderArrowsForVerticalBar(ImDrawList* draw_list, ImVec2 pos, ImVec2 half_sz, float bar_w, float alpha)
{
ImU32 alpha8 = IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(alpha);
ImGui::RenderArrowPointingAt(draw_list, ImVec2(pos.x + half_sz.x + 1, pos.y), ImVec2(half_sz.x + 2, half_sz.y + 1), ImGuiDir_Right, IM_COL32(0,0,0,alpha8));
ImGui::RenderArrowPointingAt(draw_list, ImVec2(pos.x + half_sz.x, pos.y), half_sz, ImGuiDir_Right, IM_COL32(255,255,255,alpha8));
ImGui::RenderArrowPointingAt(draw_list, ImVec2(pos.x + bar_w - half_sz.x - 1, pos.y), ImVec2(half_sz.x + 2, half_sz.y + 1), ImGuiDir_Left, IM_COL32(0,0,0,alpha8));
ImGui::RenderArrowPointingAt(draw_list, ImVec2(pos.x + bar_w - half_sz.x, pos.y), half_sz, ImGuiDir_Left, IM_COL32(255,255,255,alpha8));
}
// Note: ColorPicker4() only accesses 3 floats if ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha flag is set.
// (In C++ the 'float col[4]' notation for a function argument is equivalent to 'float* col', we only specify a size to facilitate understanding of the code.)
// FIXME: we adjust the big color square height based on item width, which may cause a flickering feedback loop (if automatic height makes a vertical scrollbar appears, affecting automatic width..)
// FIXME: this is trying to be aware of style.Alpha but not fully correct. Also, the color wheel will have overlapping glitches with (style.Alpha < 1.0)
bool ImGui::ColorPicker4(const char* label, float col[4], ImGuiColorEditFlags flags, const float* ref_col)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
ImDrawList* draw_list = window->DrawList;
ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
ImGuiIO& io = g.IO;
const float width = CalcItemWidth();
g.NextItemData.ClearFlags();
PushID(label);
BeginGroup();
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSidePreview))
flags |= ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSmallPreview;
// Context menu: display and store options.
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions))
ColorPickerOptionsPopup(col, flags);
// Read stored options
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__PickerMask))
flags |= ((g.ColorEditOptions & ImGuiColorEditFlags__PickerMask) ? g.ColorEditOptions : ImGuiColorEditFlags__OptionsDefault) & ImGuiColorEditFlags__PickerMask;
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputMask))
flags |= ((g.ColorEditOptions & ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputMask) ? g.ColorEditOptions : ImGuiColorEditFlags__OptionsDefault) & ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputMask;
IM_ASSERT(ImIsPowerOfTwo(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__PickerMask)); // Check that only 1 is selected
IM_ASSERT(ImIsPowerOfTwo(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputMask)); // Check that only 1 is selected
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions))
flags |= (g.ColorEditOptions & ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaBar);
// Setup
int components = (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha) ? 3 : 4;
bool alpha_bar = (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaBar) && !(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha);
ImVec2 picker_pos = window->DC.CursorPos;
float square_sz = GetFrameHeight();
float bars_width = square_sz; // Arbitrary smallish width of Hue/Alpha picking bars
float sv_picker_size = ImMax(bars_width * 1, width - (alpha_bar ? 2 : 1) * (bars_width + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x)); // Saturation/Value picking box
float bar0_pos_x = picker_pos.x + sv_picker_size + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x;
float bar1_pos_x = bar0_pos_x + bars_width + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x;
float bars_triangles_half_sz = IM_FLOOR(bars_width * 0.20f);
float backup_initial_col[4];
memcpy(backup_initial_col, col, components * sizeof(float));
float wheel_thickness = sv_picker_size * 0.08f;
float wheel_r_outer = sv_picker_size * 0.50f;
float wheel_r_inner = wheel_r_outer - wheel_thickness;
ImVec2 wheel_center(picker_pos.x + (sv_picker_size + bars_width)*0.5f, picker_pos.y + sv_picker_size*0.5f);
// Note: the triangle is displayed rotated with triangle_pa pointing to Hue, but most coordinates stays unrotated for logic.
float triangle_r = wheel_r_inner - (int)(sv_picker_size * 0.027f);
ImVec2 triangle_pa = ImVec2(triangle_r, 0.0f); // Hue point.
ImVec2 triangle_pb = ImVec2(triangle_r * -0.5f, triangle_r * -0.866025f); // Black point.
ImVec2 triangle_pc = ImVec2(triangle_r * -0.5f, triangle_r * +0.866025f); // White point.
float H = col[0], S = col[1], V = col[2];
float R = col[0], G = col[1], B = col[2];
if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputRGB)
{
// Hue is lost when converting from greyscale rgb (saturation=0). Restore it.
ColorConvertRGBtoHSV(R, G, B, H, S, V);
if (memcmp(g.ColorEditLastColor, col, sizeof(float) * 3) == 0)
{
if (S == 0)
H = g.ColorEditLastHue;
if (V == 0)
S = g.ColorEditLastSat;
}
}
else if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputHSV)
{
ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(H, S, V, R, G, B);
}
bool value_changed = false, value_changed_h = false, value_changed_sv = false;
PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags_NoNav, true);
if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerHueWheel)
{
// Hue wheel + SV triangle logic
InvisibleButton("hsv", ImVec2(sv_picker_size + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + bars_width, sv_picker_size));
if (IsItemActive())
{
ImVec2 initial_off = g.IO.MouseClickedPos[0] - wheel_center;
ImVec2 current_off = g.IO.MousePos - wheel_center;
float initial_dist2 = ImLengthSqr(initial_off);
if (initial_dist2 >= (wheel_r_inner-1)*(wheel_r_inner-1) && initial_dist2 <= (wheel_r_outer+1)*(wheel_r_outer+1))
{
// Interactive with Hue wheel
H = ImAtan2(current_off.y, current_off.x) / IM_PI*0.5f;
if (H < 0.0f)
H += 1.0f;
value_changed = value_changed_h = true;
}
float cos_hue_angle = ImCos(-H * 2.0f * IM_PI);
float sin_hue_angle = ImSin(-H * 2.0f * IM_PI);
if (ImTriangleContainsPoint(triangle_pa, triangle_pb, triangle_pc, ImRotate(initial_off, cos_hue_angle, sin_hue_angle)))
{
// Interacting with SV triangle
ImVec2 current_off_unrotated = ImRotate(current_off, cos_hue_angle, sin_hue_angle);
if (!ImTriangleContainsPoint(triangle_pa, triangle_pb, triangle_pc, current_off_unrotated))
current_off_unrotated = ImTriangleClosestPoint(triangle_pa, triangle_pb, triangle_pc, current_off_unrotated);
float uu, vv, ww;
ImTriangleBarycentricCoords(triangle_pa, triangle_pb, triangle_pc, current_off_unrotated, uu, vv, ww);
V = ImClamp(1.0f - vv, 0.0001f, 1.0f);
S = ImClamp(uu / V, 0.0001f, 1.0f);
value_changed = value_changed_sv = true;
}
}
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions))
OpenPopupOnItemClick("context");
}
else if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerHueBar)
{
// SV rectangle logic
InvisibleButton("sv", ImVec2(sv_picker_size, sv_picker_size));
if (IsItemActive())
{
S = ImSaturate((io.MousePos.x - picker_pos.x) / (sv_picker_size-1));
V = 1.0f - ImSaturate((io.MousePos.y - picker_pos.y) / (sv_picker_size-1));
value_changed = value_changed_sv = true;
}
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions))
OpenPopupOnItemClick("context");
// Hue bar logic
SetCursorScreenPos(ImVec2(bar0_pos_x, picker_pos.y));
InvisibleButton("hue", ImVec2(bars_width, sv_picker_size));
if (IsItemActive())
{
H = ImSaturate((io.MousePos.y - picker_pos.y) / (sv_picker_size-1));
value_changed = value_changed_h = true;
}
}
// Alpha bar logic
if (alpha_bar)
{
SetCursorScreenPos(ImVec2(bar1_pos_x, picker_pos.y));
InvisibleButton("alpha", ImVec2(bars_width, sv_picker_size));
if (IsItemActive())
{
col[3] = 1.0f - ImSaturate((io.MousePos.y - picker_pos.y) / (sv_picker_size-1));
value_changed = true;
}
}
PopItemFlag(); // ImGuiItemFlags_NoNav
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSidePreview))
{
SameLine(0, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
BeginGroup();
}
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoLabel))
{
const char* label_display_end = FindRenderedTextEnd(label);
if (label != label_display_end)
{
if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSidePreview))
SameLine(0, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x);
TextEx(label, label_display_end);
}
}
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSidePreview))
{
PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags_NoNavDefaultFocus, true);
ImVec4 col_v4(col[0], col[1], col[2], (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha) ? 1.0f : col[3]);
if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoLabel))
Text("Current");
ImGuiColorEditFlags sub_flags_to_forward = ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputMask | ImGuiColorEditFlags_HDR | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreview | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreviewHalf | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoTooltip;
ColorButton("##current", col_v4, (flags & sub_flags_to_forward), ImVec2(square_sz * 3, square_sz * 2));
if (ref_col != NULL)
{
Text("Original");
ImVec4 ref_col_v4(ref_col[0], ref_col[1], ref_col[2], (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha) ? 1.0f : ref_col[3]);
if (ColorButton("##original", ref_col_v4, (flags & sub_flags_to_forward), ImVec2(square_sz * 3, square_sz * 2)))
{
memcpy(col, ref_col, components * sizeof(float));
value_changed = true;
}
}
PopItemFlag();
EndGroup();
}
// Convert back color to RGB
if (value_changed_h || value_changed_sv)
{
if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputRGB)
{
ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(H >= 1.0f ? H - 10 * 1e-6f : H, S > 0.0f ? S : 10*1e-6f, V > 0.0f ? V : 1e-6f, col[0], col[1], col[2]);
g.ColorEditLastHue = H;
g.ColorEditLastSat = S;
memcpy(g.ColorEditLastColor, col, sizeof(float) * 3);
}
else if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputHSV)
{
col[0] = H;
col[1] = S;
col[2] = V;
}
}
// R,G,B and H,S,V slider color editor
bool value_changed_fix_hue_wrap = false;
if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoInputs) == 0)
{
PushItemWidth((alpha_bar ? bar1_pos_x : bar0_pos_x) + bars_width - picker_pos.x);
ImGuiColorEditFlags sub_flags_to_forward = ImGuiColorEditFlags__DataTypeMask | ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputMask | ImGuiColorEditFlags_HDR | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSmallPreview | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreview | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreviewHalf;
ImGuiColorEditFlags sub_flags = (flags & sub_flags_to_forward) | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoPicker;
if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayRGB || (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__DisplayMask) == 0)
if (ColorEdit4("##rgb", col, sub_flags | ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayRGB))
{
// FIXME: Hackily differenciating using the DragInt (ActiveId != 0 && !ActiveIdAllowOverlap) vs. using the InputText or DropTarget.
// For the later we don't want to run the hue-wrap canceling code. If you are well versed in HSV picker please provide your input! (See #2050)
value_changed_fix_hue_wrap = (g.ActiveId != 0 && !g.ActiveIdAllowOverlap);
value_changed = true;
}
if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHSV || (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__DisplayMask) == 0)
value_changed |= ColorEdit4("##hsv", col, sub_flags | ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHSV);
if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHex || (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__DisplayMask) == 0)
value_changed |= ColorEdit4("##hex", col, sub_flags | ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHex);
PopItemWidth();
}
// Try to cancel hue wrap (after ColorEdit4 call), if any
if (value_changed_fix_hue_wrap && (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputRGB))
{
float new_H, new_S, new_V;
ColorConvertRGBtoHSV(col[0], col[1], col[2], new_H, new_S, new_V);
if (new_H <= 0 && H > 0)
{
if (new_V <= 0 && V != new_V)
ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(H, S, new_V <= 0 ? V * 0.5f : new_V, col[0], col[1], col[2]);
else if (new_S <= 0)
ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(H, new_S <= 0 ? S * 0.5f : new_S, new_V, col[0], col[1], col[2]);
}
}
if (value_changed)
{
if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputRGB)
{
R = col[0];
G = col[1];
B = col[2];
ColorConvertRGBtoHSV(R, G, B, H, S, V);
if (memcmp(g.ColorEditLastColor, col, sizeof(float) * 3) == 0) // Fix local Hue as display below will use it immediately.
{
if (S == 0)
H = g.ColorEditLastHue;
if (V == 0)
S = g.ColorEditLastSat;
}
}
else if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputHSV)
{
H = col[0];
S = col[1];
V = col[2];
ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(H, S, V, R, G, B);
}
}
const int style_alpha8 = IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(style.Alpha);
const ImU32 col_black = IM_COL32(0,0,0,style_alpha8);
const ImU32 col_white = IM_COL32(255,255,255,style_alpha8);
const ImU32 col_midgrey = IM_COL32(128,128,128,style_alpha8);
const ImU32 col_hues[6 + 1] = { IM_COL32(255,0,0,style_alpha8), IM_COL32(255,255,0,style_alpha8), IM_COL32(0,255,0,style_alpha8), IM_COL32(0,255,255,style_alpha8), IM_COL32(0,0,255,style_alpha8), IM_COL32(255,0,255,style_alpha8), IM_COL32(255,0,0,style_alpha8) };
ImVec4 hue_color_f(1, 1, 1, style.Alpha); ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(H, 1, 1, hue_color_f.x, hue_color_f.y, hue_color_f.z);
ImU32 hue_color32 = ColorConvertFloat4ToU32(hue_color_f);
ImU32 user_col32_striped_of_alpha = ColorConvertFloat4ToU32(ImVec4(R, G, B, style.Alpha)); // Important: this is still including the main rendering/style alpha!!
ImVec2 sv_cursor_pos;
if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerHueWheel)
{
// Render Hue Wheel
const float aeps = 0.5f / wheel_r_outer; // Half a pixel arc length in radians (2pi cancels out).
const int segment_per_arc = ImMax(4, (int)wheel_r_outer / 12);
for (int n = 0; n < 6; n++)
{
const float a0 = (n) /6.0f * 2.0f * IM_PI - aeps;
const float a1 = (n+1.0f)/6.0f * 2.0f * IM_PI + aeps;
const int vert_start_idx = draw_list->VtxBuffer.Size;
draw_list->PathArcTo(wheel_center, (wheel_r_inner + wheel_r_outer)*0.5f, a0, a1, segment_per_arc);
draw_list->PathStroke(col_white, false, wheel_thickness);
const int vert_end_idx = draw_list->VtxBuffer.Size;
// Paint colors over existing vertices
ImVec2 gradient_p0(wheel_center.x + ImCos(a0) * wheel_r_inner, wheel_center.y + ImSin(a0) * wheel_r_inner);
ImVec2 gradient_p1(wheel_center.x + ImCos(a1) * wheel_r_inner, wheel_center.y + ImSin(a1) * wheel_r_inner);
ShadeVertsLinearColorGradientKeepAlpha(draw_list, vert_start_idx, vert_end_idx, gradient_p0, gradient_p1, col_hues[n], col_hues[n+1]);
}
// Render Cursor + preview on Hue Wheel
float cos_hue_angle = ImCos(H * 2.0f * IM_PI);
float sin_hue_angle = ImSin(H * 2.0f * IM_PI);
ImVec2 hue_cursor_pos(wheel_center.x + cos_hue_angle * (wheel_r_inner+wheel_r_outer)*0.5f, wheel_center.y + sin_hue_angle * (wheel_r_inner+wheel_r_outer)*0.5f);
float hue_cursor_rad = value_changed_h ? wheel_thickness * 0.65f : wheel_thickness * 0.55f;
int hue_cursor_segments = ImClamp((int)(hue_cursor_rad / 1.4f), 9, 32);
draw_list->AddCircleFilled(hue_cursor_pos, hue_cursor_rad, hue_color32, hue_cursor_segments);
draw_list->AddCircle(hue_cursor_pos, hue_cursor_rad+1, col_midgrey, hue_cursor_segments);
draw_list->AddCircle(hue_cursor_pos, hue_cursor_rad, col_white, hue_cursor_segments);
// Render SV triangle (rotated according to hue)
ImVec2 tra = wheel_center + ImRotate(triangle_pa, cos_hue_angle, sin_hue_angle);
ImVec2 trb = wheel_center + ImRotate(triangle_pb, cos_hue_angle, sin_hue_angle);
ImVec2 trc = wheel_center + ImRotate(triangle_pc, cos_hue_angle, sin_hue_angle);
ImVec2 uv_white = GetFontTexUvWhitePixel();
draw_list->PrimReserve(6, 6);
draw_list->PrimVtx(tra, uv_white, hue_color32);
draw_list->PrimVtx(trb, uv_white, hue_color32);
draw_list->PrimVtx(trc, uv_white, col_white);
draw_list->PrimVtx(tra, uv_white, 0);
draw_list->PrimVtx(trb, uv_white, col_black);
draw_list->PrimVtx(trc, uv_white, 0);
draw_list->AddTriangle(tra, trb, trc, col_midgrey, 1.5f);
sv_cursor_pos = ImLerp(ImLerp(trc, tra, ImSaturate(S)), trb, ImSaturate(1 - V));
}
else if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerHueBar)
{
// Render SV Square
draw_list->AddRectFilledMultiColor(picker_pos, picker_pos + ImVec2(sv_picker_size, sv_picker_size), col_white, hue_color32, hue_color32, col_white);
draw_list->AddRectFilledMultiColor(picker_pos, picker_pos + ImVec2(sv_picker_size, sv_picker_size), 0, 0, col_black, col_black);
RenderFrameBorder(picker_pos, picker_pos + ImVec2(sv_picker_size, sv_picker_size), 0.0f);
sv_cursor_pos.x = ImClamp(IM_ROUND(picker_pos.x + ImSaturate(S) * sv_picker_size), picker_pos.x + 2, picker_pos.x + sv_picker_size - 2); // Sneakily prevent the circle to stick out too much
sv_cursor_pos.y = ImClamp(IM_ROUND(picker_pos.y + ImSaturate(1 - V) * sv_picker_size), picker_pos.y + 2, picker_pos.y + sv_picker_size - 2);
// Render Hue Bar
for (int i = 0; i < 6; ++i)
draw_list->AddRectFilledMultiColor(ImVec2(bar0_pos_x, picker_pos.y + i * (sv_picker_size / 6)), ImVec2(bar0_pos_x + bars_width, picker_pos.y + (i + 1) * (sv_picker_size / 6)), col_hues[i], col_hues[i], col_hues[i + 1], col_hues[i + 1]);
float bar0_line_y = IM_ROUND(picker_pos.y + H * sv_picker_size);
RenderFrameBorder(ImVec2(bar0_pos_x, picker_pos.y), ImVec2(bar0_pos_x + bars_width, picker_pos.y + sv_picker_size), 0.0f);
RenderArrowsForVerticalBar(draw_list, ImVec2(bar0_pos_x - 1, bar0_line_y), ImVec2(bars_triangles_half_sz + 1, bars_triangles_half_sz), bars_width + 2.0f, style.Alpha);
}
// Render cursor/preview circle (clamp S/V within 0..1 range because floating points colors may lead HSV values to be out of range)
float sv_cursor_rad = value_changed_sv ? 10.0f : 6.0f;
draw_list->AddCircleFilled(sv_cursor_pos, sv_cursor_rad, user_col32_striped_of_alpha, 12);
draw_list->AddCircle(sv_cursor_pos, sv_cursor_rad+1, col_midgrey, 12);
draw_list->AddCircle(sv_cursor_pos, sv_cursor_rad, col_white, 12);
// Render alpha bar
if (alpha_bar)
{
float alpha = ImSaturate(col[3]);
ImRect bar1_bb(bar1_pos_x, picker_pos.y, bar1_pos_x + bars_width, picker_pos.y + sv_picker_size);
RenderColorRectWithAlphaCheckerboard(draw_list, bar1_bb.Min, bar1_bb.Max, 0, bar1_bb.GetWidth() / 2.0f, ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f));
draw_list->AddRectFilledMultiColor(bar1_bb.Min, bar1_bb.Max, user_col32_striped_of_alpha, user_col32_striped_of_alpha, user_col32_striped_of_alpha & ~IM_COL32_A_MASK, user_col32_striped_of_alpha & ~IM_COL32_A_MASK);
float bar1_line_y = IM_ROUND(picker_pos.y + (1.0f - alpha) * sv_picker_size);
RenderFrameBorder(bar1_bb.Min, bar1_bb.Max, 0.0f);
RenderArrowsForVerticalBar(draw_list, ImVec2(bar1_pos_x - 1, bar1_line_y), ImVec2(bars_triangles_half_sz + 1, bars_triangles_half_sz), bars_width + 2.0f, style.Alpha);
}
EndGroup();
if (value_changed && memcmp(backup_initial_col, col, components * sizeof(float)) == 0)
value_changed = false;
if (value_changed)
MarkItemEdited(window->DC.LastItemId);
PopID();
return value_changed;
}
// A little colored square. Return true when clicked.
// FIXME: May want to display/ignore the alpha component in the color display? Yet show it in the tooltip.
// 'desc_id' is not called 'label' because we don't display it next to the button, but only in the tooltip.
// Note that 'col' may be encoded in HSV if ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputHSV is set.
bool ImGui::ColorButton(const char* desc_id, const ImVec4& col, ImGuiColorEditFlags flags, ImVec2 size)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(desc_id);
float default_size = GetFrameHeight();
if (size.x == 0.0f)
size.x = default_size;
if (size.y == 0.0f)
size.y = default_size;
const ImRect bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + size);
ItemSize(bb, (size.y >= default_size) ? g.Style.FramePadding.y : 0.0f);
if (!ItemAdd(bb, id))
return false;
bool hovered, held;
bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held);
if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha)
flags &= ~(ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreview | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreviewHalf);
ImVec4 col_rgb = col;
if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputHSV)
ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(col_rgb.x, col_rgb.y, col_rgb.z, col_rgb.x, col_rgb.y, col_rgb.z);
ImVec4 col_rgb_without_alpha(col_rgb.x, col_rgb.y, col_rgb.z, 1.0f);
float grid_step = ImMin(size.x, size.y) / 2.99f;
float rounding = ImMin(g.Style.FrameRounding, grid_step * 0.5f);
ImRect bb_inner = bb;
float off = 0.0f;
if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoBorder) == 0)
{
off = -0.75f; // The border (using Col_FrameBg) tends to look off when color is near-opaque and rounding is enabled. This offset seemed like a good middle ground to reduce those artifacts.
bb_inner.Expand(off);
}
if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreviewHalf) && col_rgb.w < 1.0f)
{
float mid_x = IM_ROUND((bb_inner.Min.x + bb_inner.Max.x) * 0.5f);
RenderColorRectWithAlphaCheckerboard(window->DrawList, ImVec2(bb_inner.Min.x + grid_step, bb_inner.Min.y), bb_inner.Max, GetColorU32(col_rgb), grid_step, ImVec2(-grid_step + off, off), rounding, ImDrawCornerFlags_TopRight| ImDrawCornerFlags_BotRight);
window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(bb_inner.Min, ImVec2(mid_x, bb_inner.Max.y), GetColorU32(col_rgb_without_alpha), rounding, ImDrawCornerFlags_TopLeft|ImDrawCornerFlags_BotLeft);
}
else
{
// Because GetColorU32() multiplies by the global style Alpha and we don't want to display a checkerboard if the source code had no alpha
ImVec4 col_source = (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreview) ? col_rgb : col_rgb_without_alpha;
if (col_source.w < 1.0f)
RenderColorRectWithAlphaCheckerboard(window->DrawList, bb_inner.Min, bb_inner.Max, GetColorU32(col_source), grid_step, ImVec2(off, off), rounding);
else
window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(bb_inner.Min, bb_inner.Max, GetColorU32(col_source), rounding, ImDrawCornerFlags_All);
}
RenderNavHighlight(bb, id);
if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoBorder) == 0)
{
if (g.Style.FrameBorderSize > 0.0f)
RenderFrameBorder(bb.Min, bb.Max, rounding);
else
window->DrawList->AddRect(bb.Min, bb.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_FrameBg), rounding); // Color button are often in need of some sort of border
}
// Drag and Drop Source
// NB: The ActiveId test is merely an optional micro-optimization, BeginDragDropSource() does the same test.
if (g.ActiveId == id && !(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoDragDrop) && BeginDragDropSource())
{
if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha)
SetDragDropPayload(IMGUI_PAYLOAD_TYPE_COLOR_3F, &col_rgb, sizeof(float) * 3, ImGuiCond_Once);
else
SetDragDropPayload(IMGUI_PAYLOAD_TYPE_COLOR_4F, &col_rgb, sizeof(float) * 4, ImGuiCond_Once);
ColorButton(desc_id, col, flags);
SameLine();
TextEx("Color");
EndDragDropSource();
}
// Tooltip
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoTooltip) && hovered)
ColorTooltip(desc_id, &col.x, flags & (ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputMask | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreview | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreviewHalf));
return pressed;
}
// Initialize/override default color options
void ImGui::SetColorEditOptions(ImGuiColorEditFlags flags)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__DisplayMask) == 0)
flags |= ImGuiColorEditFlags__OptionsDefault & ImGuiColorEditFlags__DisplayMask;
if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__DataTypeMask) == 0)
flags |= ImGuiColorEditFlags__OptionsDefault & ImGuiColorEditFlags__DataTypeMask;
if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__PickerMask) == 0)
flags |= ImGuiColorEditFlags__OptionsDefault & ImGuiColorEditFlags__PickerMask;
if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputMask) == 0)
flags |= ImGuiColorEditFlags__OptionsDefault & ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputMask;
IM_ASSERT(ImIsPowerOfTwo(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__DisplayMask)); // Check only 1 option is selected
IM_ASSERT(ImIsPowerOfTwo(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__DataTypeMask)); // Check only 1 option is selected
IM_ASSERT(ImIsPowerOfTwo(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__PickerMask)); // Check only 1 option is selected
IM_ASSERT(ImIsPowerOfTwo(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputMask)); // Check only 1 option is selected
g.ColorEditOptions = flags;
}
// Note: only access 3 floats if ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha flag is set.
void ImGui::ColorTooltip(const char* text, const float* col, ImGuiColorEditFlags flags)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
BeginTooltipEx(0, ImGuiTooltipFlags_OverridePreviousTooltip);
const char* text_end = text ? FindRenderedTextEnd(text, NULL) : text;
if (text_end > text)
{
TextEx(text, text_end);
Separator();
}
ImVec2 sz(g.FontSize * 3 + g.Style.FramePadding.y * 2, g.FontSize * 3 + g.Style.FramePadding.y * 2);
ImVec4 cf(col[0], col[1], col[2], (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha) ? 1.0f : col[3]);
int cr = IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(col[0]), cg = IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(col[1]), cb = IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(col[2]), ca = (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha) ? 255 : IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(col[3]);
ColorButton("##preview", cf, (flags & (ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputMask | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreview | ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaPreviewHalf)) | ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoTooltip, sz);
SameLine();
if ((flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputRGB) || !(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__InputMask))
{
if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha)
Text("#%02X%02X%02X\nR: %d, G: %d, B: %d\n(%.3f, %.3f, %.3f)", cr, cg, cb, cr, cg, cb, col[0], col[1], col[2]);
else
Text("#%02X%02X%02X%02X\nR:%d, G:%d, B:%d, A:%d\n(%.3f, %.3f, %.3f, %.3f)", cr, cg, cb, ca, cr, cg, cb, ca, col[0], col[1], col[2], col[3]);
}
else if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_InputHSV)
{
if (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha)
Text("H: %.3f, S: %.3f, V: %.3f", col[0], col[1], col[2]);
else
Text("H: %.3f, S: %.3f, V: %.3f, A: %.3f", col[0], col[1], col[2], col[3]);
}
EndTooltip();
}
void ImGui::ColorEditOptionsPopup(const float* col, ImGuiColorEditFlags flags)
{
bool allow_opt_inputs = !(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__DisplayMask);
bool allow_opt_datatype = !(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__DataTypeMask);
if ((!allow_opt_inputs && !allow_opt_datatype) || !BeginPopup("context"))
return;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiColorEditFlags opts = g.ColorEditOptions;
if (allow_opt_inputs)
{
if (RadioButton("RGB", (opts & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayRGB) != 0)) opts = (opts & ~ImGuiColorEditFlags__DisplayMask) | ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayRGB;
if (RadioButton("HSV", (opts & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHSV) != 0)) opts = (opts & ~ImGuiColorEditFlags__DisplayMask) | ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHSV;
if (RadioButton("Hex", (opts & ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHex) != 0)) opts = (opts & ~ImGuiColorEditFlags__DisplayMask) | ImGuiColorEditFlags_DisplayHex;
}
if (allow_opt_datatype)
{
if (allow_opt_inputs) Separator();
if (RadioButton("0..255", (opts & ImGuiColorEditFlags_Uint8) != 0)) opts = (opts & ~ImGuiColorEditFlags__DataTypeMask) | ImGuiColorEditFlags_Uint8;
if (RadioButton("0.00..1.00", (opts & ImGuiColorEditFlags_Float) != 0)) opts = (opts & ~ImGuiColorEditFlags__DataTypeMask) | ImGuiColorEditFlags_Float;
}
if (allow_opt_inputs || allow_opt_datatype)
Separator();
if (Button("Copy as..", ImVec2(-1,0)))
OpenPopup("Copy");
if (BeginPopup("Copy"))
{
int cr = IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(col[0]), cg = IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(col[1]), cb = IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(col[2]), ca = (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha) ? 255 : IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(col[3]);
char buf[64];
ImFormatString(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), "(%.3ff, %.3ff, %.3ff, %.3ff)", col[0], col[1], col[2], (flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha) ? 1.0f : col[3]);
if (Selectable(buf))
SetClipboardText(buf);
ImFormatString(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), "(%d,%d,%d,%d)", cr, cg, cb, ca);
if (Selectable(buf))
SetClipboardText(buf);
ImFormatString(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), "#%02X%02X%02X", cr, cg, cb);
if (Selectable(buf))
SetClipboardText(buf);
if (!(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha))
{
ImFormatString(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), "#%02X%02X%02X%02X", cr, cg, cb, ca);
if (Selectable(buf))
SetClipboardText(buf);
}
EndPopup();
}
g.ColorEditOptions = opts;
EndPopup();
}
void ImGui::ColorPickerOptionsPopup(const float* ref_col, ImGuiColorEditFlags flags)
{
bool allow_opt_picker = !(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__PickerMask);
bool allow_opt_alpha_bar = !(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha) && !(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaBar);
if ((!allow_opt_picker && !allow_opt_alpha_bar) || !BeginPopup("context"))
return;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
if (allow_opt_picker)
{
ImVec2 picker_size(g.FontSize * 8, ImMax(g.FontSize * 8 - (GetFrameHeight() + g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x), 1.0f)); // FIXME: Picker size copied from main picker function
PushItemWidth(picker_size.x);
for (int picker_type = 0; picker_type < 2; picker_type++)
{
// Draw small/thumbnail version of each picker type (over an invisible button for selection)
if (picker_type > 0) Separator();
PushID(picker_type);
ImGuiColorEditFlags picker_flags = ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoInputs|ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoOptions|ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoLabel|ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoSidePreview|(flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha);
if (picker_type == 0) picker_flags |= ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerHueBar;
if (picker_type == 1) picker_flags |= ImGuiColorEditFlags_PickerHueWheel;
ImVec2 backup_pos = GetCursorScreenPos();
if (Selectable("##selectable", false, 0, picker_size)) // By default, Selectable() is closing popup
g.ColorEditOptions = (g.ColorEditOptions & ~ImGuiColorEditFlags__PickerMask) | (picker_flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags__PickerMask);
SetCursorScreenPos(backup_pos);
ImVec4 dummy_ref_col;
memcpy(&dummy_ref_col, ref_col, sizeof(float) * ((picker_flags & ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoAlpha) ? 3 : 4));
ColorPicker4("##dummypicker", &dummy_ref_col.x, picker_flags);
PopID();
}
PopItemWidth();
}
if (allow_opt_alpha_bar)
{
if (allow_opt_picker) Separator();
CheckboxFlags("Alpha Bar", (unsigned int*)&g.ColorEditOptions, ImGuiColorEditFlags_AlphaBar);
}
EndPopup();
}
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// [SECTION] Widgets: TreeNode, CollapsingHeader, etc.
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// - TreeNode()
// - TreeNodeV()
// - TreeNodeEx()
// - TreeNodeExV()
// - TreeNodeBehavior() [Internal]
// - TreePush()
// - TreePop()
// - GetTreeNodeToLabelSpacing()
// - SetNextItemOpen()
// - CollapsingHeader()
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
bool ImGui::TreeNode(const char* str_id, const char* fmt, ...)
{
va_list args;
va_start(args, fmt);
bool is_open = TreeNodeExV(str_id, 0, fmt, args);
va_end(args);
return is_open;
}
bool ImGui::TreeNode(const void* ptr_id, const char* fmt, ...)
{
va_list args;
va_start(args, fmt);
bool is_open = TreeNodeExV(ptr_id, 0, fmt, args);
va_end(args);
return is_open;
}
bool ImGui::TreeNode(const char* label)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
return TreeNodeBehavior(window->GetID(label), 0, label, NULL);
}
bool ImGui::TreeNodeV(const char* str_id, const char* fmt, va_list args)
{
return TreeNodeExV(str_id, 0, fmt, args);
}
bool ImGui::TreeNodeV(const void* ptr_id, const char* fmt, va_list args)
{
return TreeNodeExV(ptr_id, 0, fmt, args);
}
bool ImGui::TreeNodeEx(const char* label, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
return TreeNodeBehavior(window->GetID(label), flags, label, NULL);
}
bool ImGui::TreeNodeEx(const char* str_id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* fmt, ...)
{
va_list args;
va_start(args, fmt);
bool is_open = TreeNodeExV(str_id, flags, fmt, args);
va_end(args);
return is_open;
}
bool ImGui::TreeNodeEx(const void* ptr_id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* fmt, ...)
{
va_list args;
va_start(args, fmt);
bool is_open = TreeNodeExV(ptr_id, flags, fmt, args);
va_end(args);
return is_open;
}
bool ImGui::TreeNodeExV(const char* str_id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* fmt, va_list args)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
const char* label_end = g.TempBuffer + ImFormatStringV(g.TempBuffer, IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.TempBuffer), fmt, args);
return TreeNodeBehavior(window->GetID(str_id), flags, g.TempBuffer, label_end);
}
bool ImGui::TreeNodeExV(const void* ptr_id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* fmt, va_list args)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
const char* label_end = g.TempBuffer + ImFormatStringV(g.TempBuffer, IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.TempBuffer), fmt, args);
return TreeNodeBehavior(window->GetID(ptr_id), flags, g.TempBuffer, label_end);
}
bool ImGui::TreeNodeBehaviorIsOpen(ImGuiID id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags)
{
if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Leaf)
return true;
// We only write to the tree storage if the user clicks (or explicitly use the SetNextItemOpen function)
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
ImGuiStorage* storage = window->DC.StateStorage;
bool is_open;
if (g.NextItemData.Flags & ImGuiNextItemDataFlags_HasOpen)
{
if (g.NextItemData.OpenCond & ImGuiCond_Always)
{
is_open = g.NextItemData.OpenVal;
storage->SetInt(id, is_open);
}
else
{
// We treat ImGuiCond_Once and ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver the same because tree node state are not saved persistently.
const int stored_value = storage->GetInt(id, -1);
if (stored_value == -1)
{
is_open = g.NextItemData.OpenVal;
storage->SetInt(id, is_open);
}
else
{
is_open = stored_value != 0;
}
}
}
else
{
is_open = storage->GetInt(id, (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_DefaultOpen) ? 1 : 0) != 0;
}
// When logging is enabled, we automatically expand tree nodes (but *NOT* collapsing headers.. seems like sensible behavior).
// NB- If we are above max depth we still allow manually opened nodes to be logged.
if (g.LogEnabled && !(flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoAutoOpenOnLog) && (window->DC.TreeDepth - g.LogDepthRef) < g.LogDepthToExpand)
is_open = true;
return is_open;
}
bool ImGui::TreeNodeBehavior(ImGuiID id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* label, const char* label_end)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
const bool display_frame = (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Framed) != 0;
const ImVec2 padding = (display_frame || (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_FramePadding)) ? style.FramePadding : ImVec2(style.FramePadding.x, ImMin(window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset, style.FramePadding.y));
if (!label_end)
label_end = FindRenderedTextEnd(label);
const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, label_end, false);
// We vertically grow up to current line height up the typical widget height.
const float frame_height = ImMax(ImMin(window->DC.CurrLineSize.y, g.FontSize + style.FramePadding.y*2), label_size.y + padding.y*2);
ImRect frame_bb;
frame_bb.Min.x = (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_SpanFullWidth) ? window->WorkRect.Min.x : window->DC.CursorPos.x;
frame_bb.Min.y = window->DC.CursorPos.y;
frame_bb.Max.x = window->WorkRect.Max.x;
frame_bb.Max.y = window->DC.CursorPos.y + frame_height;
if (display_frame)
{
// Framed header expand a little outside the default padding, to the edge of InnerClipRect
// (FIXME: May remove this at some point and make InnerClipRect align with WindowPadding.x instead of WindowPadding.x*0.5f)
frame_bb.Min.x -= IM_FLOOR(window->WindowPadding.x * 0.5f - 1.0f);
frame_bb.Max.x += IM_FLOOR(window->WindowPadding.x * 0.5f);
}
const float text_offset_x = g.FontSize + (display_frame ? padding.x*3 : padding.x*2); // Collapser arrow width + Spacing
const float text_offset_y = ImMax(padding.y, window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset); // Latch before ItemSize changes it
const float text_width = g.FontSize + (label_size.x > 0.0f ? label_size.x + padding.x*2 : 0.0f); // Include collapser
ImVec2 text_pos(window->DC.CursorPos.x + text_offset_x, window->DC.CursorPos.y + text_offset_y);
ItemSize(ImVec2(text_width, frame_height), padding.y);
// For regular tree nodes, we arbitrary allow to click past 2 worth of ItemSpacing
ImRect interact_bb = frame_bb;
if (!display_frame && (flags & (ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_SpanAvailWidth | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_SpanFullWidth)) == 0)
interact_bb.Max.x = frame_bb.Min.x + text_width + style.ItemSpacing.x * 2.0f;
// Store a flag for the current depth to tell if we will allow closing this node when navigating one of its child.
// For this purpose we essentially compare if g.NavIdIsAlive went from 0 to 1 between TreeNode() and TreePop().
// This is currently only support 32 level deep and we are fine with (1 << Depth) overflowing into a zero.
const bool is_leaf = (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Leaf) != 0;
bool is_open = TreeNodeBehaviorIsOpen(id, flags);
if (is_open && !g.NavIdIsAlive && (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NavLeftJumpsBackHere) && !(flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen))
window->DC.TreeJumpToParentOnPopMask |= (1 << window->DC.TreeDepth);
bool item_add = ItemAdd(interact_bb, id);
window->DC.LastItemStatusFlags |= ImGuiItemStatusFlags_HasDisplayRect;
window->DC.LastItemDisplayRect = frame_bb;
if (!item_add)
{
if (is_open && !(flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen))
TreePushOverrideID(id);
IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(window->DC.LastItemId, label, window->DC.ItemFlags | (is_leaf ? 0 : ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Openable) | (is_open ? ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Opened : 0));
return is_open;
}
ImGuiButtonFlags button_flags = ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_None;
if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_AllowItemOverlap)
button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_AllowItemOverlap;
if (!is_leaf)
button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDragDropHold;
// We allow clicking on the arrow section with keyboard modifiers held, in order to easily
// allow browsing a tree while preserving selection with code implementing multi-selection patterns.
// When clicking on the rest of the tree node we always disallow keyboard modifiers.
const float arrow_hit_x1 = (text_pos.x - text_offset_x) - style.TouchExtraPadding.x;
const float arrow_hit_x2 = (text_pos.x - text_offset_x) + (g.FontSize + padding.x * 2.0f) + style.TouchExtraPadding.x;
const bool is_mouse_x_over_arrow = (g.IO.MousePos.x >= arrow_hit_x1 && g.IO.MousePos.x < arrow_hit_x2);
if (window != g.HoveredWindow || !is_mouse_x_over_arrow)
button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_NoKeyModifiers;
// Open behaviors can be altered with the _OpenOnArrow and _OnOnDoubleClick flags.
// Some alteration have subtle effects (e.g. toggle on MouseUp vs MouseDown events) due to requirements for multi-selection and drag and drop support.
// - Single-click on label = Toggle on MouseUp (default)
// - Single-click on arrow = Toggle on MouseUp (when _OpenOnArrow=0)
// - Single-click on arrow = Toggle on MouseDown (when _OpenOnArrow=1)
// - Double-click on label = Toggle on MouseDoubleClick (when _OpenOnDoubleClick=1)
// - Double-click on arrow = Toggle on MouseDoubleClick (when _OpenOnDoubleClick=1 and _OpenOnArrow=0)
// This makes _OpenOnArrow have a subtle effect on _OpenOnDoubleClick: arrow click reacts on Down rather than Up.
// It is rather standard that arrow click react on Down rather than Up and we'd be tempted to make it the default
// (by removing the _OpenOnArrow test below), however this would have a perhaps surprising effect on CollapsingHeader()?
// So right now we are making this optional. May evolve later.
if (is_mouse_x_over_arrow && (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnArrow))
button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClick;
else if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnDoubleClick)
button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDoubleClick;
else
button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease;
bool selected = (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Selected) != 0;
const bool was_selected = selected;
bool hovered, held;
bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(interact_bb, id, &hovered, &held, button_flags);
bool toggled = false;
if (!is_leaf)
{
if (pressed)
{
if ((flags & (ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnArrow | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnDoubleClick)) == 0 || (g.NavActivateId == id))
toggled = true;
if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnArrow)
toggled |= is_mouse_x_over_arrow && !g.NavDisableMouseHover; // Lightweight equivalent of IsMouseHoveringRect() since ButtonBehavior() already did the job
if ((flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnDoubleClick) && g.IO.MouseDoubleClicked[0])
toggled = true;
if (g.DragDropActive && is_open) // When using Drag and Drop "hold to open" we keep the node highlighted after opening, but never close it again.
toggled = false;
}
if (g.NavId == id && g.NavMoveRequest && g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Left && is_open)
{
toggled = true;
NavMoveRequestCancel();
}
if (g.NavId == id && g.NavMoveRequest && g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Right && !is_open) // If there's something upcoming on the line we may want to give it the priority?
{
toggled = true;
NavMoveRequestCancel();
}
if (toggled)
{
is_open = !is_open;
window->DC.StateStorage->SetInt(id, is_open);
window->DC.LastItemStatusFlags |= ImGuiItemStatusFlags_ToggledOpen;
}
}
if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_AllowItemOverlap)
SetItemAllowOverlap();
// In this branch, TreeNodeBehavior() cannot toggle the selection so this will never trigger.
if (selected != was_selected) //-V547
window->DC.LastItemStatusFlags |= ImGuiItemStatusFlags_ToggledSelection;
// Render
const ImU32 text_col = GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text);
ImGuiNavHighlightFlags nav_highlight_flags = ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_TypeThin;
if (display_frame)
{
// Framed type
const ImU32 bg_col = GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_HeaderActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered : ImGuiCol_Header);
RenderFrame(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, bg_col, true, style.FrameRounding);
RenderNavHighlight(frame_bb, id, nav_highlight_flags);
if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Bullet)
RenderBullet(window->DrawList, ImVec2(text_pos.x - text_offset_x * 0.60f, text_pos.y + g.FontSize * 0.5f), text_col);
else if (!is_leaf)
RenderArrow(window->DrawList, ImVec2(text_pos.x - text_offset_x + padding.x, text_pos.y), text_col, is_open ? ImGuiDir_Down : ImGuiDir_Right, 1.0f);
else // Leaf without bullet, left-adjusted text
text_pos.x -= text_offset_x;
if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_ClipLabelForTrailingButton)
frame_bb.Max.x -= g.FontSize + style.FramePadding.x;
if (g.LogEnabled)
{
// NB: '##' is normally used to hide text (as a library-wide feature), so we need to specify the text range to make sure the ## aren't stripped out here.
const char log_prefix[] = "\n##";
const char log_suffix[] = "##";
LogRenderedText(&text_pos, log_prefix, log_prefix+3);
RenderTextClipped(text_pos, frame_bb.Max, label, label_end, &label_size);
LogRenderedText(&text_pos, log_suffix, log_suffix+2);
}
else
{
RenderTextClipped(text_pos, frame_bb.Max, label, label_end, &label_size);
}
}
else
{
// Unframed typed for tree nodes
if (hovered || selected)
{
const ImU32 bg_col = GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_HeaderActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered : ImGuiCol_Header);
RenderFrame(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, bg_col, false);
RenderNavHighlight(frame_bb, id, nav_highlight_flags);
}
if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Bullet)
RenderBullet(window->DrawList, ImVec2(text_pos.x - text_offset_x * 0.5f, text_pos.y + g.FontSize * 0.5f), text_col);
else if (!is_leaf)
RenderArrow(window->DrawList, ImVec2(text_pos.x - text_offset_x + padding.x, text_pos.y + g.FontSize * 0.15f), text_col, is_open ? ImGuiDir_Down : ImGuiDir_Right, 0.70f);
if (g.LogEnabled)
LogRenderedText(&text_pos, ">");
RenderText(text_pos, label, label_end, false);
}
if (is_open && !(flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen))
TreePushOverrideID(id);
IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(id, label, window->DC.ItemFlags | (is_leaf ? 0 : ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Openable) | (is_open ? ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Opened : 0));
return is_open;
}
void ImGui::TreePush(const char* str_id)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
Indent();
window->DC.TreeDepth++;
PushID(str_id ? str_id : "#TreePush");
}
void ImGui::TreePush(const void* ptr_id)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
Indent();
window->DC.TreeDepth++;
PushID(ptr_id ? ptr_id : (const void*)"#TreePush");
}
void ImGui::TreePushOverrideID(ImGuiID id)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
Indent();
window->DC.TreeDepth++;
window->IDStack.push_back(id);
}
void ImGui::TreePop()
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
Unindent();
window->DC.TreeDepth--;
ImU32 tree_depth_mask = (1 << window->DC.TreeDepth);
// Handle Left arrow to move to parent tree node (when ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NavLeftJumpsBackHere is enabled)
if (g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Left && g.NavWindow == window && NavMoveRequestButNoResultYet())
if (g.NavIdIsAlive && (window->DC.TreeJumpToParentOnPopMask & tree_depth_mask))
{
SetNavID(window->IDStack.back(), g.NavLayer, 0);
NavMoveRequestCancel();
}
window->DC.TreeJumpToParentOnPopMask &= tree_depth_mask - 1;
IM_ASSERT(window->IDStack.Size > 1); // There should always be 1 element in the IDStack (pushed during window creation). If this triggers you called TreePop/PopID too much.
PopID();
}
// Horizontal distance preceding label when using TreeNode() or Bullet()
float ImGui::GetTreeNodeToLabelSpacing()
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
return g.FontSize + (g.Style.FramePadding.x * 2.0f);
}
// Set next TreeNode/CollapsingHeader open state.
void ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(bool is_open, ImGuiCond cond)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
if (g.CurrentWindow->SkipItems)
return;
g.NextItemData.Flags |= ImGuiNextItemDataFlags_HasOpen;
g.NextItemData.OpenVal = is_open;
g.NextItemData.OpenCond = cond ? cond : ImGuiCond_Always;
}
// CollapsingHeader returns true when opened but do not indent nor push into the ID stack (because of the ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen flag).
// This is basically the same as calling TreeNodeEx(label, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_CollapsingHeader). You can remove the _NoTreePushOnOpen flag if you want behavior closer to normal TreeNode().
bool ImGui::CollapsingHeader(const char* label, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
return TreeNodeBehavior(window->GetID(label), flags | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_CollapsingHeader, label);
}
bool ImGui::CollapsingHeader(const char* label, bool* p_open, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
if (p_open && !*p_open)
return false;
ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label);
flags |= ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_CollapsingHeader;
if (p_open)
flags |= ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_AllowItemOverlap | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_ClipLabelForTrailingButton;
bool is_open = TreeNodeBehavior(id, flags, label);
if (p_open)
{
// Create a small overlapping close button
// FIXME: We can evolve this into user accessible helpers to add extra buttons on title bars, headers, etc.
// FIXME: CloseButton can overlap into text, need find a way to clip the text somehow.
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiItemHoveredDataBackup last_item_backup;
float button_size = g.FontSize;
float button_x = ImMax(window->DC.LastItemRect.Min.x, window->DC.LastItemRect.Max.x - g.Style.FramePadding.x * 2.0f - button_size);
float button_y = window->DC.LastItemRect.Min.y;
if (CloseButton(window->GetID((void*)((intptr_t)id + 1)), ImVec2(button_x, button_y)))
*p_open = false;
last_item_backup.Restore();
}
return is_open;
}
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// [SECTION] Widgets: Selectable
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// - Selectable()
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// Tip: pass a non-visible label (e.g. "##dummy") then you can use the space to draw other text or image.
// But you need to make sure the ID is unique, e.g. enclose calls in PushID/PopID or use ##unique_id.
// With this scheme, ImGuiSelectableFlags_SpanAllColumns and ImGuiSelectableFlags_AllowItemOverlap are also frequently used flags.
// FIXME: Selectable() with (size.x == 0.0f) and (SelectableTextAlign.x > 0.0f) followed by SameLine() is currently not supported.
bool ImGui::Selectable(const char* label, bool selected, ImGuiSelectableFlags flags, const ImVec2& size_arg)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
if ((flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_SpanAllColumns) && window->DC.CurrentColumns) // FIXME-OPT: Avoid if vertically clipped.
PushColumnsBackground();
// Submit label or explicit size to ItemSize(), whereas ItemAdd() will submit a larger/spanning rectangle.
ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label);
ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true);
ImVec2 size(size_arg.x != 0.0f ? size_arg.x : label_size.x, size_arg.y != 0.0f ? size_arg.y : label_size.y);
ImVec2 pos = window->DC.CursorPos;
pos.y += window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset;
ItemSize(size, 0.0f);
// Fill horizontal space
const float min_x = (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_SpanAllColumns) ? window->ContentRegionRect.Min.x : pos.x;
const float max_x = (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_SpanAllColumns) ? window->ContentRegionRect.Max.x : GetContentRegionMaxAbs().x;
if (size_arg.x == 0.0f || (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_SpanAvailWidth))
size.x = ImMax(label_size.x, max_x - min_x);
// Text stays at the submission position, but bounding box may be extended on both sides
const ImVec2 text_min = pos;
const ImVec2 text_max(min_x + size.x, pos.y + size.y);
// Selectables are meant to be tightly packed together with no click-gap, so we extend their box to cover spacing between selectable.
ImRect bb_enlarged(min_x, pos.y, text_max.x, text_max.y);
const float spacing_x = style.ItemSpacing.x;
const float spacing_y = style.ItemSpacing.y;
const float spacing_L = IM_FLOOR(spacing_x * 0.50f);
const float spacing_U = IM_FLOOR(spacing_y * 0.50f);
bb_enlarged.Min.x -= spacing_L;
bb_enlarged.Min.y -= spacing_U;
bb_enlarged.Max.x += (spacing_x - spacing_L);
bb_enlarged.Max.y += (spacing_y - spacing_U);
//if (g.IO.KeyCtrl) { GetForegroundDrawList()->AddRect(bb_align.Min, bb_align.Max, IM_COL32(255, 0, 0, 255)); }
//if (g.IO.KeyCtrl) { GetForegroundDrawList()->AddRect(bb_enlarged.Min, bb_enlarged.Max, IM_COL32(0, 255, 0, 255)); }
bool item_add;
if (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_Disabled)
{
ImGuiItemFlags backup_item_flags = window->DC.ItemFlags;
window->DC.ItemFlags |= ImGuiItemFlags_Disabled | ImGuiItemFlags_NoNavDefaultFocus;
item_add = ItemAdd(bb_enlarged, id);
window->DC.ItemFlags = backup_item_flags;
}
else
{
item_add = ItemAdd(bb_enlarged, id);
}
if (!item_add)
{
if ((flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_SpanAllColumns) && window->DC.CurrentColumns)
PopColumnsBackground();
return false;
}
// We use NoHoldingActiveID on menus so user can click and _hold_ on a menu then drag to browse child entries
ImGuiButtonFlags button_flags = 0;
if (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_NoHoldingActiveID) { button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_NoHoldingActiveId; }
if (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_SelectOnClick) { button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClick; }
if (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_SelectOnRelease) { button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnRelease; }
if (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_Disabled) { button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_Disabled; }
if (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_AllowDoubleClick) { button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease | ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDoubleClick; }
if (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_AllowItemOverlap) { button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_AllowItemOverlap; }
if (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_Disabled)
selected = false;
const bool was_selected = selected;
bool hovered, held;
bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb_enlarged, id, &hovered, &held, button_flags);
// Update NavId when clicking or when Hovering (this doesn't happen on most widgets), so navigation can be resumed with gamepad/keyboard
if (pressed || (hovered && (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_SetNavIdOnHover)))
{
if (!g.NavDisableMouseHover && g.NavWindow == window && g.NavLayer == window->DC.NavLayerCurrent)
{
g.NavDisableHighlight = true;
SetNavID(id, window->DC.NavLayerCurrent, window->DC.NavFocusScopeIdCurrent);
}
}
if (pressed)
MarkItemEdited(id);
if (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_AllowItemOverlap)
SetItemAllowOverlap();
// In this branch, Selectable() cannot toggle the selection so this will never trigger.
if (selected != was_selected) //-V547
window->DC.LastItemStatusFlags |= ImGuiItemStatusFlags_ToggledSelection;
// Render
if (held && (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_DrawHoveredWhenHeld))
hovered = true;
if (hovered || selected)
{
const ImU32 col = GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_HeaderActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered : ImGuiCol_Header);
RenderFrame(bb_enlarged.Min, bb_enlarged.Max, col, false, 0.0f);
RenderNavHighlight(bb_enlarged, id, ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_TypeThin | ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_NoRounding);
}
if ((flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_SpanAllColumns) && window->DC.CurrentColumns)
PopColumnsBackground();
if (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_Disabled) PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, style.Colors[ImGuiCol_TextDisabled]);
RenderTextClipped(text_min, text_max, label, NULL, &label_size, style.SelectableTextAlign, &bb_enlarged);
if (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_Disabled) PopStyleColor();
// Automatically close popups
if (pressed && (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) && !(flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_DontClosePopups) && !(window->DC.ItemFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_SelectableDontClosePopup))
CloseCurrentPopup();
IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(id, label, window->DC.ItemFlags);
return pressed;
}
bool ImGui::Selectable(const char* label, bool* p_selected, ImGuiSelectableFlags flags, const ImVec2& size_arg)
{
if (Selectable(label, *p_selected, flags, size_arg))
{
*p_selected = !*p_selected;
return true;
}
return false;
}
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// [SECTION] Widgets: ListBox
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// - ListBox()
// - ListBoxHeader()
// - ListBoxFooter()
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// FIXME: This is an old API. We should redesign some of it, rename ListBoxHeader->BeginListBox, ListBoxFooter->EndListBox
// and promote using them over existing ListBox() functions, similarly to change with combo boxes.
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// FIXME: In principle this function should be called BeginListBox(). We should rename it after re-evaluating if we want to keep the same signature.
// Helper to calculate the size of a listbox and display a label on the right.
// Tip: To have a list filling the entire window width, PushItemWidth(-1) and pass an non-visible label e.g. "##empty"
bool ImGui::ListBoxHeader(const char* label, const ImVec2& size_arg)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
const ImGuiID id = GetID(label);
const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true);
// Size default to hold ~7 items. Fractional number of items helps seeing that we can scroll down/up without looking at scrollbar.
ImVec2 size = CalcItemSize(size_arg, CalcItemWidth(), GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing() * 7.4f + style.ItemSpacing.y);
ImVec2 frame_size = ImVec2(size.x, ImMax(size.y, label_size.y));
ImRect frame_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + frame_size);
ImRect bb(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max + ImVec2(label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x : 0.0f, 0.0f));
window->DC.LastItemRect = bb; // Forward storage for ListBoxFooter.. dodgy.
g.NextItemData.ClearFlags();
if (!IsRectVisible(bb.Min, bb.Max))
{
ItemSize(bb.GetSize(), style.FramePadding.y);
ItemAdd(bb, 0, &frame_bb);
return false;
}
BeginGroup();
if (label_size.x > 0)
RenderText(ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, frame_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), label);
BeginChildFrame(id, frame_bb.GetSize());
return true;
}
// FIXME: In principle this function should be called EndListBox(). We should rename it after re-evaluating if we want to keep the same signature.
bool ImGui::ListBoxHeader(const char* label, int items_count, int height_in_items)
{
// Size default to hold ~7.25 items.
// We add +25% worth of item height to allow the user to see at a glance if there are more items up/down, without looking at the scrollbar.
// We don't add this extra bit if items_count <= height_in_items. It is slightly dodgy, because it means a dynamic list of items will make the widget resize occasionally when it crosses that size.
// I am expecting that someone will come and complain about this behavior in a remote future, then we can advise on a better solution.
if (height_in_items < 0)
height_in_items = ImMin(items_count, 7);
const ImGuiStyle& style = GetStyle();
float height_in_items_f = (height_in_items < items_count) ? (height_in_items + 0.25f) : (height_in_items + 0.00f);
// We include ItemSpacing.y so that a list sized for the exact number of items doesn't make a scrollbar appears. We could also enforce that by passing a flag to BeginChild().
ImVec2 size;
size.x = 0.0f;
size.y = ImFloor(GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing() * height_in_items_f + style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f);
return ListBoxHeader(label, size);
}
// FIXME: In principle this function should be called EndListBox(). We should rename it after re-evaluating if we want to keep the same signature.
void ImGui::ListBoxFooter()
{
ImGuiWindow* parent_window = GetCurrentWindow()->ParentWindow;
const ImRect bb = parent_window->DC.LastItemRect;
const ImGuiStyle& style = GetStyle();
EndChildFrame();
// Redeclare item size so that it includes the label (we have stored the full size in LastItemRect)
// We call SameLine() to restore DC.CurrentLine* data
SameLine();
parent_window->DC.CursorPos = bb.Min;
ItemSize(bb, style.FramePadding.y);
EndGroup();
}
bool ImGui::ListBox(const char* label, int* current_item, const char* const items[], int items_count, int height_items)
{
const bool value_changed = ListBox(label, current_item, Items_ArrayGetter, (void*)items, items_count, height_items);
return value_changed;
}
bool ImGui::ListBox(const char* label, int* current_item, bool (*items_getter)(void*, int, const char**), void* data, int items_count, int height_in_items)
{
if (!ListBoxHeader(label, items_count, height_in_items))
return false;
// Assume all items have even height (= 1 line of text). If you need items of different or variable sizes you can create a custom version of ListBox() in your code without using the clipper.
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
bool value_changed = false;
ImGuiListClipper clipper(items_count, GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing()); // We know exactly our line height here so we pass it as a minor optimization, but generally you don't need to.
while (clipper.Step())
for (int i = clipper.DisplayStart; i < clipper.DisplayEnd; i++)
{
const bool item_selected = (i == *current_item);
const char* item_text;
if (!items_getter(data, i, &item_text))
item_text = "*Unknown item*";
PushID(i);
if (Selectable(item_text, item_selected))
{
*current_item = i;
value_changed = true;
}
if (item_selected)
SetItemDefaultFocus();
PopID();
}
ListBoxFooter();
if (value_changed)
MarkItemEdited(g.CurrentWindow->DC.LastItemId);
return value_changed;
}
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// [SECTION] Widgets: PlotLines, PlotHistogram
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// - PlotEx() [Internal]
// - PlotLines()
// - PlotHistogram()
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
int ImGui::PlotEx(ImGuiPlotType plot_type, const char* label, float (*values_getter)(void* data, int idx), void* data, int values_count, int values_offset, const char* overlay_text, float scale_min, float scale_max, ImVec2 frame_size)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return -1;
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label);
const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true);
if (frame_size.x == 0.0f)
frame_size.x = CalcItemWidth();
if (frame_size.y == 0.0f)
frame_size.y = label_size.y + (style.FramePadding.y * 2);
const ImRect frame_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + frame_size);
const ImRect inner_bb(frame_bb.Min + style.FramePadding, frame_bb.Max - style.FramePadding);
const ImRect total_bb(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max + ImVec2(label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x : 0.0f, 0));
ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y);
if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, 0, &frame_bb))
return -1;
const bool hovered = ItemHoverable(frame_bb, id);
// Determine scale from values if not specified
if (scale_min == FLT_MAX || scale_max == FLT_MAX)
{
float v_min = FLT_MAX;
float v_max = -FLT_MAX;
for (int i = 0; i < values_count; i++)
{
const float v = values_getter(data, i);
if (v != v) // Ignore NaN values
continue;
v_min = ImMin(v_min, v);
v_max = ImMax(v_max, v);
}
if (scale_min == FLT_MAX)
scale_min = v_min;
if (scale_max == FLT_MAX)
scale_max = v_max;
}
RenderFrame(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_FrameBg), true, style.FrameRounding);
const int values_count_min = (plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Lines) ? 2 : 1;
int idx_hovered = -1;
if (values_count >= values_count_min)
{
int res_w = ImMin((int)frame_size.x, values_count) + ((plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Lines) ? -1 : 0);
int item_count = values_count + ((plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Lines) ? -1 : 0);
// Tooltip on hover
if (hovered && inner_bb.Contains(g.IO.MousePos))
{
const float t = ImClamp((g.IO.MousePos.x - inner_bb.Min.x) / (inner_bb.Max.x - inner_bb.Min.x), 0.0f, 0.9999f);
const int v_idx = (int)(t * item_count);
IM_ASSERT(v_idx >= 0 && v_idx < values_count);
const float v0 = values_getter(data, (v_idx + values_offset) % values_count);
const float v1 = values_getter(data, (v_idx + 1 + values_offset) % values_count);
if (plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Lines)
SetTooltip("%d: %8.4g\n%d: %8.4g", v_idx, v0, v_idx+1, v1);
else if (plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Histogram)
SetTooltip("%d: %8.4g", v_idx, v0);
idx_hovered = v_idx;
}
const float t_step = 1.0f / (float)res_w;
const float inv_scale = (scale_min == scale_max) ? 0.0f : (1.0f / (scale_max - scale_min));
float v0 = values_getter(data, (0 + values_offset) % values_count);
float t0 = 0.0f;
ImVec2 tp0 = ImVec2( t0, 1.0f - ImSaturate((v0 - scale_min) * inv_scale) ); // Point in the normalized space of our target rectangle
float histogram_zero_line_t = (scale_min * scale_max < 0.0f) ? (-scale_min * inv_scale) : (scale_min < 0.0f ? 0.0f : 1.0f); // Where does the zero line stands
const ImU32 col_base = GetColorU32((plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Lines) ? ImGuiCol_PlotLines : ImGuiCol_PlotHistogram);
const ImU32 col_hovered = GetColorU32((plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Lines) ? ImGuiCol_PlotLinesHovered : ImGuiCol_PlotHistogramHovered);
for (int n = 0; n < res_w; n++)
{
const float t1 = t0 + t_step;
const int v1_idx = (int)(t0 * item_count + 0.5f);
IM_ASSERT(v1_idx >= 0 && v1_idx < values_count);
const float v1 = values_getter(data, (v1_idx + values_offset + 1) % values_count);
const ImVec2 tp1 = ImVec2( t1, 1.0f - ImSaturate((v1 - scale_min) * inv_scale) );
// NB: Draw calls are merged together by the DrawList system. Still, we should render our batch are lower level to save a bit of CPU.
ImVec2 pos0 = ImLerp(inner_bb.Min, inner_bb.Max, tp0);
ImVec2 pos1 = ImLerp(inner_bb.Min, inner_bb.Max, (plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Lines) ? tp1 : ImVec2(tp1.x, histogram_zero_line_t));
if (plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Lines)
{
window->DrawList->AddLine(pos0, pos1, idx_hovered == v1_idx ? col_hovered : col_base);
}
else if (plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Histogram)
{
if (pos1.x >= pos0.x + 2.0f)
pos1.x -= 1.0f;
window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(pos0, pos1, idx_hovered == v1_idx ? col_hovered : col_base);
}
t0 = t1;
tp0 = tp1;
}
}
// Text overlay
if (overlay_text)
RenderTextClipped(ImVec2(frame_bb.Min.x, frame_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), frame_bb.Max, overlay_text, NULL, NULL, ImVec2(0.5f,0.0f));
if (label_size.x > 0.0f)
RenderText(ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, inner_bb.Min.y), label);
// Return hovered index or -1 if none are hovered.
// This is currently not exposed in the public API because we need a larger redesign of the whole thing, but in the short-term we are making it available in PlotEx().
return idx_hovered;
}
struct ImGuiPlotArrayGetterData
{
const float* Values;
int Stride;
ImGuiPlotArrayGetterData(const float* values, int stride) { Values = values; Stride = stride; }
};
static float Plot_ArrayGetter(void* data, int idx)
{
ImGuiPlotArrayGetterData* plot_data = (ImGuiPlotArrayGetterData*)data;
const float v = *(const float*)(const void*)((const unsigned char*)plot_data->Values + (size_t)idx * plot_data->Stride);
return v;
}
void ImGui::PlotLines(const char* label, const float* values, int values_count, int values_offset, const char* overlay_text, float scale_min, float scale_max, ImVec2 graph_size, int stride)
{
ImGuiPlotArrayGetterData data(values, stride);
PlotEx(ImGuiPlotType_Lines, label, &Plot_ArrayGetter, (void*)&data, values_count, values_offset, overlay_text, scale_min, scale_max, graph_size);
}
void ImGui::PlotLines(const char* label, float (*values_getter)(void* data, int idx), void* data, int values_count, int values_offset, const char* overlay_text, float scale_min, float scale_max, ImVec2 graph_size)
{
PlotEx(ImGuiPlotType_Lines, label, values_getter, data, values_count, values_offset, overlay_text, scale_min, scale_max, graph_size);
}
void ImGui::PlotHistogram(const char* label, const float* values, int values_count, int values_offset, const char* overlay_text, float scale_min, float scale_max, ImVec2 graph_size, int stride)
{
ImGuiPlotArrayGetterData data(values, stride);
PlotEx(ImGuiPlotType_Histogram, label, &Plot_ArrayGetter, (void*)&data, values_count, values_offset, overlay_text, scale_min, scale_max, graph_size);
}
void ImGui::PlotHistogram(const char* label, float (*values_getter)(void* data, int idx), void* data, int values_count, int values_offset, const char* overlay_text, float scale_min, float scale_max, ImVec2 graph_size)
{
PlotEx(ImGuiPlotType_Histogram, label, values_getter, data, values_count, values_offset, overlay_text, scale_min, scale_max, graph_size);
}
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// [SECTION] Widgets: Value helpers
// Those is not very useful, legacy API.
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// - Value()
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
void ImGui::Value(const char* prefix, bool b)
{
Text("%s: %s", prefix, (b ? "true" : "false"));
}
void ImGui::Value(const char* prefix, int v)
{
Text("%s: %d", prefix, v);
}
void ImGui::Value(const char* prefix, unsigned int v)
{
Text("%s: %d", prefix, v);
}
void ImGui::Value(const char* prefix, float v, const char* float_format)
{
if (float_format)
{
char fmt[64];
ImFormatString(fmt, IM_ARRAYSIZE(fmt), "%%s: %s", float_format);
Text(fmt, prefix, v);
}
else
{
Text("%s: %.3f", prefix, v);
}
}
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// [SECTION] MenuItem, BeginMenu, EndMenu, etc.
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// - ImGuiMenuColumns [Internal]
// - BeginMenuBar()
// - EndMenuBar()
// - BeginMainMenuBar()
// - EndMainMenuBar()
// - BeginMenu()
// - EndMenu()
// - MenuItem()
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// Helpers for internal use
ImGuiMenuColumns::ImGuiMenuColumns()
{
Spacing = Width = NextWidth = 0.0f;
memset(Pos, 0, sizeof(Pos));
memset(NextWidths, 0, sizeof(NextWidths));
}
void ImGuiMenuColumns::Update(int count, float spacing, bool clear)
{
IM_ASSERT(count == IM_ARRAYSIZE(Pos));
IM_UNUSED(count);
Width = NextWidth = 0.0f;
Spacing = spacing;
if (clear)
memset(NextWidths, 0, sizeof(NextWidths));
for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(Pos); i++)
{
if (i > 0 && NextWidths[i] > 0.0f)
Width += Spacing;
Pos[i] = IM_FLOOR(Width);
Width += NextWidths[i];
NextWidths[i] = 0.0f;
}
}
float ImGuiMenuColumns::DeclColumns(float w0, float w1, float w2) // not using va_arg because they promote float to double
{
NextWidth = 0.0f;
NextWidths[0] = ImMax(NextWidths[0], w0);
NextWidths[1] = ImMax(NextWidths[1], w1);
NextWidths[2] = ImMax(NextWidths[2], w2);
for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(Pos); i++)
NextWidth += NextWidths[i] + ((i > 0 && NextWidths[i] > 0.0f) ? Spacing : 0.0f);
return ImMax(Width, NextWidth);
}
float ImGuiMenuColumns::CalcExtraSpace(float avail_w) const
{
return ImMax(0.0f, avail_w - Width);
}
// FIXME: Provided a rectangle perhaps e.g. a BeginMenuBarEx() could be used anywhere..
// Currently the main responsibility of this function being to setup clip-rect + horizontal layout + menu navigation layer.
// Ideally we also want this to be responsible for claiming space out of the main window scrolling rectangle, in which case ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar will become unnecessary.
// Then later the same system could be used for multiple menu-bars, scrollbars, side-bars.
bool ImGui::BeginMenuBar()
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
if (!(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar))
return false;
IM_ASSERT(!window->DC.MenuBarAppending);
BeginGroup(); // Backup position on layer 0 // FIXME: Misleading to use a group for that backup/restore
PushID("##menubar");
// We don't clip with current window clipping rectangle as it is already set to the area below. However we clip with window full rect.
// We remove 1 worth of rounding to Max.x to that text in long menus and small windows don't tend to display over the lower-right rounded area, which looks particularly glitchy.
ImRect bar_rect = window->MenuBarRect();
ImRect clip_rect(IM_ROUND(bar_rect.Min.x + window->WindowBorderSize), IM_ROUND(bar_rect.Min.y + window->WindowBorderSize), IM_ROUND(ImMax(bar_rect.Min.x, bar_rect.Max.x - ImMax(window->WindowRounding, window->WindowBorderSize))), IM_ROUND(bar_rect.Max.y));
clip_rect.ClipWith(window->OuterRectClipped);
PushClipRect(clip_rect.Min, clip_rect.Max, false);
window->DC.CursorPos = ImVec2(bar_rect.Min.x + window->DC.MenuBarOffset.x, bar_rect.Min.y + window->DC.MenuBarOffset.y);
window->DC.LayoutType = ImGuiLayoutType_Horizontal;
window->DC.NavLayerCurrent = ImGuiNavLayer_Menu;
window->DC.NavLayerCurrentMask = (1 << ImGuiNavLayer_Menu);
window->DC.MenuBarAppending = true;
AlignTextToFramePadding();
return true;
}
void ImGui::EndMenuBar()
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
// Nav: When a move request within one of our child menu failed, capture the request to navigate among our siblings.
if (NavMoveRequestButNoResultYet() && (g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Left || g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Right) && (g.NavWindow->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu))
{
ImGuiWindow* nav_earliest_child = g.NavWindow;
while (nav_earliest_child->ParentWindow && (nav_earliest_child->ParentWindow->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu))
nav_earliest_child = nav_earliest_child->ParentWindow;
if (nav_earliest_child->ParentWindow == window && nav_earliest_child->DC.ParentLayoutType == ImGuiLayoutType_Horizontal && g.NavMoveRequestForward == ImGuiNavForward_None)
{
// To do so we claim focus back, restore NavId and then process the movement request for yet another frame.
// This involve a one-frame delay which isn't very problematic in this situation. We could remove it by scoring in advance for multiple window (probably not worth the hassle/cost)
const ImGuiNavLayer layer = ImGuiNavLayer_Menu;
IM_ASSERT(window->DC.NavLayerActiveMaskNext & (1 << layer)); // Sanity check
FocusWindow(window);
SetNavIDWithRectRel(window->NavLastIds[layer], layer, 0, window->NavRectRel[layer]);
g.NavLayer = layer;
g.NavDisableHighlight = true; // Hide highlight for the current frame so we don't see the intermediary selection.
g.NavMoveRequestForward = ImGuiNavForward_ForwardQueued;
NavMoveRequestCancel();
}
}
IM_ASSERT(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar);
IM_ASSERT(window->DC.MenuBarAppending);
PopClipRect();
PopID();
window->DC.MenuBarOffset.x = window->DC.CursorPos.x - window->MenuBarRect().Min.x; // Save horizontal position so next append can reuse it. This is kinda equivalent to a per-layer CursorPos.
window->DC.GroupStack.back().EmitItem = false;
EndGroup(); // Restore position on layer 0
window->DC.LayoutType = ImGuiLayoutType_Vertical;
window->DC.NavLayerCurrent = ImGuiNavLayer_Main;
window->DC.NavLayerCurrentMask = (1 << ImGuiNavLayer_Main);
window->DC.MenuBarAppending = false;
}
// For the main menu bar, which cannot be moved, we honor g.Style.DisplaySafeAreaPadding to ensure text can be visible on a TV set.
bool ImGui::BeginMainMenuBar()
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
g.NextWindowData.MenuBarOffsetMinVal = ImVec2(g.Style.DisplaySafeAreaPadding.x, ImMax(g.Style.DisplaySafeAreaPadding.y - g.Style.FramePadding.y, 0.0f));
SetNextWindowPos(ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f));
SetNextWindowSize(ImVec2(g.IO.DisplaySize.x, g.NextWindowData.MenuBarOffsetMinVal.y + g.FontBaseSize + g.Style.FramePadding.y));
PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_WindowRounding, 0.0f);
PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_WindowMinSize, ImVec2(0, 0));
ImGuiWindowFlags window_flags = ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings | ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar;
bool is_open = Begin("##MainMenuBar", NULL, window_flags) && BeginMenuBar();
PopStyleVar(2);
g.NextWindowData.MenuBarOffsetMinVal = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f);
if (!is_open)
{
End();
return false;
}
return true; //-V1020
}
void ImGui::EndMainMenuBar()
{
EndMenuBar();
// When the user has left the menu layer (typically: closed menus through activation of an item), we restore focus to the previous window
// FIXME: With this strategy we won't be able to restore a NULL focus.
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
if (g.CurrentWindow == g.NavWindow && g.NavLayer == ImGuiNavLayer_Main && !g.NavAnyRequest)
FocusTopMostWindowUnderOne(g.NavWindow, NULL);
End();
}
bool ImGui::BeginMenu(const char* label, bool enabled)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label);
bool menu_is_open = IsPopupOpen(id);
// Sub-menus are ChildWindow so that mouse can be hovering across them (otherwise top-most popup menu would steal focus and not allow hovering on parent menu)
ImGuiWindowFlags flags = ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu | ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoNavFocus;
if (window->Flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup | ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu))
flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow;
// If a menu with same the ID was already submitted, we will append to it, matching the behavior of Begin().
// We are relying on a O(N) search - so O(N log N) over the frame - which seems like the most efficient for the expected small amount of BeginMenu() calls per frame.
// If somehow this is ever becoming a problem we can switch to use e.g. a ImGuiStorager mapping key to last frame used.
if (g.MenusIdSubmittedThisFrame.contains(id))
{
if (menu_is_open)
menu_is_open = BeginPopupEx(id, flags); // menu_is_open can be 'false' when the popup is completely clipped (e.g. zero size display)
else
g.NextWindowData.ClearFlags(); // we behave like Begin() and need to consume those values
return menu_is_open;
}
// Tag menu as used. Next time BeginMenu() with same ID is called it will append to existing menu
g.MenusIdSubmittedThisFrame.push_back(id);
ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true);
bool pressed;
bool menuset_is_open = !(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) && (g.OpenPopupStack.Size > g.BeginPopupStack.Size && g.OpenPopupStack[g.BeginPopupStack.Size].OpenParentId == window->IDStack.back());
ImGuiWindow* backed_nav_window = g.NavWindow;
if (menuset_is_open)
g.NavWindow = window; // Odd hack to allow hovering across menus of a same menu-set (otherwise we wouldn't be able to hover parent)
// The reference position stored in popup_pos will be used by Begin() to find a suitable position for the child menu,
// However the final position is going to be different! It is choosen by FindBestWindowPosForPopup().
// e.g. Menus tend to overlap each other horizontally to amplify relative Z-ordering.
ImVec2 popup_pos, pos = window->DC.CursorPos;
if (window->DC.LayoutType == ImGuiLayoutType_Horizontal)
{
// Menu inside an horizontal menu bar
// Selectable extend their highlight by half ItemSpacing in each direction.
// For ChildMenu, the popup position will be overwritten by the call to FindBestWindowPosForPopup() in Begin()
popup_pos = ImVec2(pos.x - 1.0f - IM_FLOOR(style.ItemSpacing.x * 0.5f), pos.y - style.FramePadding.y + window->MenuBarHeight());
window->DC.CursorPos.x += IM_FLOOR(style.ItemSpacing.x * 0.5f);
PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ItemSpacing, ImVec2(style.ItemSpacing.x * 2.0f, style.ItemSpacing.y));
float w = label_size.x;
pressed = Selectable(label, menu_is_open, ImGuiSelectableFlags_NoHoldingActiveID | ImGuiSelectableFlags_SelectOnClick | ImGuiSelectableFlags_DontClosePopups | (!enabled ? ImGuiSelectableFlags_Disabled : 0), ImVec2(w, 0.0f));
PopStyleVar();
window->DC.CursorPos.x += IM_FLOOR(style.ItemSpacing.x * (-1.0f + 0.5f)); // -1 spacing to compensate the spacing added when Selectable() did a SameLine(). It would also work to call SameLine() ourselves after the PopStyleVar().
}
else
{
// Menu inside a menu
// (In a typical menu window where all items are BeginMenu() or MenuItem() calls, extra_w will always be 0.0f.
// Only when they are other items sticking out we're going to add spacing, yet only register minimum width into the layout system.
popup_pos = ImVec2(pos.x, pos.y - style.WindowPadding.y);
float min_w = window->DC.MenuColumns.DeclColumns(label_size.x, 0.0f, IM_FLOOR(g.FontSize * 1.20f)); // Feedback to next frame
float extra_w = ImMax(0.0f, GetContentRegionAvail().x - min_w);
pressed = Selectable(label, menu_is_open, ImGuiSelectableFlags_NoHoldingActiveID | ImGuiSelectableFlags_SelectOnClick | ImGuiSelectableFlags_DontClosePopups | ImGuiSelectableFlags_SpanAvailWidth | (!enabled ? ImGuiSelectableFlags_Disabled : 0), ImVec2(min_w, 0.0f));
ImU32 text_col = GetColorU32(enabled ? ImGuiCol_Text : ImGuiCol_TextDisabled);
RenderArrow(window->DrawList, pos + ImVec2(window->DC.MenuColumns.Pos[2] + extra_w + g.FontSize * 0.30f, 0.0f), text_col, ImGuiDir_Right);
}
const bool hovered = enabled && ItemHoverable(window->DC.LastItemRect, id);
if (menuset_is_open)
g.NavWindow = backed_nav_window;
bool want_open = false;
bool want_close = false;
if (window->DC.LayoutType == ImGuiLayoutType_Vertical) // (window->Flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup|ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu))
{
// Close menu when not hovering it anymore unless we are moving roughly in the direction of the menu
// Implement http://bjk5.com/post/44698559168/breaking-down-amazons-mega-dropdown to avoid using timers, so menus feels more reactive.
bool moving_toward_other_child_menu = false;
ImGuiWindow* child_menu_window = (g.BeginPopupStack.Size < g.OpenPopupStack.Size && g.OpenPopupStack[g.BeginPopupStack.Size].SourceWindow == window) ? g.OpenPopupStack[g.BeginPopupStack.Size].Window : NULL;
if (g.HoveredWindow == window && child_menu_window != NULL && !(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar))
{
// FIXME-DPI: Values should be derived from a master "scale" factor.
ImRect next_window_rect = child_menu_window->Rect();
ImVec2 ta = g.IO.MousePos - g.IO.MouseDelta;
ImVec2 tb = (window->Pos.x < child_menu_window->Pos.x) ? next_window_rect.GetTL() : next_window_rect.GetTR();
ImVec2 tc = (window->Pos.x < child_menu_window->Pos.x) ? next_window_rect.GetBL() : next_window_rect.GetBR();
float extra = ImClamp(ImFabs(ta.x - tb.x) * 0.30f, 5.0f, 30.0f); // add a bit of extra slack.
ta.x += (window->Pos.x < child_menu_window->Pos.x) ? -0.5f : +0.5f; // to avoid numerical issues
tb.y = ta.y + ImMax((tb.y - extra) - ta.y, -100.0f); // triangle is maximum 200 high to limit the slope and the bias toward large sub-menus // FIXME: Multiply by fb_scale?
tc.y = ta.y + ImMin((tc.y + extra) - ta.y, +100.0f);
moving_toward_other_child_menu = ImTriangleContainsPoint(ta, tb, tc, g.IO.MousePos);
//GetForegroundDrawList()->AddTriangleFilled(ta, tb, tc, moving_within_opened_triangle ? IM_COL32(0,128,0,128) : IM_COL32(128,0,0,128)); // [DEBUG]
}
if (menu_is_open && !hovered && g.HoveredWindow == window && g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame != 0 && g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame != id && !moving_toward_other_child_menu)
want_close = true;
if (!menu_is_open && hovered && pressed) // Click to open
want_open = true;
else if (!menu_is_open && hovered && !moving_toward_other_child_menu) // Hover to open
want_open = true;
if (g.NavActivateId == id)
{
want_close = menu_is_open;
want_open = !menu_is_open;
}
if (g.NavId == id && g.NavMoveRequest && g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Right) // Nav-Right to open
{
want_open = true;
NavMoveRequestCancel();
}
}
else
{
// Menu bar
if (menu_is_open && pressed && menuset_is_open) // Click an open menu again to close it
{
want_close = true;
want_open = menu_is_open = false;
}
else if (pressed || (hovered && menuset_is_open && !menu_is_open)) // First click to open, then hover to open others
{
want_open = true;
}
else if (g.NavId == id && g.NavMoveRequest && g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Down) // Nav-Down to open
{
want_open = true;
NavMoveRequestCancel();
}
}
if (!enabled) // explicitly close if an open menu becomes disabled, facilitate users code a lot in pattern such as 'if (BeginMenu("options", has_object)) { ..use object.. }'
want_close = true;
if (want_close && IsPopupOpen(id))
ClosePopupToLevel(g.BeginPopupStack.Size, true);
IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(id, label, window->DC.ItemFlags | ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Openable | (menu_is_open ? ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Opened : 0));
if (!menu_is_open && want_open && g.OpenPopupStack.Size > g.BeginPopupStack.Size)
{
// Don't recycle same menu level in the same frame, first close the other menu and yield for a frame.
OpenPopup(label);
return false;
}
menu_is_open |= want_open;
if (want_open)
OpenPopup(label);
if (menu_is_open)
{
SetNextWindowPos(popup_pos, ImGuiCond_Always);
menu_is_open = BeginPopupEx(id, flags); // menu_is_open can be 'false' when the popup is completely clipped (e.g. zero size display)
}
else
{
g.NextWindowData.ClearFlags(); // We behave like Begin() and need to consume those values
}
return menu_is_open;
}
void ImGui::EndMenu()
{
// Nav: When a left move request _within our child menu_ failed, close ourselves (the _parent_ menu).
// A menu doesn't close itself because EndMenuBar() wants the catch the last Left<>Right inputs.
// However, it means that with the current code, a BeginMenu() from outside another menu or a menu-bar won't be closable with the Left direction.
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
if (g.NavWindow && g.NavWindow->ParentWindow == window && g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Left && NavMoveRequestButNoResultYet() && window->DC.LayoutType == ImGuiLayoutType_Vertical)
{
ClosePopupToLevel(g.BeginPopupStack.Size, true);
NavMoveRequestCancel();
}
EndPopup();
}
bool ImGui::MenuItem(const char* label, const char* shortcut, bool selected, bool enabled)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
ImVec2 pos = window->DC.CursorPos;
ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true);
// We've been using the equivalent of ImGuiSelectableFlags_SetNavIdOnHover on all Selectable() since early Nav system days (commit 43ee5d73),
// but I am unsure whether this should be kept at all. For now moved it to be an opt-in feature used by menus only.
ImGuiSelectableFlags flags = ImGuiSelectableFlags_SelectOnRelease | ImGuiSelectableFlags_SetNavIdOnHover | (enabled ? 0 : ImGuiSelectableFlags_Disabled);
bool pressed;
if (window->DC.LayoutType == ImGuiLayoutType_Horizontal)
{
// Mimic the exact layout spacing of BeginMenu() to allow MenuItem() inside a menu bar, which is a little misleading but may be useful
// Note that in this situation we render neither the shortcut neither the selected tick mark
float w = label_size.x;
window->DC.CursorPos.x += IM_FLOOR(style.ItemSpacing.x * 0.5f);
PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ItemSpacing, ImVec2(style.ItemSpacing.x * 2.0f, style.ItemSpacing.y));
pressed = Selectable(label, false, flags, ImVec2(w, 0.0f));
PopStyleVar();
window->DC.CursorPos.x += IM_FLOOR(style.ItemSpacing.x * (-1.0f + 0.5f)); // -1 spacing to compensate the spacing added when Selectable() did a SameLine(). It would also work to call SameLine() ourselves after the PopStyleVar().
}
else
{
// Menu item inside a vertical menu
// (In a typical menu window where all items are BeginMenu() or MenuItem() calls, extra_w will always be 0.0f.
// Only when they are other items sticking out we're going to add spacing, yet only register minimum width into the layout system.
float shortcut_w = shortcut ? CalcTextSize(shortcut, NULL).x : 0.0f;
float min_w = window->DC.MenuColumns.DeclColumns(label_size.x, shortcut_w, IM_FLOOR(g.FontSize * 1.20f)); // Feedback for next frame
float extra_w = ImMax(0.0f, GetContentRegionAvail().x - min_w);
pressed = Selectable(label, false, flags | ImGuiSelectableFlags_SpanAvailWidth, ImVec2(min_w, 0.0f));
if (shortcut_w > 0.0f)
{
PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, g.Style.Colors[ImGuiCol_TextDisabled]);
RenderText(pos + ImVec2(window->DC.MenuColumns.Pos[1] + extra_w, 0.0f), shortcut, NULL, false);
PopStyleColor();
}
if (selected)
RenderCheckMark(window->DrawList, pos + ImVec2(window->DC.MenuColumns.Pos[2] + extra_w + g.FontSize * 0.40f, g.FontSize * 0.134f * 0.5f), GetColorU32(enabled ? ImGuiCol_Text : ImGuiCol_TextDisabled), g.FontSize * 0.866f);
}
IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(window->DC.LastItemId, label, window->DC.ItemFlags | ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Checkable | (selected ? ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Checked : 0));
return pressed;
}
bool ImGui::MenuItem(const char* label, const char* shortcut, bool* p_selected, bool enabled)
{
if (MenuItem(label, shortcut, p_selected ? *p_selected : false, enabled))
{
if (p_selected)
*p_selected = !*p_selected;
return true;
}
return false;
}
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// [SECTION] Widgets: BeginTabBar, EndTabBar, etc.
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// - BeginTabBar()
// - BeginTabBarEx() [Internal]
// - EndTabBar()
// - TabBarLayout() [Internal]
// - TabBarCalcTabID() [Internal]
// - TabBarCalcMaxTabWidth() [Internal]
// - TabBarFindTabById() [Internal]
// - TabBarRemoveTab() [Internal]
// - TabBarCloseTab() [Internal]
// - TabBarScrollClamp()v
// - TabBarScrollToTab() [Internal]
// - TabBarQueueChangeTabOrder() [Internal]
// - TabBarScrollingButtons() [Internal]
// - TabBarTabListPopupButton() [Internal]
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
namespace ImGui
{
static void TabBarLayout(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar);
static ImU32 TabBarCalcTabID(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, const char* label);
static float TabBarCalcMaxTabWidth();
static float TabBarScrollClamp(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, float scrolling);
static void TabBarScrollToTab(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, ImGuiTabItem* tab);
static ImGuiTabItem* TabBarScrollingButtons(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar);
static ImGuiTabItem* TabBarTabListPopupButton(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar);
}
ImGuiTabBar::ImGuiTabBar()
{
ID = 0;
SelectedTabId = NextSelectedTabId = VisibleTabId = 0;
CurrFrameVisible = PrevFrameVisible = -1;
LastTabContentHeight = 0.0f;
OffsetMax = OffsetMaxIdeal = OffsetNextTab = 0.0f;
ScrollingAnim = ScrollingTarget = ScrollingTargetDistToVisibility = ScrollingSpeed = 0.0f;
Flags = ImGuiTabBarFlags_None;
ReorderRequestTabId = 0;
ReorderRequestDir = 0;
WantLayout = VisibleTabWasSubmitted = false;
LastTabItemIdx = -1;
}
static int IMGUI_CDECL TabItemComparerByVisibleOffset(const void* lhs, const void* rhs)
{
const ImGuiTabItem* a = (const ImGuiTabItem*)lhs;
const ImGuiTabItem* b = (const ImGuiTabItem*)rhs;
return (int)(a->Offset - b->Offset);
}
static ImGuiTabBar* GetTabBarFromTabBarRef(const ImGuiPtrOrIndex& ref)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
return ref.Ptr ? (ImGuiTabBar*)ref.Ptr : g.TabBars.GetByIndex(ref.Index);
}
static ImGuiPtrOrIndex GetTabBarRefFromTabBar(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
if (g.TabBars.Contains(tab_bar))
return ImGuiPtrOrIndex(g.TabBars.GetIndex(tab_bar));
return ImGuiPtrOrIndex(tab_bar);
}
bool ImGui::BeginTabBar(const char* str_id, ImGuiTabBarFlags flags)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
ImGuiID id = window->GetID(str_id);
ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar = g.TabBars.GetOrAddByKey(id);
ImRect tab_bar_bb = ImRect(window->DC.CursorPos.x, window->DC.CursorPos.y, window->WorkRect.Max.x, window->DC.CursorPos.y + g.FontSize + g.Style.FramePadding.y * 2);
tab_bar->ID = id;
return BeginTabBarEx(tab_bar, tab_bar_bb, flags | ImGuiTabBarFlags_IsFocused);
}
bool ImGui::BeginTabBarEx(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, const ImRect& tab_bar_bb, ImGuiTabBarFlags flags)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
if ((flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_DockNode) == 0)
PushOverrideID(tab_bar->ID);
// Add to stack
g.CurrentTabBarStack.push_back(GetTabBarRefFromTabBar(tab_bar));
g.CurrentTabBar = tab_bar;
if (tab_bar->CurrFrameVisible == g.FrameCount)
{
//IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG("BeginTabBarEx already called this frame\n", g.FrameCount);
IM_ASSERT(0);
return true;
}
// When toggling back from ordered to manually-reorderable, shuffle tabs to enforce the last visible order.
// Otherwise, the most recently inserted tabs would move at the end of visible list which can be a little too confusing or magic for the user.
if ((flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_Reorderable) && !(tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_Reorderable) && tab_bar->Tabs.Size > 1 && tab_bar->PrevFrameVisible != -1)
ImQsort(tab_bar->Tabs.Data, tab_bar->Tabs.Size, sizeof(ImGuiTabItem), TabItemComparerByVisibleOffset);
// Flags
if ((flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyMask_) == 0)
flags |= ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyDefault_;
tab_bar->Flags = flags;
tab_bar->BarRect = tab_bar_bb;
tab_bar->WantLayout = true; // Layout will be done on the first call to ItemTab()
tab_bar->PrevFrameVisible = tab_bar->CurrFrameVisible;
tab_bar->CurrFrameVisible = g.FrameCount;
tab_bar->FramePadding = g.Style.FramePadding;
// Layout
ItemSize(ImVec2(tab_bar->OffsetMaxIdeal, tab_bar->BarRect.GetHeight()), tab_bar->FramePadding.y);
window->DC.CursorPos.x = tab_bar->BarRect.Min.x;
// Draw separator
const ImU32 col = GetColorU32((flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_IsFocused) ? ImGuiCol_TabActive : ImGuiCol_TabUnfocusedActive);
const float y = tab_bar->BarRect.Max.y - 1.0f;
{
const float separator_min_x = tab_bar->BarRect.Min.x - IM_FLOOR(window->WindowPadding.x * 0.5f);
const float separator_max_x = tab_bar->BarRect.Max.x + IM_FLOOR(window->WindowPadding.x * 0.5f);
window->DrawList->AddLine(ImVec2(separator_min_x, y), ImVec2(separator_max_x, y), col, 1.0f);
}
return true;
}
void ImGui::EndTabBar()
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
if (window->SkipItems)
return;
ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar = g.CurrentTabBar;
if (tab_bar == NULL)
{
IM_ASSERT_USER_ERROR(tab_bar != NULL, "Mismatched BeginTabBar()/EndTabBar()!");
return;
}
if (tab_bar->WantLayout)
TabBarLayout(tab_bar);
// Restore the last visible height if no tab is visible, this reduce vertical flicker/movement when a tabs gets removed without calling SetTabItemClosed().
const bool tab_bar_appearing = (tab_bar->PrevFrameVisible + 1 < g.FrameCount);
if (tab_bar->VisibleTabWasSubmitted || tab_bar->VisibleTabId == 0 || tab_bar_appearing)
tab_bar->LastTabContentHeight = ImMax(window->DC.CursorPos.y - tab_bar->BarRect.Max.y, 0.0f);
else
window->DC.CursorPos.y = tab_bar->BarRect.Max.y + tab_bar->LastTabContentHeight;
if ((tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_DockNode) == 0)
PopID();
g.CurrentTabBarStack.pop_back();
g.CurrentTabBar = g.CurrentTabBarStack.empty() ? NULL : GetTabBarFromTabBarRef(g.CurrentTabBarStack.back());
}
// This is called only once a frame before by the first call to ItemTab()
// The reason we're not calling it in BeginTabBar() is to leave a chance to the user to call the SetTabItemClosed() functions.
static void ImGui::TabBarLayout(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
tab_bar->WantLayout = false;
// Garbage collect
int tab_dst_n = 0;
for (int tab_src_n = 0; tab_src_n < tab_bar->Tabs.Size; tab_src_n++)
{
ImGuiTabItem* tab = &tab_bar->Tabs[tab_src_n];
if (tab->LastFrameVisible < tab_bar->PrevFrameVisible)
{
if (tab->ID == tab_bar->SelectedTabId)
tab_bar->SelectedTabId = 0;
continue;
}
if (tab_dst_n != tab_src_n)
tab_bar->Tabs[tab_dst_n] = tab_bar->Tabs[tab_src_n];
tab_dst_n++;
}
if (tab_bar->Tabs.Size != tab_dst_n)
tab_bar->Tabs.resize(tab_dst_n);
// Setup next selected tab
ImGuiID scroll_track_selected_tab_id = 0;
if (tab_bar->NextSelectedTabId)
{
tab_bar->SelectedTabId = tab_bar->NextSelectedTabId;
tab_bar->NextSelectedTabId = 0;
scroll_track_selected_tab_id = tab_bar->SelectedTabId;
}
// Process order change request (we could probably process it when requested but it's just saner to do it in a single spot).
if (tab_bar->ReorderRequestTabId != 0)
{
if (ImGuiTabItem* tab1 = TabBarFindTabByID(tab_bar, tab_bar->ReorderRequestTabId))
{
//IM_ASSERT(tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_Reorderable); // <- this may happen when using debug tools
int tab2_order = tab_bar->GetTabOrder(tab1) + tab_bar->ReorderRequestDir;
if (tab2_order >= 0 && tab2_order < tab_bar->Tabs.Size)
{
ImGuiTabItem* tab2 = &tab_bar->Tabs[tab2_order];
ImGuiTabItem item_tmp = *tab1;
*tab1 = *tab2;
*tab2 = item_tmp;
if (tab2->ID == tab_bar->SelectedTabId)
scroll_track_selected_tab_id = tab2->ID;
tab1 = tab2 = NULL;
}
if (tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_SaveSettings)
MarkIniSettingsDirty();
}
tab_bar->ReorderRequestTabId = 0;
}
// Tab List Popup (will alter tab_bar->BarRect and therefore the available width!)
const bool tab_list_popup_button = (tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_TabListPopupButton) != 0;
if (tab_list_popup_button)
if (ImGuiTabItem* tab_to_select = TabBarTabListPopupButton(tab_bar)) // NB: Will alter BarRect.Max.x!
scroll_track_selected_tab_id = tab_bar->SelectedTabId = tab_to_select->ID;
// Compute ideal widths
g.ShrinkWidthBuffer.resize(tab_bar->Tabs.Size);
float width_total_contents = 0.0f;
ImGuiTabItem* most_recently_selected_tab = NULL;
bool found_selected_tab_id = false;
for (int tab_n = 0; tab_n < tab_bar->Tabs.Size; tab_n++)
{
ImGuiTabItem* tab = &tab_bar->Tabs[tab_n];
IM_ASSERT(tab->LastFrameVisible >= tab_bar->PrevFrameVisible);
if (most_recently_selected_tab == NULL || most_recently_selected_tab->LastFrameSelected < tab->LastFrameSelected)
most_recently_selected_tab = tab;
if (tab->ID == tab_bar->SelectedTabId)
found_selected_tab_id = true;
// Refresh tab width immediately, otherwise changes of style e.g. style.FramePadding.x would noticeably lag in the tab bar.
// Additionally, when using TabBarAddTab() to manipulate tab bar order we occasionally insert new tabs that don't have a width yet,
// and we cannot wait for the next BeginTabItem() call. We cannot compute this width within TabBarAddTab() because font size depends on the active window.
const char* tab_name = tab_bar->GetTabName(tab);
const bool has_close_button = (tab->Flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_NoCloseButton) ? false : true;
tab->ContentWidth = TabItemCalcSize(tab_name, has_close_button).x;
width_total_contents += (tab_n > 0 ? g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x : 0.0f) + tab->ContentWidth;
// Store data so we can build an array sorted by width if we need to shrink tabs down
g.ShrinkWidthBuffer[tab_n].Index = tab_n;
g.ShrinkWidthBuffer[tab_n].Width = tab->ContentWidth;
}
// Compute width
const float initial_offset_x = 0.0f; // g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x;
const float width_avail = ImMax(tab_bar->BarRect.GetWidth() - initial_offset_x, 0.0f);
float width_excess = (width_avail < width_total_contents) ? (width_total_contents - width_avail) : 0.0f;
if (width_excess > 0.0f && (tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyResizeDown))
{
// If we don't have enough room, resize down the largest tabs first
ShrinkWidths(g.ShrinkWidthBuffer.Data, g.ShrinkWidthBuffer.Size, width_excess);
for (int tab_n = 0; tab_n < tab_bar->Tabs.Size; tab_n++)
tab_bar->Tabs[g.ShrinkWidthBuffer[tab_n].Index].Width = IM_FLOOR(g.ShrinkWidthBuffer[tab_n].Width);
}
else
{
const float tab_max_width = TabBarCalcMaxTabWidth();
for (int tab_n = 0; tab_n < tab_bar->Tabs.Size; tab_n++)
{
ImGuiTabItem* tab = &tab_bar->Tabs[tab_n];
tab->Width = ImMin(tab->ContentWidth, tab_max_width);
IM_ASSERT(tab->Width > 0.0f);
}
}
// Layout all active tabs
float offset_x = initial_offset_x;
float offset_x_ideal = offset_x;
tab_bar->OffsetNextTab = offset_x; // This is used by non-reorderable tab bar where the submission order is always honored.
for (int tab_n = 0; tab_n < tab_bar->Tabs.Size; tab_n++)
{
ImGuiTabItem* tab = &tab_bar->Tabs[tab_n];
tab->Offset = offset_x;
if (scroll_track_selected_tab_id == 0 && g.NavJustMovedToId == tab->ID)
scroll_track_selected_tab_id = tab->ID;
offset_x += tab->Width + g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x;
offset_x_ideal += tab->ContentWidth + g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x;
}
tab_bar->OffsetMax = ImMax(offset_x - g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, 0.0f);
tab_bar->OffsetMaxIdeal = ImMax(offset_x_ideal - g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, 0.0f);
// Horizontal scrolling buttons
const bool scrolling_buttons = (tab_bar->OffsetMax > tab_bar->BarRect.GetWidth() && tab_bar->Tabs.Size > 1) && !(tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_NoTabListScrollingButtons) && (tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyScroll);
if (scrolling_buttons)
if (ImGuiTabItem* tab_to_select = TabBarScrollingButtons(tab_bar)) // NB: Will alter BarRect.Max.x!
scroll_track_selected_tab_id = tab_bar->SelectedTabId = tab_to_select->ID;
// If we have lost the selected tab, select the next most recently active one
if (found_selected_tab_id == false)
tab_bar->SelectedTabId = 0;
if (tab_bar->SelectedTabId == 0 && tab_bar->NextSelectedTabId == 0 && most_recently_selected_tab != NULL)
scroll_track_selected_tab_id = tab_bar->SelectedTabId = most_recently_selected_tab->ID;
// Lock in visible tab
tab_bar->VisibleTabId = tab_bar->SelectedTabId;
tab_bar->VisibleTabWasSubmitted = false;
// Update scrolling
if (scroll_track_selected_tab_id)
if (ImGuiTabItem* scroll_track_selected_tab = TabBarFindTabByID(tab_bar, scroll_track_selected_tab_id))
TabBarScrollToTab(tab_bar, scroll_track_selected_tab);
tab_bar->ScrollingAnim = TabBarScrollClamp(tab_bar, tab_bar->ScrollingAnim);
tab_bar->ScrollingTarget = TabBarScrollClamp(tab_bar, tab_bar->ScrollingTarget);
if (tab_bar->ScrollingAnim != tab_bar->ScrollingTarget)
{
// Scrolling speed adjust itself so we can always reach our target in 1/3 seconds.
// Teleport if we are aiming far off the visible line
tab_bar->ScrollingSpeed = ImMax(tab_bar->ScrollingSpeed, 70.0f * g.FontSize);
tab_bar->ScrollingSpeed = ImMax(tab_bar->ScrollingSpeed, ImFabs(tab_bar->ScrollingTarget - tab_bar->ScrollingAnim) / 0.3f);
const bool teleport = (tab_bar->PrevFrameVisible + 1 < g.FrameCount) || (tab_bar->ScrollingTargetDistToVisibility > 10.0f * g.FontSize);
tab_bar->ScrollingAnim = teleport ? tab_bar->ScrollingTarget : ImLinearSweep(tab_bar->ScrollingAnim, tab_bar->ScrollingTarget, g.IO.DeltaTime * tab_bar->ScrollingSpeed);
}
else
{
tab_bar->ScrollingSpeed = 0.0f;
}
// Clear name buffers
if ((tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_DockNode) == 0)
tab_bar->TabsNames.Buf.resize(0);
}
// Dockables uses Name/ID in the global namespace. Non-dockable items use the ID stack.
static ImU32 ImGui::TabBarCalcTabID(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, const char* label)
{
if (tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_DockNode)
{
ImGuiID id = ImHashStr(label);
KeepAliveID(id);
return id;
}
else
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GImGui->CurrentWindow;
return window->GetID(label);
}
}
static float ImGui::TabBarCalcMaxTabWidth()
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
return g.FontSize * 20.0f;
}
ImGuiTabItem* ImGui::TabBarFindTabByID(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, ImGuiID tab_id)
{
if (tab_id != 0)
for (int n = 0; n < tab_bar->Tabs.Size; n++)
if (tab_bar->Tabs[n].ID == tab_id)
return &tab_bar->Tabs[n];
return NULL;
}
// The *TabId fields be already set by the docking system _before_ the actual TabItem was created, so we clear them regardless.
void ImGui::TabBarRemoveTab(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, ImGuiID tab_id)
{
if (ImGuiTabItem* tab = TabBarFindTabByID(tab_bar, tab_id))
tab_bar->Tabs.erase(tab);
if (tab_bar->VisibleTabId == tab_id) { tab_bar->VisibleTabId = 0; }
if (tab_bar->SelectedTabId == tab_id) { tab_bar->SelectedTabId = 0; }
if (tab_bar->NextSelectedTabId == tab_id) { tab_bar->NextSelectedTabId = 0; }
}
// Called on manual closure attempt
void ImGui::TabBarCloseTab(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, ImGuiTabItem* tab)
{
if ((tab_bar->VisibleTabId == tab->ID) && !(tab->Flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_UnsavedDocument))
{
// This will remove a frame of lag for selecting another tab on closure.
// However we don't run it in the case where the 'Unsaved' flag is set, so user gets a chance to fully undo the closure
tab->LastFrameVisible = -1;
tab_bar->SelectedTabId = tab_bar->NextSelectedTabId = 0;
}
else if ((tab_bar->VisibleTabId != tab->ID) && (tab->Flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_UnsavedDocument))
{
// Actually select before expecting closure
tab_bar->NextSelectedTabId = tab->ID;
}
}
static float ImGui::TabBarScrollClamp(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, float scrolling)
{
scrolling = ImMin(scrolling, tab_bar->OffsetMax - tab_bar->BarRect.GetWidth());
return ImMax(scrolling, 0.0f);
}
static void ImGui::TabBarScrollToTab(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, ImGuiTabItem* tab)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
float margin = g.FontSize * 1.0f; // When to scroll to make Tab N+1 visible always make a bit of N visible to suggest more scrolling area (since we don't have a scrollbar)
int order = tab_bar->GetTabOrder(tab);
float tab_x1 = tab->Offset + (order > 0 ? -margin : 0.0f);
float tab_x2 = tab->Offset + tab->Width + (order + 1 < tab_bar->Tabs.Size ? margin : 1.0f);
tab_bar->ScrollingTargetDistToVisibility = 0.0f;
if (tab_bar->ScrollingTarget > tab_x1 || (tab_x2 - tab_x1 >= tab_bar->BarRect.GetWidth()))
{
tab_bar->ScrollingTargetDistToVisibility = ImMax(tab_bar->ScrollingAnim - tab_x2, 0.0f);
tab_bar->ScrollingTarget = tab_x1;
}
else if (tab_bar->ScrollingTarget < tab_x2 - tab_bar->BarRect.GetWidth())
{
tab_bar->ScrollingTargetDistToVisibility = ImMax((tab_x1 - tab_bar->BarRect.GetWidth()) - tab_bar->ScrollingAnim, 0.0f);
tab_bar->ScrollingTarget = tab_x2 - tab_bar->BarRect.GetWidth();
}
}
void ImGui::TabBarQueueChangeTabOrder(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, const ImGuiTabItem* tab, int dir)
{
IM_ASSERT(dir == -1 || dir == +1);
IM_ASSERT(tab_bar->ReorderRequestTabId == 0);
tab_bar->ReorderRequestTabId = tab->ID;
tab_bar->ReorderRequestDir = (ImS8)dir;
}
static ImGuiTabItem* ImGui::TabBarScrollingButtons(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
const ImVec2 arrow_button_size(g.FontSize - 2.0f, g.FontSize + g.Style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f);
const float scrolling_buttons_width = arrow_button_size.x * 2.0f;
const ImVec2 backup_cursor_pos = window->DC.CursorPos;
//window->DrawList->AddRect(ImVec2(tab_bar->BarRect.Max.x - scrolling_buttons_width, tab_bar->BarRect.Min.y), ImVec2(tab_bar->BarRect.Max.x, tab_bar->BarRect.Max.y), IM_COL32(255,0,0,255));
const ImRect avail_bar_rect = tab_bar->BarRect;
bool want_clip_rect = !avail_bar_rect.Contains(ImRect(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(scrolling_buttons_width, 0.0f)));
if (want_clip_rect)
PushClipRect(tab_bar->BarRect.Min, tab_bar->BarRect.Max + ImVec2(g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, 0.0f), true);
ImGuiTabItem* tab_to_select = NULL;
int select_dir = 0;
ImVec4 arrow_col = g.Style.Colors[ImGuiCol_Text];
arrow_col.w *= 0.5f;
PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, arrow_col);
PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Button, ImVec4(0, 0, 0, 0));
const float backup_repeat_delay = g.IO.KeyRepeatDelay;
const float backup_repeat_rate = g.IO.KeyRepeatRate;
g.IO.KeyRepeatDelay = 0.250f;
g.IO.KeyRepeatRate = 0.200f;
window->DC.CursorPos = ImVec2(tab_bar->BarRect.Max.x - scrolling_buttons_width, tab_bar->BarRect.Min.y);
if (ArrowButtonEx("##<", ImGuiDir_Left, arrow_button_size, ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClick | ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat))
select_dir = -1;
window->DC.CursorPos = ImVec2(tab_bar->BarRect.Max.x - scrolling_buttons_width + arrow_button_size.x, tab_bar->BarRect.Min.y);
if (ArrowButtonEx("##>", ImGuiDir_Right, arrow_button_size, ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClick | ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat))
select_dir = +1;
PopStyleColor(2);
g.IO.KeyRepeatRate = backup_repeat_rate;
g.IO.KeyRepeatDelay = backup_repeat_delay;
if (want_clip_rect)
PopClipRect();
if (select_dir != 0)
if (ImGuiTabItem* tab_item = TabBarFindTabByID(tab_bar, tab_bar->SelectedTabId))
{
int selected_order = tab_bar->GetTabOrder(tab_item);
int target_order = selected_order + select_dir;
tab_to_select = &tab_bar->Tabs[(target_order >= 0 && target_order < tab_bar->Tabs.Size) ? target_order : selected_order]; // If we are at the end of the list, still scroll to make our tab visible
}
window->DC.CursorPos = backup_cursor_pos;
tab_bar->BarRect.Max.x -= scrolling_buttons_width + 1.0f;
return tab_to_select;
}
static ImGuiTabItem* ImGui::TabBarTabListPopupButton(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
// We use g.Style.FramePadding.y to match the square ArrowButton size
const float tab_list_popup_button_width = g.FontSize + g.Style.FramePadding.y;
const ImVec2 backup_cursor_pos = window->DC.CursorPos;
window->DC.CursorPos = ImVec2(tab_bar->BarRect.Min.x - g.Style.FramePadding.y, tab_bar->BarRect.Min.y);
tab_bar->BarRect.Min.x += tab_list_popup_button_width;
ImVec4 arrow_col = g.Style.Colors[ImGuiCol_Text];
arrow_col.w *= 0.5f;
PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, arrow_col);
PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Button, ImVec4(0, 0, 0, 0));
bool open = BeginCombo("##v", NULL, ImGuiComboFlags_NoPreview);
PopStyleColor(2);
ImGuiTabItem* tab_to_select = NULL;
if (open)
{
for (int tab_n = 0; tab_n < tab_bar->Tabs.Size; tab_n++)
{
ImGuiTabItem* tab = &tab_bar->Tabs[tab_n];
const char* tab_name = tab_bar->GetTabName(tab);
if (Selectable(tab_name, tab_bar->SelectedTabId == tab->ID))
tab_to_select = tab;
}
EndCombo();
}
window->DC.CursorPos = backup_cursor_pos;
return tab_to_select;
}
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// [SECTION] Widgets: BeginTabItem, EndTabItem, etc.
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// - BeginTabItem()
// - EndTabItem()
// - TabItemEx() [Internal]
// - SetTabItemClosed()
// - TabItemCalcSize() [Internal]
// - TabItemBackground() [Internal]
// - TabItemLabelAndCloseButton() [Internal]
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
bool ImGui::BeginTabItem(const char* label, bool* p_open, ImGuiTabItemFlags flags)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar = g.CurrentTabBar;
if (tab_bar == NULL)
{
IM_ASSERT_USER_ERROR(tab_bar, "BeginTabItem() Needs to be called between BeginTabBar() and EndTabBar()!");
return false;
}
bool ret = TabItemEx(tab_bar, label, p_open, flags);
if (ret && !(flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_NoPushId))
{
ImGuiTabItem* tab = &tab_bar->Tabs[tab_bar->LastTabItemIdx];
PushOverrideID(tab->ID); // We already hashed 'label' so push into the ID stack directly instead of doing another hash through PushID(label)
}
return ret;
}
void ImGui::EndTabItem()
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
if (window->SkipItems)
return;
ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar = g.CurrentTabBar;
if (tab_bar == NULL)
{
IM_ASSERT(tab_bar != NULL && "Needs to be called between BeginTabBar() and EndTabBar()!");
return;
}
IM_ASSERT(tab_bar->LastTabItemIdx >= 0);
ImGuiTabItem* tab = &tab_bar->Tabs[tab_bar->LastTabItemIdx];
if (!(tab->Flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_NoPushId))
window->IDStack.pop_back();
}
bool ImGui::TabItemEx(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, const char* label, bool* p_open, ImGuiTabItemFlags flags)
{
// Layout whole tab bar if not already done
if (tab_bar->WantLayout)
TabBarLayout(tab_bar);
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
if (window->SkipItems)
return false;
const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style;
const ImGuiID id = TabBarCalcTabID(tab_bar, label);
// If the user called us with *p_open == false, we early out and don't render. We make a dummy call to ItemAdd() so that attempts to use a contextual popup menu with an implicit ID won't use an older ID.
if (p_open && !*p_open)
{
PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags_NoNav | ImGuiItemFlags_NoNavDefaultFocus, true);
ItemAdd(ImRect(), id);
PopItemFlag();
return false;
}
// Store into ImGuiTabItemFlags_NoCloseButton, also honor ImGuiTabItemFlags_NoCloseButton passed by user (although not documented)
if (flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_NoCloseButton)
p_open = NULL;
else if (p_open == NULL)
flags |= ImGuiTabItemFlags_NoCloseButton;
// Calculate tab contents size
ImVec2 size = TabItemCalcSize(label, p_open != NULL);
// Acquire tab data
ImGuiTabItem* tab = TabBarFindTabByID(tab_bar, id);
bool tab_is_new = false;
if (tab == NULL)
{
tab_bar->Tabs.push_back(ImGuiTabItem());
tab = &tab_bar->Tabs.back();
tab->ID = id;
tab->Width = size.x;
tab_is_new = true;
}
tab_bar->LastTabItemIdx = (short)tab_bar->Tabs.index_from_ptr(tab);
tab->ContentWidth = size.x;
const bool tab_bar_appearing = (tab_bar->PrevFrameVisible + 1 < g.FrameCount);
const bool tab_bar_focused = (tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_IsFocused) != 0;
const bool tab_appearing = (tab->LastFrameVisible + 1 < g.FrameCount);
tab->LastFrameVisible = g.FrameCount;
tab->Flags = flags;
// Append name with zero-terminator
tab->NameOffset = tab_bar->TabsNames.size();
tab_bar->TabsNames.append(label, label + strlen(label) + 1);
// If we are not reorderable, always reset offset based on submission order.
// (We already handled layout and sizing using the previous known order, but sizing is not affected by order!)
if (!tab_appearing && !(tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_Reorderable))
{
tab->Offset = tab_bar->OffsetNextTab;
tab_bar->OffsetNextTab += tab->Width + g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x;
}
// Update selected tab
if (tab_appearing && (tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_AutoSelectNewTabs) && tab_bar->NextSelectedTabId == 0)
if (!tab_bar_appearing || tab_bar->SelectedTabId == 0)
tab_bar->NextSelectedTabId = id; // New tabs gets activated
if ((flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_SetSelected) && (tab_bar->SelectedTabId != id)) // SetSelected can only be passed on explicit tab bar
tab_bar->NextSelectedTabId = id;
// Lock visibility
bool tab_contents_visible = (tab_bar->VisibleTabId == id);
if (tab_contents_visible)
tab_bar->VisibleTabWasSubmitted = true;
// On the very first frame of a tab bar we let first tab contents be visible to minimize appearing glitches
if (!tab_contents_visible && tab_bar->SelectedTabId == 0 && tab_bar_appearing)
if (tab_bar->Tabs.Size == 1 && !(tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_AutoSelectNewTabs))
tab_contents_visible = true;
if (tab_appearing && !(tab_bar_appearing && !tab_is_new))
{
PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags_NoNav | ImGuiItemFlags_NoNavDefaultFocus, true);
ItemAdd(ImRect(), id);
PopItemFlag();
return tab_contents_visible;
}
if (tab_bar->SelectedTabId == id)
tab->LastFrameSelected = g.FrameCount;
// Backup current layout position
const ImVec2 backup_main_cursor_pos = window->DC.CursorPos;
// Layout
size.x = tab->Width;
window->DC.CursorPos = tab_bar->BarRect.Min + ImVec2(IM_FLOOR(tab->Offset - tab_bar->ScrollingAnim), 0.0f);
ImVec2 pos = window->DC.CursorPos;
ImRect bb(pos, pos + size);
// We don't have CPU clipping primitives to clip the CloseButton (until it becomes a texture), so need to add an extra draw call (temporary in the case of vertical animation)
bool want_clip_rect = (bb.Min.x < tab_bar->BarRect.Min.x) || (bb.Max.x > tab_bar->BarRect.Max.x);
if (want_clip_rect)
PushClipRect(ImVec2(ImMax(bb.Min.x, tab_bar->BarRect.Min.x), bb.Min.y - 1), ImVec2(tab_bar->BarRect.Max.x, bb.Max.y), true);
ImVec2 backup_cursor_max_pos = window->DC.CursorMaxPos;
ItemSize(bb.GetSize(), style.FramePadding.y);
window->DC.CursorMaxPos = backup_cursor_max_pos;
if (!ItemAdd(bb, id))
{
if (want_clip_rect)
PopClipRect();
window->DC.CursorPos = backup_main_cursor_pos;
return tab_contents_visible;
}
// Click to Select a tab
ImGuiButtonFlags button_flags = (ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClick | ImGuiButtonFlags_AllowItemOverlap);
if (g.DragDropActive)
button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDragDropHold;
bool hovered, held;
bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held, button_flags);
if (pressed)
tab_bar->NextSelectedTabId = id;
hovered |= (g.HoveredId == id);
// Allow the close button to overlap unless we are dragging (in which case we don't want any overlapping tabs to be hovered)
if (!held)
SetItemAllowOverlap();
// Drag and drop: re-order tabs
if (held && !tab_appearing && IsMouseDragging(0))
{
if (!g.DragDropActive && (tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_Reorderable))
{
// While moving a tab it will jump on the other side of the mouse, so we also test for MouseDelta.x
if (g.IO.MouseDelta.x < 0.0f && g.IO.MousePos.x < bb.Min.x)
{
if (tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_Reorderable)
TabBarQueueChangeTabOrder(tab_bar, tab, -1);
}
else if (g.IO.MouseDelta.x > 0.0f && g.IO.MousePos.x > bb.Max.x)
{
if (tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_Reorderable)
TabBarQueueChangeTabOrder(tab_bar, tab, +1);
}
}
}
#if 0
if (hovered && g.HoveredIdNotActiveTimer > 0.50f && bb.GetWidth() < tab->ContentWidth)
{
// Enlarge tab display when hovering
bb.Max.x = bb.Min.x + IM_FLOOR(ImLerp(bb.GetWidth(), tab->ContentWidth, ImSaturate((g.HoveredIdNotActiveTimer - 0.40f) * 6.0f)));
display_draw_list = GetForegroundDrawList(window);
TabItemBackground(display_draw_list, bb, flags, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive));
}
#endif
// Render tab shape
ImDrawList* display_draw_list = window->DrawList;
const ImU32 tab_col = GetColorU32((held || hovered) ? ImGuiCol_TabHovered : tab_contents_visible ? (tab_bar_focused ? ImGuiCol_TabActive : ImGuiCol_TabUnfocusedActive) : (tab_bar_focused ? ImGuiCol_Tab : ImGuiCol_TabUnfocused));
TabItemBackground(display_draw_list, bb, flags, tab_col);
RenderNavHighlight(bb, id);
// Select with right mouse button. This is so the common idiom for context menu automatically highlight the current widget.
const bool hovered_unblocked = IsItemHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenBlockedByPopup);
if (hovered_unblocked && (IsMouseClicked(1) || IsMouseReleased(1)))
tab_bar->NextSelectedTabId = id;
if (tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_NoCloseWithMiddleMouseButton)
flags |= ImGuiTabItemFlags_NoCloseWithMiddleMouseButton;
// Render tab label, process close button
const ImGuiID close_button_id = p_open ? window->GetID((void*)((intptr_t)id + 1)) : 0;
bool just_closed = TabItemLabelAndCloseButton(display_draw_list, bb, flags, tab_bar->FramePadding, label, id, close_button_id);
if (just_closed && p_open != NULL)
{
*p_open = false;
TabBarCloseTab(tab_bar, tab);
}
// Restore main window position so user can draw there
if (want_clip_rect)
PopClipRect();
window->DC.CursorPos = backup_main_cursor_pos;
// Tooltip (FIXME: Won't work over the close button because ItemOverlap systems messes up with HoveredIdTimer)
// We test IsItemHovered() to discard e.g. when another item is active or drag and drop over the tab bar (which g.HoveredId ignores)
if (g.HoveredId == id && !held && g.HoveredIdNotActiveTimer > 0.50f && IsItemHovered())
if (!(tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_NoTooltip))
SetTooltip("%.*s", (int)(FindRenderedTextEnd(label) - label), label);
return tab_contents_visible;
}
// [Public] This is call is 100% optional but it allows to remove some one-frame glitches when a tab has been unexpectedly removed.
// To use it to need to call the function SetTabItemClosed() after BeginTabBar() and before any call to BeginTabItem()
void ImGui::SetTabItemClosed(const char* label)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
bool is_within_manual_tab_bar = g.CurrentTabBar && !(g.CurrentTabBar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_DockNode);
if (is_within_manual_tab_bar)
{
ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar = g.CurrentTabBar;
IM_ASSERT(tab_bar->WantLayout); // Needs to be called AFTER BeginTabBar() and BEFORE the first call to BeginTabItem()
ImGuiID tab_id = TabBarCalcTabID(tab_bar, label);
TabBarRemoveTab(tab_bar, tab_id);
}
}
ImVec2 ImGui::TabItemCalcSize(const char* label, bool has_close_button)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true);
ImVec2 size = ImVec2(label_size.x + g.Style.FramePadding.x, label_size.y + g.Style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f);
if (has_close_button)
size.x += g.Style.FramePadding.x + (g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + g.FontSize); // We use Y intentionally to fit the close button circle.
else
size.x += g.Style.FramePadding.x + 1.0f;
return ImVec2(ImMin(size.x, TabBarCalcMaxTabWidth()), size.y);
}
void ImGui::TabItemBackground(ImDrawList* draw_list, const ImRect& bb, ImGuiTabItemFlags flags, ImU32 col)
{
// While rendering tabs, we trim 1 pixel off the top of our bounding box so they can fit within a regular frame height while looking "detached" from it.
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
const float width = bb.GetWidth();
IM_UNUSED(flags);
IM_ASSERT(width > 0.0f);
const float rounding = ImMax(0.0f, ImMin(g.Style.TabRounding, width * 0.5f - 1.0f));
const float y1 = bb.Min.y + 1.0f;
const float y2 = bb.Max.y - 1.0f;
draw_list->PathLineTo(ImVec2(bb.Min.x, y2));
draw_list->PathArcToFast(ImVec2(bb.Min.x + rounding, y1 + rounding), rounding, 6, 9);
draw_list->PathArcToFast(ImVec2(bb.Max.x - rounding, y1 + rounding), rounding, 9, 12);
draw_list->PathLineTo(ImVec2(bb.Max.x, y2));
draw_list->PathFillConvex(col);
if (g.Style.TabBorderSize > 0.0f)
{
draw_list->PathLineTo(ImVec2(bb.Min.x + 0.5f, y2));
draw_list->PathArcToFast(ImVec2(bb.Min.x + rounding + 0.5f, y1 + rounding + 0.5f), rounding, 6, 9);
draw_list->PathArcToFast(ImVec2(bb.Max.x - rounding - 0.5f, y1 + rounding + 0.5f), rounding, 9, 12);
draw_list->PathLineTo(ImVec2(bb.Max.x - 0.5f, y2));
draw_list->PathStroke(GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Border), false, g.Style.TabBorderSize);
}
}
// Render text label (with custom clipping) + Unsaved Document marker + Close Button logic
// We tend to lock style.FramePadding for a given tab-bar, hence the 'frame_padding' parameter.
bool ImGui::TabItemLabelAndCloseButton(ImDrawList* draw_list, const ImRect& bb, ImGuiTabItemFlags flags, ImVec2 frame_padding, const char* label, ImGuiID tab_id, ImGuiID close_button_id)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true);
if (bb.GetWidth() <= 1.0f)
return false;
// Render text label (with clipping + alpha gradient) + unsaved marker
const char* TAB_UNSAVED_MARKER = "*";
ImRect text_pixel_clip_bb(bb.Min.x + frame_padding.x, bb.Min.y + frame_padding.y, bb.Max.x - frame_padding.x, bb.Max.y);
if (flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_UnsavedDocument)
{
text_pixel_clip_bb.Max.x -= CalcTextSize(TAB_UNSAVED_MARKER, NULL, false).x;
ImVec2 unsaved_marker_pos(ImMin(bb.Min.x + frame_padding.x + label_size.x + 2, text_pixel_clip_bb.Max.x), bb.Min.y + frame_padding.y + IM_FLOOR(-g.FontSize * 0.25f));
RenderTextClippedEx(draw_list, unsaved_marker_pos, bb.Max - frame_padding, TAB_UNSAVED_MARKER, NULL, NULL);
}
ImRect text_ellipsis_clip_bb = text_pixel_clip_bb;
// Close Button
// We are relying on a subtle and confusing distinction between 'hovered' and 'g.HoveredId' which happens because we are using ImGuiButtonFlags_AllowOverlapMode + SetItemAllowOverlap()
// 'hovered' will be true when hovering the Tab but NOT when hovering the close button
// 'g.HoveredId==id' will be true when hovering the Tab including when hovering the close button
// 'g.ActiveId==close_button_id' will be true when we are holding on the close button, in which case both hovered booleans are false
bool close_button_pressed = false;
bool close_button_visible = false;
if (close_button_id != 0)
if (g.HoveredId == tab_id || g.HoveredId == close_button_id || g.ActiveId == close_button_id)
close_button_visible = true;
if (close_button_visible)
{
ImGuiItemHoveredDataBackup last_item_backup;
const float close_button_sz = g.FontSize;
PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_FramePadding, frame_padding);
if (CloseButton(close_button_id, ImVec2(bb.Max.x - frame_padding.x * 2.0f - close_button_sz, bb.Min.y)))
close_button_pressed = true;
PopStyleVar();
last_item_backup.Restore();
// Close with middle mouse button
if (!(flags & ImGuiTabItemFlags_NoCloseWithMiddleMouseButton) && IsMouseClicked(2))
close_button_pressed = true;
text_pixel_clip_bb.Max.x -= close_button_sz;
}
float ellipsis_max_x = close_button_visible ? text_pixel_clip_bb.Max.x : bb.Max.x - 1.0f;
RenderTextEllipsis(draw_list, text_ellipsis_clip_bb.Min, text_ellipsis_clip_bb.Max, text_pixel_clip_bb.Max.x, ellipsis_max_x, label, NULL, &label_size);
return close_button_pressed;
}
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// [SECTION] Widgets: Columns, BeginColumns, EndColumns, etc.
// In the current version, Columns are very weak. Needs to be replaced with a more full-featured system.
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
// - GetColumnIndex()
// - GetColumnCount()
// - GetColumnOffset()
// - GetColumnWidth()
// - SetColumnOffset()
// - SetColumnWidth()
// - PushColumnClipRect() [Internal]
// - PushColumnsBackground() [Internal]
// - PopColumnsBackground() [Internal]
// - FindOrCreateColumns() [Internal]
// - GetColumnsID() [Internal]
// - BeginColumns()
// - NextColumn()
// - EndColumns()
// - Columns()
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
int ImGui::GetColumnIndex()
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
return window->DC.CurrentColumns ? window->DC.CurrentColumns->Current : 0;
}
int ImGui::GetColumnsCount()
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
return window->DC.CurrentColumns ? window->DC.CurrentColumns->Count : 1;
}
float ImGui::GetColumnOffsetFromNorm(const ImGuiColumns* columns, float offset_norm)
{
return offset_norm * (columns->OffMaxX - columns->OffMinX);
}
float ImGui::GetColumnNormFromOffset(const ImGuiColumns* columns, float offset)
{
return offset / (columns->OffMaxX - columns->OffMinX);
}
static const float COLUMNS_HIT_RECT_HALF_WIDTH = 4.0f;
static float GetDraggedColumnOffset(ImGuiColumns* columns, int column_index)
{
// Active (dragged) column always follow mouse. The reason we need this is that dragging a column to the right edge of an auto-resizing
// window creates a feedback loop because we store normalized positions. So while dragging we enforce absolute positioning.
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
IM_ASSERT(column_index > 0); // We are not supposed to drag column 0.
IM_ASSERT(g.ActiveId == columns->ID + ImGuiID(column_index));
float x = g.IO.MousePos.x - g.ActiveIdClickOffset.x + COLUMNS_HIT_RECT_HALF_WIDTH - window->Pos.x;
x = ImMax(x, ImGui::GetColumnOffset(column_index - 1) + g.Style.ColumnsMinSpacing);
if ((columns->Flags & ImGuiColumnsFlags_NoPreserveWidths))
x = ImMin(x, ImGui::GetColumnOffset(column_index + 1) - g.Style.ColumnsMinSpacing);
return x;
}
float ImGui::GetColumnOffset(int column_index)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
ImGuiColumns* columns = window->DC.CurrentColumns;
if (columns == NULL)
return 0.0f;
if (column_index < 0)
column_index = columns->Current;
IM_ASSERT(column_index < columns->Columns.Size);
const float t = columns->Columns[column_index].OffsetNorm;
const float x_offset = ImLerp(columns->OffMinX, columns->OffMaxX, t);
return x_offset;
}
static float GetColumnWidthEx(ImGuiColumns* columns, int column_index, bool before_resize = false)
{
if (column_index < 0)
column_index = columns->Current;
float offset_norm;
if (before_resize)
offset_norm = columns->Columns[column_index + 1].OffsetNormBeforeResize - columns->Columns[column_index].OffsetNormBeforeResize;
else
offset_norm = columns->Columns[column_index + 1].OffsetNorm - columns->Columns[column_index].OffsetNorm;
return ImGui::GetColumnOffsetFromNorm(columns, offset_norm);
}
float ImGui::GetColumnWidth(int column_index)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
ImGuiColumns* columns = window->DC.CurrentColumns;
if (columns == NULL)
return GetContentRegionAvail().x;
if (column_index < 0)
column_index = columns->Current;
return GetColumnOffsetFromNorm(columns, columns->Columns[column_index + 1].OffsetNorm - columns->Columns[column_index].OffsetNorm);
}
void ImGui::SetColumnOffset(int column_index, float offset)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow;
ImGuiColumns* columns = window->DC.CurrentColumns;
IM_ASSERT(columns != NULL);
if (column_index < 0)
column_index = columns->Current;
IM_ASSERT(column_index < columns->Columns.Size);
const bool preserve_width = !(columns->Flags & ImGuiColumnsFlags_NoPreserveWidths) && (column_index < columns->Count-1);
const float width = preserve_width ? GetColumnWidthEx(columns, column_index, columns->IsBeingResized) : 0.0f;
if (!(columns->Flags & ImGuiColumnsFlags_NoForceWithinWindow))
offset = ImMin(offset, columns->OffMaxX - g.Style.ColumnsMinSpacing * (columns->Count - column_index));
columns->Columns[column_index].OffsetNorm = GetColumnNormFromOffset(columns, offset - columns->OffMinX);
if (preserve_width)
SetColumnOffset(column_index + 1, offset + ImMax(g.Style.ColumnsMinSpacing, width));
}
void ImGui::SetColumnWidth(int column_index, float width)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
ImGuiColumns* columns = window->DC.CurrentColumns;
IM_ASSERT(columns != NULL);
if (column_index < 0)
column_index = columns->Current;
SetColumnOffset(column_index + 1, GetColumnOffset(column_index) + width);
}
void ImGui::PushColumnClipRect(int column_index)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
ImGuiColumns* columns = window->DC.CurrentColumns;
if (column_index < 0)
column_index = columns->Current;
ImGuiColumnData* column = &columns->Columns[column_index];
PushClipRect(column->ClipRect.Min, column->ClipRect.Max, false);
}
// Get into the columns background draw command (which is generally the same draw command as before we called BeginColumns)
void ImGui::PushColumnsBackground()
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
ImGuiColumns* columns = window->DC.CurrentColumns;
if (columns->Count == 1)
return;
columns->Splitter.SetCurrentChannel(window->DrawList, 0);
int cmd_size = window->DrawList->CmdBuffer.Size;
PushClipRect(columns->HostClipRect.Min, columns->HostClipRect.Max, false);
IM_UNUSED(cmd_size);
IM_ASSERT(cmd_size == window->DrawList->CmdBuffer.Size); // Being in channel 0 this should not have created an ImDrawCmd
}
void ImGui::PopColumnsBackground()
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead();
ImGuiColumns* columns = window->DC.CurrentColumns;
if (columns->Count == 1)
return;
columns->Splitter.SetCurrentChannel(window->DrawList, columns->Current + 1);
PopClipRect();
}
ImGuiColumns* ImGui::FindOrCreateColumns(ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiID id)
{
// We have few columns per window so for now we don't need bother much with turning this into a faster lookup.
for (int n = 0; n < window->ColumnsStorage.Size; n++)
if (window->ColumnsStorage[n].ID == id)
return &window->ColumnsStorage[n];
window->ColumnsStorage.push_back(ImGuiColumns());
ImGuiColumns* columns = &window->ColumnsStorage.back();
columns->ID = id;
return columns;
}
ImGuiID ImGui::GetColumnsID(const char* str_id, int columns_count)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
// Differentiate column ID with an arbitrary prefix for cases where users name their columns set the same as another widget.
// In addition, when an identifier isn't explicitly provided we include the number of columns in the hash to make it uniquer.
PushID(0x11223347 + (str_id ? 0 : columns_count));
ImGuiID id = window->GetID(str_id ? str_id : "columns");
PopID();
return id;
}
void ImGui::BeginColumns(const char* str_id, int columns_count, ImGuiColumnsFlags flags)
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
IM_ASSERT(columns_count >= 1);
IM_ASSERT(window->DC.CurrentColumns == NULL); // Nested columns are currently not supported
// Acquire storage for the columns set
ImGuiID id = GetColumnsID(str_id, columns_count);
ImGuiColumns* columns = FindOrCreateColumns(window, id);
IM_ASSERT(columns->ID == id);
columns->Current = 0;
columns->Count = columns_count;
columns->Flags = flags;
window->DC.CurrentColumns = columns;
columns->HostCursorPosY = window->DC.CursorPos.y;
columns->HostCursorMaxPosX = window->DC.CursorMaxPos.x;
columns->HostClipRect = window->ClipRect;
columns->HostWorkRect = window->WorkRect;
// Set state for first column
// We aim so that the right-most column will have the same clipping width as other after being clipped by parent ClipRect
const float column_padding = g.Style.ItemSpacing.x;
const float half_clip_extend_x = ImFloor(ImMax(window->WindowPadding.x * 0.5f, window->WindowBorderSize));
const float max_1 = window->WorkRect.Max.x + column_padding - ImMax(column_padding - window->WindowPadding.x, 0.0f);
const float max_2 = window->WorkRect.Max.x + half_clip_extend_x;
columns->OffMinX = window->DC.Indent.x - column_padding + ImMax(column_padding - window->WindowPadding.x, 0.0f);
columns->OffMaxX = ImMax(ImMin(max_1, max_2) - window->Pos.x, columns->OffMinX + 1.0f);
columns->LineMinY = columns->LineMaxY = window->DC.CursorPos.y;
// Clear data if columns count changed
if (columns->Columns.Size != 0 && columns->Columns.Size != columns_count + 1)
columns->Columns.resize(0);
// Initialize default widths
columns->IsFirstFrame = (columns->Columns.Size == 0);
if (columns->Columns.Size == 0)
{
columns->Columns.reserve(columns_count + 1);
for (int n = 0; n < columns_count + 1; n++)
{
ImGuiColumnData column;
column.OffsetNorm = n / (float)columns_count;
columns->Columns.push_back(column);
}
}
for (int n = 0; n < columns_count; n++)
{
// Compute clipping rectangle
ImGuiColumnData* column = &columns->Columns[n];
float clip_x1 = IM_ROUND(window->Pos.x + GetColumnOffset(n));
float clip_x2 = IM_ROUND(window->Pos.x + GetColumnOffset(n + 1) - 1.0f);
column->ClipRect = ImRect(clip_x1, -FLT_MAX, clip_x2, +FLT_MAX);
column->ClipRect.ClipWith(window->ClipRect);
}
if (columns->Count > 1)
{
columns->Splitter.Split(window->DrawList, 1 + columns->Count);
columns->Splitter.SetCurrentChannel(window->DrawList, 1);
PushColumnClipRect(0);
}
// We don't generally store Indent.x inside ColumnsOffset because it may be manipulated by the user.
float offset_0 = GetColumnOffset(columns->Current);
float offset_1 = GetColumnOffset(columns->Current + 1);
float width = offset_1 - offset_0;
PushItemWidth(width * 0.65f);
window->DC.ColumnsOffset.x = ImMax(column_padding - window->WindowPadding.x, 0.0f);
window->DC.CursorPos.x = IM_FLOOR(window->Pos.x + window->DC.Indent.x + window->DC.ColumnsOffset.x);
window->WorkRect.Max.x = window->Pos.x + offset_1 - column_padding;
}
void ImGui::NextColumn()
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
if (window->SkipItems || window->DC.CurrentColumns == NULL)
return;
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiColumns* columns = window->DC.CurrentColumns;
if (columns->Count == 1)
{
window->DC.CursorPos.x = IM_FLOOR(window->Pos.x + window->DC.Indent.x + window->DC.ColumnsOffset.x);
IM_ASSERT(columns->Current == 0);
return;
}
PopItemWidth();
PopClipRect();
const float column_padding = g.Style.ItemSpacing.x;
columns->LineMaxY = ImMax(columns->LineMaxY, window->DC.CursorPos.y);
if (++columns->Current < columns->Count)
{
// Columns 1+ ignore IndentX (by canceling it out)
// FIXME-COLUMNS: Unnecessary, could be locked?
window->DC.ColumnsOffset.x = GetColumnOffset(columns->Current) - window->DC.Indent.x + column_padding;
columns->Splitter.SetCurrentChannel(window->DrawList, columns->Current + 1);
}
else
{
// New row/line
// Column 0 honor IndentX
window->DC.ColumnsOffset.x = ImMax(column_padding - window->WindowPadding.x, 0.0f);
columns->Splitter.SetCurrentChannel(window->DrawList, 1);
columns->Current = 0;
columns->LineMinY = columns->LineMaxY;
}
window->DC.CursorPos.x = IM_FLOOR(window->Pos.x + window->DC.Indent.x + window->DC.ColumnsOffset.x);
window->DC.CursorPos.y = columns->LineMinY;
window->DC.CurrLineSize = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f);
window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset = 0.0f;
PushColumnClipRect(columns->Current); // FIXME-COLUMNS: Could it be an overwrite?
// FIXME-COLUMNS: Share code with BeginColumns() - move code on columns setup.
float offset_0 = GetColumnOffset(columns->Current);
float offset_1 = GetColumnOffset(columns->Current + 1);
float width = offset_1 - offset_0;
PushItemWidth(width * 0.65f);
window->WorkRect.Max.x = window->Pos.x + offset_1 - column_padding;
}
void ImGui::EndColumns()
{
ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui;
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
ImGuiColumns* columns = window->DC.CurrentColumns;
IM_ASSERT(columns != NULL);
PopItemWidth();
if (columns->Count > 1)
{
PopClipRect();
columns->Splitter.Merge(window->DrawList);
}
const ImGuiColumnsFlags flags = columns->Flags;
columns->LineMaxY = ImMax(columns->LineMaxY, window->DC.CursorPos.y);
window->DC.CursorPos.y = columns->LineMaxY;
if (!(flags & ImGuiColumnsFlags_GrowParentContentsSize))
window->DC.CursorMaxPos.x = columns->HostCursorMaxPosX; // Restore cursor max pos, as columns don't grow parent
// Draw columns borders and handle resize
// The IsBeingResized flag ensure we preserve pre-resize columns width so back-and-forth are not lossy
bool is_being_resized = false;
if (!(flags & ImGuiColumnsFlags_NoBorder) && !window->SkipItems)
{
// We clip Y boundaries CPU side because very long triangles are mishandled by some GPU drivers.
const float y1 = ImMax(columns->HostCursorPosY, window->ClipRect.Min.y);
const float y2 = ImMin(window->DC.CursorPos.y, window->ClipRect.Max.y);
int dragging_column = -1;
for (int n = 1; n < columns->Count; n++)
{
ImGuiColumnData* column = &columns->Columns[n];
float x = window->Pos.x + GetColumnOffset(n);
const ImGuiID column_id = columns->ID + ImGuiID(n);
const float column_hit_hw = COLUMNS_HIT_RECT_HALF_WIDTH;
const ImRect column_hit_rect(ImVec2(x - column_hit_hw, y1), ImVec2(x + column_hit_hw, y2));
KeepAliveID(column_id);
if (IsClippedEx(column_hit_rect, column_id, false))
continue;
bool hovered = false, held = false;
if (!(flags & ImGuiColumnsFlags_NoResize))
{
ButtonBehavior(column_hit_rect, column_id, &hovered, &held);
if (hovered || held)
g.MouseCursor = ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeEW;
if (held && !(column->Flags & ImGuiColumnsFlags_NoResize))
dragging_column = n;
}
// Draw column
const ImU32 col = GetColorU32(held ? ImGuiCol_SeparatorActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_SeparatorHovered : ImGuiCol_Separator);
const float xi = IM_FLOOR(x);
window->DrawList->AddLine(ImVec2(xi, y1 + 1.0f), ImVec2(xi, y2), col);
}
// Apply dragging after drawing the column lines, so our rendered lines are in sync with how items were displayed during the frame.
if (dragging_column != -1)
{
if (!columns->IsBeingResized)
for (int n = 0; n < columns->Count + 1; n++)
columns->Columns[n].OffsetNormBeforeResize = columns->Columns[n].OffsetNorm;
columns->IsBeingResized = is_being_resized = true;
float x = GetDraggedColumnOffset(columns, dragging_column);
SetColumnOffset(dragging_column, x);
}
}
columns->IsBeingResized = is_being_resized;
window->WorkRect = columns->HostWorkRect;
window->DC.CurrentColumns = NULL;
window->DC.ColumnsOffset.x = 0.0f;
window->DC.CursorPos.x = IM_FLOOR(window->Pos.x + window->DC.Indent.x + window->DC.ColumnsOffset.x);
}
// [2018-03: This is currently the only public API, while we are working on making BeginColumns/EndColumns user-facing]
void ImGui::Columns(int columns_count, const char* id, bool border)
{
ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow();
IM_ASSERT(columns_count >= 1);
ImGuiColumnsFlags flags = (border ? 0 : ImGuiColumnsFlags_NoBorder);
//flags |= ImGuiColumnsFlags_NoPreserveWidths; // NB: Legacy behavior
ImGuiColumns* columns = window->DC.CurrentColumns;
if (columns != NULL && columns->Count == columns_count && columns->Flags == flags)
return;
if (columns != NULL)
EndColumns();
if (columns_count != 1)
BeginColumns(id, columns_count, flags);
}
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
#endif // #ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE
|